annotate runtime/doc/options.txt @ 6777:a8962f0e0d34 v7.4.710

patch 7.4.710 Problem: It is not possible to make spaces visibible in list mode. Solution: Add the "space" item to 'listchars'. (David B?rgin, issue 350)
author Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
date Tue, 21 Apr 2015 18:33:48 +0200
parents 7c5a0c69e1ac
children 47ebd4065059
Ignore whitespace changes - Everywhere: Within whitespace: At end of lines:
rev   line source
6647
3af822eb4da5 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6583
diff changeset
1 *options.txt* For Vim version 7.4. Last change: 2015 Feb 17
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7 Options *options*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
9 1. Setting options |set-option|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
10 2. Automatically setting options |auto-setting|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
11 3. Options summary |option-summary|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
12
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
13 For an overview of options see help.txt |option-list|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
14
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
15 Vim has a number of internal variables and switches which can be set to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
16 achieve special effects. These options come in three forms:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
17 boolean can only be on or off *boolean* *toggle*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
18 number has a numeric value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
19 string has a string value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
20
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
21 ==============================================================================
523
a7ae7e043e43 updated for version 7.0146
vimboss
parents: 519
diff changeset
22 1. Setting options *set-option* *E764*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
23
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
24 *:se* *:set*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
25 :se[t] Show all options that differ from their default value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
26
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
27 :se[t] all Show all but terminal options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
28
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
29 :se[t] termcap Show all terminal options. Note that in the GUI the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
30 key codes are not shown, because they are generated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
31 internally and can't be changed. Changing the terminal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
32 codes in the GUI is not useful either...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
33
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
34 *E518* *E519*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
35 :se[t] {option}? Show value of {option}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
36
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
37 :se[t] {option} Toggle option: set, switch it on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
38 Number option: show value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
39 String option: show value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
40
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
41 :se[t] no{option} Toggle option: Reset, switch it off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
42
2152
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
43 *:set-!* *:set-inv*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
44 :se[t] {option}! or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
45 :se[t] inv{option} Toggle option: Invert value. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
46
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
47 *:set-default* *:set-&* *:set-&vi* *:set-&vim*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
48 :se[t] {option}& Reset option to its default value. May depend on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
49 current value of 'compatible'. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
50 :se[t] {option}&vi Reset option to its Vi default value. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
51 :se[t] {option}&vim Reset option to its Vim default value. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
52
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
53 :se[t] all& Set all options, except terminal options, to their
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
54 default value. The values of 'term', 'lines' and
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
55 'columns' are not changed. {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
56
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
57 *:set-args* *E487* *E521*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
58 :se[t] {option}={value} or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
59 :se[t] {option}:{value}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
60 Set string or number option to {value}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
61 For numeric options the value can be given in decimal,
6551
4e31d9f7c896 updated for version 7.4.602
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6476
diff changeset
62 hex (preceded with 0x) or octal (preceded with '0').
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
63 The old value can be inserted by typing 'wildchar' (by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
64 default this is a <Tab> or CTRL-E if 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
65 set). See |cmdline-completion|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
66 White space between {option} and '=' is allowed and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
67 will be ignored. White space between '=' and {value}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
68 is not allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
69 See |option-backslash| for using white space and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
70 backslashes in {value}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
71
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
72 :se[t] {option}+={value} *:set+=*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
73 Add the {value} to a number option, or append the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
74 {value} to a string option. When the option is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
75 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
76 value was empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
77 If the option is a list of flags, superfluous flags
557
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
78 are removed. When adding a flag that was already
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
79 present the option value doesn't change.
809
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
80 Also see |:set-args| above.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
81 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
82
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
83 :se[t] {option}^={value} *:set^=*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
84 Multiply the {value} to a number option, or prepend
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
85 the {value} to a string option. When the option is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
86 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
87 value was empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
88 Also see |:set-args| above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
89 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
90
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
91 :se[t] {option}-={value} *:set-=*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
92 Subtract the {value} from a number option, or remove
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
93 the {value} from a string option, if it is there.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
94 If the {value} is not found in a string option, there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
95 is no error or warning. When the option is a comma
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
96 separated list, a comma is deleted, unless the option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
97 becomes empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
98 When the option is a list of flags, {value} must be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
99 exactly as they appear in the option. Remove flags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
100 one by one to avoid problems.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
101 Also see |:set-args| above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
102 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
103
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
104 The {option} arguments to ":set" may be repeated. For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
105 :set ai nosi sw=3 ts=3
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
106 If you make an error in one of the arguments, an error message will be given
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
107 and the following arguments will be ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
108
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
109 *:set-verbose*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
110 When 'verbose' is non-zero, displaying an option value will also tell where it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
111 was last set. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
112 :verbose set shiftwidth cindent?
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
113 < shiftwidth=4 ~
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
114 Last set from modeline ~
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
115 cindent ~
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
116 Last set from /usr/local/share/vim/vim60/ftplugin/c.vim ~
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
117 This is only done when specific option values are requested, not for ":verbose
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
118 set all" or ":verbose set" without an argument.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
119 When the option was set by hand there is no "Last set" message.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
120 When the option was set while executing a function, user command or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
121 autocommand, the script in which it was defined is reported.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
122 Note that an option may also have been set as a side effect of setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
123 'compatible'.
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
124 A few special texts:
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
125 Last set from modeline ~
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
126 Option was set in a |modeline|.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
127 Last set from --cmd argument ~
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
128 Option was set with command line argument |--cmd| or +.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
129 Last set from -c argument ~
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
130 Option was set with command line argument |-c|, +, |-S| or
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
131 |-q|.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
132 Last set from environment variable ~
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
133 Option was set from an environment variable, $VIMINIT,
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
134 $GVIMINIT or $EXINIT.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
135 Last set from error handler ~
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
136 Option was cleared when evaluating it resulted in an error.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
137
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
138 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| feature}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
139
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
140 *:set-termcap* *E522*
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
141 For {option} the form "t_xx" may be used to set a terminal option. This will
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
142 override the value from the termcap. You can then use it in a mapping. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
143 the "xx" part contains special characters, use the <t_xx> form: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
144 :set <t_#4>=^[Ot
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
145 This can also be used to translate a special code for a normal key. For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
146 example, if Alt-b produces <Esc>b, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
147 :set <M-b>=^[b
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
148 (the ^[ is a real <Esc> here, use CTRL-V <Esc> to enter it)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
149 The advantage over a mapping is that it works in all situations.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
150
2726
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
151 You can define any key codes, e.g.: >
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
152 :set t_xy=^[foo;
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
153 There is no warning for using a name that isn't recognized. You can map these
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
154 codes as you like: >
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
155 :map <t_xy> something
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
156 < *E846*
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
157 When a key code is not set, it's like it does not exist. Trying to get its
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
158 value will result in an error: >
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
159 :set t_kb=
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
160 :set t_kb
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
161 E846: Key code not set: t_kb
0d201adaf9c5 updated for version 7.3.141
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
162
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
163 The t_xx options cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
164 security reasons.
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
165
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
166 The listing from ":set" looks different from Vi. Long string options are put
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
167 at the end of the list. The number of options is quite large. The output of
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
168 "set all" probably does not fit on the screen, causing Vim to give the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
169 |more-prompt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
170
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
171 *option-backslash*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
172 To include white space in a string option value it has to be preceded with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
173 backslash. To include a backslash you have to use two. Effectively this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
174 means that the number of backslashes in an option value is halved (rounded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
175 down).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
176 A few examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
177 :set tags=tags\ /usr/tags results in "tags /usr/tags"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
178 :set tags=tags\\,file results in "tags\,file"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
179 :set tags=tags\\\ file results in "tags\ file"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
180
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
181 The "|" character separates a ":set" command from a following command. To
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
182 include the "|" in the option value, use "\|" instead. This example sets the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
183 'titlestring' option to "hi|there": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
184 :set titlestring=hi\|there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
185 This sets the 'titlestring' option to "hi" and 'iconstring' to "there": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
186 :set titlestring=hi|set iconstring=there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
187
642
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 634
diff changeset
188 Similarly, the double quote character starts a comment. To include the '"' in
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 634
diff changeset
189 the option value, use '\"' instead. This example sets the 'titlestring'
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 634
diff changeset
190 option to 'hi "there"': >
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 634
diff changeset
191 :set titlestring=hi\ \"there\"
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 634
diff changeset
192
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
193 For MS-DOS and WIN32 backslashes in file names are mostly not removed. More
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
194 precise: For options that expect a file name (those where environment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
195 variables are expanded) a backslash before a normal file name character is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
196 removed. But a backslash before a special character (space, backslash, comma,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
197 etc.) is used like explained above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
198 There is one special situation, when the value starts with "\\": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
199 :set dir=\\machine\path results in "\\machine\path"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
200 :set dir=\\\\machine\\path results in "\\machine\path"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
201 :set dir=\\path\\file results in "\\path\file" (wrong!)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
202 For the first one the start is kept, but for the second one the backslashes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
203 are halved. This makes sure it works both when you expect backslashes to be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
204 halved and when you expect the backslashes to be kept. The third gives a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
205 result which is probably not what you want. Avoid it.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
206
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
207 *add-option-flags* *remove-option-flags*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
208 *E539* *E550* *E551* *E552*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
209 Some options are a list of flags. When you want to add a flag to such an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
210 option, without changing the existing ones, you can do it like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
211 :set guioptions+=a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
212 Remove a flag from an option like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
213 :set guioptions-=a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
214 This removes the 'a' flag from 'guioptions'.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
215 Note that you should add or remove one flag at a time. If 'guioptions' has
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
216 the value "ab", using "set guioptions-=ba" won't work, because the string "ba"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
217 doesn't appear.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
218
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
219 *:set_env* *expand-env* *expand-environment-var*
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 20
diff changeset
220 Environment variables in specific string options will be expanded. If the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
221 environment variable exists the '$' and the following environment variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
222 name is replaced with its value. If it does not exist the '$' and the name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
223 are not modified. Any non-id character (not a letter, digit or '_') may
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
224 follow the environment variable name. That character and what follows is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
225 appended to the value of the environment variable. Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
226 :set term=$TERM.new
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
227 :set path=/usr/$INCLUDE,$HOME/include,.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
228 When adding or removing a string from an option with ":set opt-=val" or ":set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
229 opt+=val" the expansion is done before the adding or removing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
230
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
231
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
232 Handling of local options *local-options*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
233
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
234 Some of the options only apply to a window or buffer. Each window or buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
235 has its own copy of this option, thus can each have their own value. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
236 allows you to set 'list' in one window but not in another. And set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
237 'shiftwidth' to 3 in one buffer and 4 in another.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
238
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
239 The following explains what happens to these local options in specific
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
240 situations. You don't really need to know all of this, since Vim mostly uses
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
241 the option values you would expect. Unfortunately, doing what the user
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
242 expects is a bit complicated...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
243
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
244 When splitting a window, the local options are copied to the new window. Thus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
245 right after the split the contents of the two windows look the same.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
246
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
247 When editing a new buffer, its local option values must be initialized. Since
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
248 the local options of the current buffer might be specifically for that buffer,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
249 these are not used. Instead, for each buffer-local option there also is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
250 global value, which is used for new buffers. With ":set" both the local and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
251 global value is changed. With "setlocal" only the local value is changed,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
252 thus this value is not used when editing a new buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
253
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
254 When editing a buffer that has been edited before, the last used window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
255 options are used again. If this buffer has been edited in this window, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
256 values from back then are used. Otherwise the values from the window where
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
257 the buffer was edited last are used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
258
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
259 It's possible to set a local window option specifically for a type of buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
260 When you edit another buffer in the same window, you don't want to keep
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
261 using these local window options. Therefore Vim keeps a global value of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
262 local window options, which is used when editing another buffer. Each window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
263 has its own copy of these values. Thus these are local to the window, but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
264 global to all buffers in the window. With this you can do: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
265 :e one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
266 :set list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
267 :e two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
268 Now the 'list' option will also be set in "two", since with the ":set list"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
269 command you have also set the global value. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
270 :set nolist
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
271 :e one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
272 :setlocal list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
273 :e two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
274 Now the 'list' option is not set, because ":set nolist" resets the global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
275 value, ":setlocal list" only changes the local value and ":e two" gets the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
276 global value. Note that if you do this next: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
277 :e one
4358
cf1d93a3914a Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4264
diff changeset
278 You will get back the 'list' value as it was the last time you edited "one".
cf1d93a3914a Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4264
diff changeset
279 The options local to a window are remembered for each buffer. This also
cf1d93a3914a Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4264
diff changeset
280 happens when the buffer is not loaded, but they are lost when the buffer is
cf1d93a3914a Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4264
diff changeset
281 wiped out |:bwipe|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
282
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
283 *:setl* *:setlocal*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
284 :setl[ocal] ... Like ":set" but set only the value local to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
285 current buffer or window. Not all options have a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
286 local value. If the option does not have a local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
287 value the global value is set.
2413
f766a1c87f69 7.3b -> 7.3c
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2411
diff changeset
288 With the "all" argument: display local values for all
f766a1c87f69 7.3b -> 7.3c
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2411
diff changeset
289 local options.
f766a1c87f69 7.3b -> 7.3c
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2411
diff changeset
290 Without argument: Display local values for all local
f766a1c87f69 7.3b -> 7.3c
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2411
diff changeset
291 options which are different from the default.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
292 When displaying a specific local option, show the
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
293 local value. For a global/local boolean option, when
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
294 the global value is being used, "--" is displayed
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
295 before the option name.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
296 For a global option the global value is
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
297 shown (but that might change in the future).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
298 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
299
809
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
300 :setl[ocal] {option}< Set the local value of {option} to its global value by
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
301 copying the value.
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
302 {not in Vi}
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
303
3281
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3237
diff changeset
304 :se[t] {option}< For |global-local| options: Remove the local value of
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3237
diff changeset
305 {option}, so that the global value will be used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
306 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
307
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
308 *:setg* *:setglobal*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
309 :setg[lobal] ... Like ":set" but set only the global value for a local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
310 option without changing the local value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
311 When displaying an option, the global value is shown.
2413
f766a1c87f69 7.3b -> 7.3c
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2411
diff changeset
312 With the "all" argument: display global values for all
f766a1c87f69 7.3b -> 7.3c
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2411
diff changeset
313 local options.
f766a1c87f69 7.3b -> 7.3c
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2411
diff changeset
314 Without argument: display global values for all local
f766a1c87f69 7.3b -> 7.3c
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2411
diff changeset
315 options which are different from the default.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
316 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
317
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
318 For buffer-local and window-local options:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
319 Command global value local value ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
320 :set option=value set set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
321 :setlocal option=value - set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
322 :setglobal option=value set -
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
323 :set option? - display
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
324 :setlocal option? - display
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
325 :setglobal option? display -
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
326
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
327
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
328 Global options with a local value *global-local*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
329
40
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
330 Options are global when you mostly use one value for all buffers and windows.
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
331 For some global options it's useful to sometimes have a different local value.
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
332 You can set the local value with ":setlocal". That buffer or window will then
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
333 use the local value, while other buffers and windows continue using the global
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
334 value.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
335
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
336 For example, you have two windows, both on C source code. They use the global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
337 'makeprg' option. If you do this in one of the two windows: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
338 :set makeprg=gmake
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
339 then the other window will switch to the same value. There is no need to set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
340 the 'makeprg' option in the other C source window too.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
341 However, if you start editing a Perl file in a new window, you want to use
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
342 another 'makeprg' for it, without changing the value used for the C source
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
343 files. You use this command: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
344 :setlocal makeprg=perlmake
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
345 You can switch back to using the global value by making the local value empty: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
346 :setlocal makeprg=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
347 This only works for a string option. For a boolean option you need to use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
348 "<" flag, like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
349 :setlocal autoread<
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
350 Note that for non-boolean options using "<" copies the global value to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
351 local value, it doesn't switch back to using the global value (that matters
809
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
352 when the global value changes later). You can also use: >
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
353 :set path<
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
354 This will make the local value of 'path' empty, so that the global value is
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
355 used. Thus it does the same as: >
4f1b94b51e99 updated for version 7.0b02
vimboss
parents: 804
diff changeset
356 :setlocal path=
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
357 Note: In the future more global options can be made global-local. Using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
358 ":setlocal" on a global option might work differently then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
359
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
360
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
361 Setting the filetype
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
362
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
363 :setf[iletype] {filetype} *:setf* *:setfiletype*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
364 Set the 'filetype' option to {filetype}, but only if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
365 not done yet in a sequence of (nested) autocommands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
366 This is short for: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
367 :if !did_filetype()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
368 : setlocal filetype={filetype}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
369 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
370 < This command is used in a filetype.vim file to avoid
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
371 setting the 'filetype' option twice, causing different
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
372 settings and syntax files to be loaded.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
373 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
374
2698
b6471224d2af Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2681
diff changeset
375 *option-window* *optwin*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
376 :bro[wse] se[t] *:set-browse* *:browse-set* *:opt* *:options*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
377 :opt[ions] Open a window for viewing and setting all options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
378 Options are grouped by function.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
379 Offers short help for each option. Hit <CR> on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
380 short help to open a help window with more help for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
381 the option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
382 Modify the value of the option and hit <CR> on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
383 "set" line to set the new value. For window and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
384 buffer specific options, the last accessed window is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
385 used to set the option value in, unless this is a help
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
386 window, in which case the window below help window is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
387 used (skipping the option-window).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
388 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
389 |+autocmd| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
390
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
391 *$HOME*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
392 Using "~" is like using "$HOME", but it is only recognized at the start of an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
393 option and after a space or comma.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
394
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
395 On Unix systems "~user" can be used too. It is replaced by the home directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
396 of user "user". Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
397 :set path=~mool/include,/usr/include,.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
398
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
399 On Unix systems the form "${HOME}" can be used too. The name between {} can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
400 contain non-id characters then. Note that if you want to use this for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
401 "gf" command, you need to add the '{' and '}' characters to 'isfname'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
402
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
403 On MS-Windows, if $HOME is not defined as an environment variable, then
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
404 at runtime Vim will set it to the expansion of $HOMEDRIVE$HOMEPATH.
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
405
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
406 NOTE: expanding environment variables and "~/" is only done with the ":set"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
407 command, not when assigning a value to an option with ":let".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
408
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
409
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
410 Note the maximum length of an expanded option is limited. How much depends on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
411 the system, mostly it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
412
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
413 *:fix* *:fixdel*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
414 :fix[del] Set the value of 't_kD':
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
415 't_kb' is 't_kD' becomes ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
416 CTRL-? CTRL-H
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
417 not CTRL-? CTRL-?
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
418
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
419 (CTRL-? is 0177 octal, 0x7f hex) {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
420
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
421 If your delete key terminal code is wrong, but the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
422 code for backspace is alright, you can put this in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
423 your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
424 :fixdel
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
425 < This works no matter what the actual code for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
426 backspace is.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
427
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
428 If the backspace key terminal code is wrong you can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
429 use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
430 :if &term == "termname"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
431 : set t_kb=^V<BS>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
432 : fixdel
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
433 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
434 < Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<BS>" is the backspace key
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
435 (don't type four characters!). Replace "termname"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
436 with your terminal name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
437
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
438 If your <Delete> key sends a strange key sequence (not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
439 CTRL-? or CTRL-H) you cannot use ":fixdel". Then use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
440 :if &term == "termname"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
441 : set t_kD=^V<Delete>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
442 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
443 < Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<Delete>" is the delete key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
444 (don't type eight characters!). Replace "termname"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
445 with your terminal name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
446
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
447 *Linux-backspace*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
448 Note about Linux: By default the backspace key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
449 produces CTRL-?, which is wrong. You can fix it by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
450 putting this line in your rc.local: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
451 echo "keycode 14 = BackSpace" | loadkeys
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
452 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
453 *NetBSD-backspace*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
454 Note about NetBSD: If your backspace doesn't produce
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
455 the right code, try this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
456 xmodmap -e "keycode 22 = BackSpace"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
457 < If this works, add this in your .Xmodmap file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
458 keysym 22 = BackSpace
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
459 < You need to restart for this to take effect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
460
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
461 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
462 2. Automatically setting options *auto-setting*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
463
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
464 Besides changing options with the ":set" command, there are three alternatives
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
465 to set options automatically for one or more files:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
466
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
467 1. When starting Vim initializations are read from various places. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
468 |initialization|. Most of them are performed for all editing sessions,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
469 and some of them depend on the directory where Vim is started.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
470 You can create an initialization file with |:mkvimrc|, |:mkview| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
471 |:mksession|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
472 2. If you start editing a new file, the automatic commands are executed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
473 This can be used to set options for files matching a particular pattern and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
474 many other things. See |autocommand|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
475 3. If you start editing a new file, and the 'modeline' option is on, a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
476 number of lines at the beginning and end of the file are checked for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
477 modelines. This is explained here.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
478
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
479 *modeline* *vim:* *vi:* *ex:* *E520*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
480 There are two forms of modelines. The first form:
5055
c458ff35497e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5024
diff changeset
481 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]{options}
5024
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
482
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
483 [text] any text or empty
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
484 {white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>)
5055
c458ff35497e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5024
diff changeset
485 {vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:"
5024
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
486 [white] optional white space
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
487 {options} a list of option settings, separated with white space
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
488 or ':', where each part between ':' is the argument
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
489 for a ":set" command (can be empty)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
490
5055
c458ff35497e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5024
diff changeset
491 Examples:
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
492 vi:noai:sw=3 ts=6 ~
5055
c458ff35497e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5024
diff changeset
493 vim: tw=77 ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
494
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
495 The second form (this is compatible with some versions of Vi):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
496
5024
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
497 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:}[white]se[t] {options}:[text]
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
498
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
499 [text] any text or empty
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
500 {white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>)
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
501 {vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:", "Vim:" or "ex:"
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
502 [white] optional white space
5055
c458ff35497e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5024
diff changeset
503 se[t] the string "set " or "se " (note the space); When
c458ff35497e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5024
diff changeset
504 "Vim" is used it must be "set".
5024
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
505 {options} a list of options, separated with white space, which
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
506 is the argument for a ":set" command
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
507 : a colon
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
508 [text] any text or empty
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
509
5055
c458ff35497e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5024
diff changeset
510 Examples:
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
511 /* vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~
5055
c458ff35497e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5024
diff changeset
512 /* Vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
513
5024
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
514 The white space before {vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} is required. This minimizes the
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
515 chance that a normal word like "lex:" is caught. There is one exception:
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
516 "vi:" and "vim:" can also be at the start of the line (for compatibility with
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
517 version 3.0). Using "ex:" at the start of the line will be ignored (this
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
518 could be short for "example:").
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
519
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
520 *modeline-local*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
521 The options are set like with ":setlocal": The new value only applies to the
11
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
522 buffer and window that contain the file. Although it's possible to set global
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
523 options from a modeline, this is unusual. If you have two windows open and
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
524 the files in it set the same global option to a different value, the result
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
525 depends on which one was opened last.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
526
23
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
527 When editing a file that was already loaded, only the window-local options
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
528 from the modeline are used. Thus if you manually changed a buffer-local
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
529 option after opening the file, it won't be changed if you edit the same buffer
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
530 in another window. But window-local options will be set.
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
531
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
532 *modeline-version*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
533 If the modeline is only to be used for some versions of Vim, the version
5024
7a2ffd685c0e Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5008
diff changeset
534 number can be specified where "vim:" or "Vim:" is used:
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
535 vim{vers}: version {vers} or later
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
536 vim<{vers}: version before {vers}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
537 vim={vers}: version {vers}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
538 vim>{vers}: version after {vers}
6647
3af822eb4da5 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6583
diff changeset
539 {vers} is 700 for Vim 7.0 (hundred times the major version plus minor).
3af822eb4da5 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6583
diff changeset
540 For example, to use a modeline only for Vim 7.0:
3af822eb4da5 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6583
diff changeset
541 /* vim700: set foldmethod=marker */ ~
3af822eb4da5 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6583
diff changeset
542 To use a modeline for Vim after version 7.2:
3af822eb4da5 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6583
diff changeset
543 /* vim>702: set cole=2: */ ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
544 There can be no blanks between "vim" and the ":".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
545
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
546
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
547 The number of lines that are checked can be set with the 'modelines' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
548 If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is 0 no lines are checked.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
549
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
550 Note that for the first form all of the rest of the line is used, thus a line
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
551 like:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
552 /* vi:ts=4: */ ~
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
553 will give an error message for the trailing "*/". This line is OK:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
554 /* vi:set ts=4: */ ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
555
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
556 If an error is detected the rest of the line is skipped.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
557
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
558 If you want to include a ':' in a set command precede it with a '\'. The
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
559 backslash in front of the ':' will be removed. Example:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
560 /* vi:set dir=c\:\tmp: */ ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
561 This sets the 'dir' option to "c:\tmp". Only a single backslash before the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
562 ':' is removed. Thus to include "\:" you have to specify "\\:".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
563
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
564 No other commands than "set" are supported, for security reasons (somebody
1111
53fd0a213cff updated for version 7.0-237
vimboss
parents: 1004
diff changeset
565 might create a Trojan horse text file with modelines). And not all options
53fd0a213cff updated for version 7.0-237
vimboss
parents: 1004
diff changeset
566 can be set. For some options a flag is set, so that when it's used the
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
567 |sandbox| is effective. Still, there is always a small risk that a modeline
1111
53fd0a213cff updated for version 7.0-237
vimboss
parents: 1004
diff changeset
568 causes trouble. E.g., when some joker sets 'textwidth' to 5 all your lines
53fd0a213cff updated for version 7.0-237
vimboss
parents: 1004
diff changeset
569 are wrapped unexpectedly. So disable modelines before editing untrusted text.
53fd0a213cff updated for version 7.0-237
vimboss
parents: 1004
diff changeset
570 The mail ftplugin does this, for example.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
571
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
572 Hint: If you would like to do something else than setting an option, you could
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
573 define an autocommand that checks the file for a specific string. For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
574 example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
575 au BufReadPost * if getline(1) =~ "VAR" | call SetVar() | endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
576 And define a function SetVar() that does something with the line containing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
577 "VAR".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
578
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
579 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
580 3. Options summary *option-summary*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
581
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
582 In the list below all the options are mentioned with their full name and with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
583 an abbreviation if there is one. Both forms may be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
584
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
585 In this document when a boolean option is "set" that means that ":set option"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
586 is entered. When an option is "reset", ":set nooption" is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
587
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
588 For some options there are two default values: The "Vim default", which is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
589 used when 'compatible' is not set, and the "Vi default", which is used when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
590 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
591
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
592 Most options are the same in all windows and buffers. There are a few that
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
593 are specific to how the text is presented in a window. These can be set to a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
594 different value in each window. For example the 'list' option can be set in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
595 one window and reset in another for the same text, giving both types of view
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
596 at the same time. There are a few options that are specific to a certain
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
597 file. These can have a different value for each file or buffer. For example
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
598 the 'textwidth' option can be 78 for a normal text file and 0 for a C
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
599 program.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
600
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
601 global one option for all buffers and windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
602 local to window each window has its own copy of this option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
603 local to buffer each buffer has its own copy of this option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
604
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
605 When creating a new window the option values from the currently active window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
606 are used as a default value for the window-specific options. For the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
607 buffer-specific options this depends on the 's' and 'S' flags in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
608 'cpoptions' option. If 's' is included (which is the default) the values for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
609 buffer options are copied from the currently active buffer when a buffer is
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
610 first entered. If 'S' is present the options are copied each time the buffer
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
611 is entered, this is almost like having global options. If 's' and 'S' are not
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
612 present, the options are copied from the currently active buffer when the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
613 buffer is created.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
614
519
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
615 Hidden options *hidden-options*
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
616
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
617 Not all options are supported in all versions. This depends on the supported
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
618 features and sometimes on the system. A remark about this is in curly braces
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
619 below. When an option is not supported it may still be set without getting an
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
620 error, this is called a hidden option. You can't get the value of a hidden
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
621 option though, it is not stored.
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
622
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
623 To test if option "foo" can be used with ":set" use something like this: >
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
624 if exists('&foo')
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
625 This also returns true for a hidden option. To test if option "foo" is really
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
626 supported use something like this: >
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
627 if exists('+foo')
d50452846776 updated for version 7.0145
vimboss
parents: 515
diff changeset
628 <
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
629 *E355*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
630 A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
631
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
632 *'aleph'* *'al'* *aleph* *Aleph*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
633 'aleph' 'al' number (default 128 for MS-DOS, 224 otherwise)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
634 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
635 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
636 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
637 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
638 The ASCII code for the first letter of the Hebrew alphabet. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
639 routine that maps the keyboard in Hebrew mode, both in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
640 (when hkmap is set) and on the command-line (when hitting CTRL-_)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
641 outputs the Hebrew characters in the range [aleph..aleph+26].
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
642 aleph=128 applies to PC code, and aleph=224 applies to ISO 8859-8.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
643 See |rileft.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
644
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
645 *'allowrevins'* *'ari'* *'noallowrevins'* *'noari'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
646 'allowrevins' 'ari' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
647 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
648 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
649 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
650 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
651 Allow CTRL-_ in Insert and Command-line mode. This is default off, to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
652 avoid that users that accidentally type CTRL-_ instead of SHIFT-_ get
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
653 into reverse Insert mode, and don't know how to get out. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
654 'revins'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
655 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
656
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
657 *'altkeymap'* *'akm'* *'noaltkeymap'* *'noakm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
658 'altkeymap' 'akm' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
659 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
660 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
661 {only available when compiled with the |+farsi|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
662 feature}
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
663 When on, the second language is Farsi. In editing mode CTRL-_ toggles
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
664 the keyboard map between Farsi and English, when 'allowrevins' set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
665
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
666 When off, the keyboard map toggles between Hebrew and English. This
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
667 is useful to start the Vim in native mode i.e. English (left-to-right
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
668 mode) and have default second language Farsi or Hebrew (right-to-left
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
669 mode). See |farsi.txt|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
670
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
671 *'ambiwidth'* *'ambw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
672 'ambiwidth' 'ambw' string (default: "single")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
673 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
674 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
675 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
676 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
677 Only effective when 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
678 Tells Vim what to do with characters with East Asian Width Class
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
679 Ambiguous (such as Euro, Registered Sign, Copyright Sign, Greek
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
680 letters, Cyrillic letters).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
681
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
682 There are currently two possible values:
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
683 "single": Use the same width as characters in US-ASCII. This is
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
684 expected by most users.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
685 "double": Use twice the width of ASCII characters.
2492
c945fdb34ce3 Disallow setting 'ambiwidth' to "double" when 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2490
diff changeset
686 *E834* *E835*
c945fdb34ce3 Disallow setting 'ambiwidth' to "double" when 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2490
diff changeset
687 The value "double" cannot be used if 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
c945fdb34ce3 Disallow setting 'ambiwidth' to "double" when 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2490
diff changeset
688 contains a character that would be double width.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
689
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
690 There are a number of CJK fonts for which the width of glyphs for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
691 those characters are solely based on how many octets they take in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
692 legacy/traditional CJK encodings. In those encodings, Euro,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
693 Registered sign, Greek/Cyrillic letters are represented by two octets,
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
694 therefore those fonts have "wide" glyphs for them. This is also
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
695 true of some line drawing characters used to make tables in text
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
696 file. Therefore, when a CJK font is used for GUI Vim or
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
697 Vim is running inside a terminal (emulators) that uses a CJK font
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
698 (or Vim is run inside an xterm invoked with "-cjkwidth" option.),
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
699 this option should be set to "double" to match the width perceived
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
700 by Vim with the width of glyphs in the font. Perhaps it also has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
701 to be set to "double" under CJK Windows 9x/ME or Windows 2k/XP
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
702 when the system locale is set to one of CJK locales. See Unicode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
703 Standard Annex #11 (http://www.unicode.org/reports/tr11).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
704
4229
fa4089df54bc Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4186
diff changeset
705 Vim may set this option automatically at startup time when Vim is
fa4089df54bc Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4186
diff changeset
706 compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and if |t_u7| is set to the
4264
2d1383658bb4 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4242
diff changeset
707 escape sequence to request cursor position report.
4229
fa4089df54bc Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4186
diff changeset
708
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
709 *'antialias'* *'anti'* *'noantialias'* *'noanti'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
710 'antialias' 'anti' boolean (default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
711 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
712 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
713 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
714 on Mac OS X}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
715 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim on Mac OS X
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
716 v10.2 or later. When on, Vim will use smooth ("antialiased") fonts,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
717 which can be easier to read at certain sizes on certain displays.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
718 Setting this option can sometimes cause problems if 'guifont' is set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
719 to its default (empty string).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
720
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
721 *'autochdir'* *'acd'* *'noautochdir'* *'noacd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
722 'autochdir' 'acd' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
723 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
724 {not in Vi}
2152
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
725 {only available when compiled with it, use
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
726 exists("+autochdir") to check}
438
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
727 When on, Vim will change the current working directory whenever you
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
728 open a file, switch buffers, delete a buffer or open/close a window.
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
729 It will change to the directory containing the file which was opened
59b7b7e99c95 updated for version 7.0113
vimboss
parents: 435
diff changeset
730 or selected.
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
731 Note: When this option is on some plugins may not work.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
732
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
733 *'arabic'* *'arab'* *'noarabic'* *'noarab'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
734 'arabic' 'arab' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
735 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
736 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
737 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
738 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
739 This option can be set to start editing Arabic text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
740 Setting this option will:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
741 - Set the 'rightleft' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
742 - Set the 'arabicshape' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
743 - Set the 'keymap' option to "arabic"; in Insert mode CTRL-^ toggles
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
744 between typing English and Arabic key mapping.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
745 - Set the 'delcombine' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
746 Note that 'encoding' must be "utf-8" for working with Arabic text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
747
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
748 Resetting this option will:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
749 - Reset the 'rightleft' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
750 - Disable the use of 'keymap' (without changing its value).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
751 Note that 'arabicshape' and 'delcombine' are not reset (it is a global
3557
9cb3a75a20b9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3513
diff changeset
752 option).
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
753 Also see |arabic.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
754
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
755 *'arabicshape'* *'arshape'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
756 *'noarabicshape'* *'noarshape'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
757 'arabicshape' 'arshape' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
758 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
759 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
760 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
761 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
762 When on and 'termbidi' is off, the required visual character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
763 corrections that need to take place for displaying the Arabic language
3893
c3036f1dca68 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3750
diff changeset
764 take effect. Shaping, in essence, gets enabled; the term is a broad
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
765 one which encompasses:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
766 a) the changing/morphing of characters based on their location
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
767 within a word (initial, medial, final and stand-alone).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
768 b) the enabling of the ability to compose characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
769 c) the enabling of the required combining of some characters
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
770 When disabled the display shows each character's true stand-alone
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
771 form.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
772 Arabic is a complex language which requires other settings, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
773 further details see |arabic.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
774
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
775 *'autoindent'* *'ai'* *'noautoindent'* *'noai'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
776 'autoindent' 'ai' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
777 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
778 Copy indent from current line when starting a new line (typing <CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
779 in Insert mode or when using the "o" or "O" command). If you do not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
780 type anything on the new line except <BS> or CTRL-D and then type
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
781 <Esc>, CTRL-O or <CR>, the indent is deleted again. Moving the cursor
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
782 to another line has the same effect, unless the 'I' flag is included
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
783 in 'cpoptions'.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
784 When autoindent is on, formatting (with the "gq" command or when you
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
785 reach 'textwidth' in Insert mode) uses the indentation of the first
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
786 line.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
787 When 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is on the indent is changed in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
788 a different way.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
789 The 'autoindent' option is reset when the 'paste' option is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
790 {small difference from Vi: After the indent is deleted when typing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
791 <Esc> or <CR>, the cursor position when moving up or down is after the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
792 deleted indent; Vi puts the cursor somewhere in the deleted indent}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
793
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
794 *'autoread'* *'ar'* *'noautoread'* *'noar'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
795 'autoread' 'ar' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
796 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
797 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
798 When a file has been detected to have been changed outside of Vim and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
799 it has not been changed inside of Vim, automatically read it again.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
800 When the file has been deleted this is not done. |timestamp|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
801 If this option has a local value, use this command to switch back to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
802 using the global value: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
803 :set autoread<
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
804 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
805 *'autowrite'* *'aw'* *'noautowrite'* *'noaw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
806 'autowrite' 'aw' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
807 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
808 Write the contents of the file, if it has been modified, on each
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
809 :next, :rewind, :last, :first, :previous, :stop, :suspend, :tag, :!,
864
bc620d6bdf06 updated for version 7.0g03
vimboss
parents: 859
diff changeset
810 :make, CTRL-] and CTRL-^ command; and when a :buffer, CTRL-O, CTRL-I,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
811 '{A-Z0-9}, or `{A-Z0-9} command takes one to another file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
812 Note that for some commands the 'autowrite' option is not used, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
813 'autowriteall' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
814
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
815 *'autowriteall'* *'awa'* *'noautowriteall'* *'noawa'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
816 'autowriteall' 'awa' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
817 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
818 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
819 Like 'autowrite', but also used for commands ":edit", ":enew", ":quit",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
820 ":qall", ":exit", ":xit", ":recover" and closing the Vim window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
821 Setting this option also implies that Vim behaves like 'autowrite' has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
822 been set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
823
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
824 *'background'* *'bg'*
2826
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
825 'background' 'bg' string (default "dark" or "light", see below)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
826 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
827 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
828 When set to "dark", Vim will try to use colors that look good on a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
829 dark background. When set to "light", Vim will try to use colors that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
830 look good on a light background. Any other value is illegal.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
831 Vim tries to set the default value according to the terminal used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
832 This will not always be correct.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
833 Setting this option does not change the background color, it tells Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
834 what the background color looks like. For changing the background
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
835 color, see |:hi-normal|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
836
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
837 When 'background' is set Vim will adjust the default color groups for
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
838 the new value. But the colors used for syntax highlighting will not
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
839 change. *g:colors_name*
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
840 When a color scheme is loaded (the "g:colors_name" variable is set)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
841 setting 'background' will cause the color scheme to be reloaded. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
842 the color scheme adjusts to the value of 'background' this will work.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
843 However, if the color scheme sets 'background' itself the effect may
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
844 be undone. First delete the "g:colors_name" variable when needed.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
845
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
846 When setting 'background' to the default value with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
847 :set background&
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
848 < Vim will guess the value. In the GUI this should work correctly,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
849 in other cases Vim might not be able to guess the right value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
850
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
851 When starting the GUI, the default value for 'background' will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
852 "light". When the value is not set in the .gvimrc, and Vim detects
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
853 that the background is actually quite dark, 'background' is set to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
854 "dark". But this happens only AFTER the .gvimrc file has been read
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
855 (because the window needs to be opened to find the actual background
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
856 color). To get around this, force the GUI window to be opened by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
857 putting a ":gui" command in the .gvimrc file, before where the value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
858 of 'background' is used (e.g., before ":syntax on").
2826
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
859
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
860 For MS-DOS, Windows and OS/2 the default is "dark".
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
861 For other systems "dark" is used when 'term' is "linux",
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
862 "screen.linux", "cygwin" or "putty", or $COLORFGBG suggests a dark
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
863 background. Otherwise the default is "light".
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
864
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
865 Normally this option would be set in the .vimrc file. Possibly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
866 depending on the terminal name. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
867 :if &term == "pcterm"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
868 : set background=dark
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
869 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
870 < When this option is set, the default settings for the highlight groups
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
871 will change. To use other settings, place ":highlight" commands AFTER
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
872 the setting of the 'background' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
873 This option is also used in the "$VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim" file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
874 to select the colors for syntax highlighting. After changing this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
875 option, you must load syntax.vim again to see the result. This can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
876 done with ":syntax on".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
877
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
878 *'backspace'* *'bs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
879 'backspace' 'bs' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
880 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
881 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
882 Influences the working of <BS>, <Del>, CTRL-W and CTRL-U in Insert
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
883 mode. This is a list of items, separated by commas. Each item allows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
884 a way to backspace over something:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
885 value effect ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
886 indent allow backspacing over autoindent
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
887 eol allow backspacing over line breaks (join lines)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
888 start allow backspacing over the start of insert; CTRL-W and CTRL-U
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
889 stop once at the start of insert.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
890
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
891 When the value is empty, Vi compatible backspacing is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
892
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
893 For backwards compatibility with version 5.4 and earlier:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
894 value effect ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
895 0 same as ":set backspace=" (Vi compatible)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
896 1 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
897 2 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol,start"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
898
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
899 See |:fixdel| if your <BS> or <Del> key does not do what you want.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
900 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
901
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
902 *'backup'* *'bk'* *'nobackup'* *'nobk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
903 'backup' 'bk' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
904 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
905 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
906 Make a backup before overwriting a file. Leave it around after the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
907 file has been successfully written. If you do not want to keep the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
908 backup file, but you do want a backup while the file is being
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
909 written, reset this option and set the 'writebackup' option (this is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
910 the default). If you do not want a backup file at all reset both
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
911 options (use this if your file system is almost full). See the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
912 |backup-table| for more explanations.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
913 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
914 When 'patchmode' is set, the backup may be renamed to become the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
915 oldest version of a file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
916 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
917
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
918 *'backupcopy'* *'bkc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
919 'backupcopy' 'bkc' string (Vi default for Unix: "yes", otherwise: "auto")
6243
54194bd6ed60 updated for version 7.4.456
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6213
diff changeset
920 global or local to buffer |global-local|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
921 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
922 When writing a file and a backup is made, this option tells how it's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
923 done. This is a comma separated list of words.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
924
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
925 The main values are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
926 "yes" make a copy of the file and overwrite the original one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
927 "no" rename the file and write a new one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
928 "auto" one of the previous, what works best
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
929
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
930 Extra values that can be combined with the ones above are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
931 "breaksymlink" always break symlinks when writing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
932 "breakhardlink" always break hardlinks when writing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
933
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
934 Making a copy and overwriting the original file:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
935 - Takes extra time to copy the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
936 + When the file has special attributes, is a (hard/symbolic) link or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
937 has a resource fork, all this is preserved.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
938 - When the file is a link the backup will have the name of the link,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
939 not of the real file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
940
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
941 Renaming the file and writing a new one:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
942 + It's fast.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
943 - Sometimes not all attributes of the file can be copied to the new
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
944 file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
945 - When the file is a link the new file will not be a link.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
946
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
947 The "auto" value is the middle way: When Vim sees that renaming file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
948 is possible without side effects (the attributes can be passed on and
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
949 the file is not a link) that is used. When problems are expected, a
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
950 copy will be made.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
951
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
952 The "breaksymlink" and "breakhardlink" values can be used in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
953 combination with any of "yes", "no" and "auto". When included, they
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
954 force Vim to always break either symbolic or hard links by doing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
955 exactly what the "no" option does, renaming the original file to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
956 become the backup and writing a new file in its place. This can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
957 useful for example in source trees where all the files are symbolic or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
958 hard links and any changes should stay in the local source tree, not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
959 be propagated back to the original source.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
960 *crontab*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
961 One situation where "no" and "auto" will cause problems: A program
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
962 that opens a file, invokes Vim to edit that file, and then tests if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
963 the open file was changed (through the file descriptor) will check the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
964 backup file instead of the newly created file. "crontab -e" is an
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
965 example.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
966
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
967 When a copy is made, the original file is truncated and then filled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
968 with the new text. This means that protection bits, owner and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
969 symbolic links of the original file are unmodified. The backup file
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
970 however, is a new file, owned by the user who edited the file. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
971 group of the backup is set to the group of the original file. If this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
972 fails, the protection bits for the group are made the same as for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
973 others.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
974
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
975 When the file is renamed this is the other way around: The backup has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
976 the same attributes of the original file, and the newly written file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
977 is owned by the current user. When the file was a (hard/symbolic)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
978 link, the new file will not! That's why the "auto" value doesn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
979 rename when the file is a link. The owner and group of the newly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
980 written file will be set to the same ones as the original file, but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
981 the system may refuse to do this. In that case the "auto" value will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
982 again not rename the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
983
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
984 *'backupdir'* *'bdir'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
985 'backupdir' 'bdir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
5555
7818ca6de3d0 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5487
diff changeset
986 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:/tmp,c:/temp"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
987 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,~/")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
988 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
989 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
990 List of directories for the backup file, separated with commas.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
991 - The backup file will be created in the first directory in the list
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
992 where this is possible. The directory must exist, Vim will not
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
993 create it for you.
4186
7ffc704cb7c1 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4159
diff changeset
994 - Empty means that no backup file will be created ( 'patchmode' is
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
995 impossible!). Writing may fail because of this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
996 - A directory "." means to put the backup file in the same directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
997 as the edited file.
33
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
998 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
999 put the backup file relative to where the edited file is. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1000 leading "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1001 ("." inside a directory name has no special meaning).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1002 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1003 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1004 name, precede it with a backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1005 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1006 - A directory name may end in an '/'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1007 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1008 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1009 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1010 :set bdir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1011 < - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1012 of the option is removed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1013 See also 'backup' and 'writebackup' options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1014 If you want to hide your backup files on Unix, consider this value: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1015 :set backupdir=./.backup,~/.backup,.,/tmp
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1016 < You must create a ".backup" directory in each directory and in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1017 home directory for this to work properly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1018 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1019 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1020 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1021 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1022 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1023
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1024 *'backupext'* *'bex'* *E589*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1025 'backupext' 'bex' string (default "~", for VMS: "_")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1026 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1027 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1028 String which is appended to a file name to make the name of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1029 backup file. The default is quite unusual, because this avoids
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1030 accidentally overwriting existing files with a backup file. You might
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1031 prefer using ".bak", but make sure that you don't have files with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1032 ".bak" that you want to keep.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
1033 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1034
26
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
1035 If you like to keep a lot of backups, you could use a BufWritePre
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
1036 autocommand to change 'backupext' just before writing the file to
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
1037 include a timestamp. >
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
1038 :au BufWritePre * let &bex = '-' . strftime("%Y%b%d%X") . '~'
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
1039 < Use 'backupdir' to put the backup in a different directory.
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 23
diff changeset
1040
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1041 *'backupskip'* *'bsk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1042 'backupskip' 'bsk' string (default: "/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1043 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1044 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1045 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1046 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1047 A list of file patterns. When one of the patterns matches with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1048 name of the file which is written, no backup file is created. Both
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1049 the specified file name and the full path name of the file are used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1050 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1051 Watch out for special characters, see |option-backslash|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1052 When $TMPDIR, $TMP or $TEMP is not defined, it is not used for the
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
1053 default value. "/tmp/*" is only used for Unix.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1054
3513
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
1055 WARNING: Not having a backup file means that when Vim fails to write
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
1056 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
1057 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only disable
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
1058 backups if you don't care about losing the file.
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
1059
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1060 Note that environment variables are not expanded. If you want to use
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1061 $HOME you must expand it explicitly, e.g.: >
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1062 :let backupskip = escape(expand('$HOME'), '\') . '/tmp/*'
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1063
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1064 < Note that the default also makes sure that "crontab -e" works (when a
557
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
1065 backup would be made by renaming the original file crontab won't see
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
1066 the newly created file). Also see 'backupcopy' and |crontab|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1067
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1068 *'balloondelay'* *'bdlay'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1069 'balloondelay' 'bdlay' number (default: 600)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1070 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1071 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1072 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1073 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1074 Delay in milliseconds before a balloon may pop up. See |balloon-eval|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1075
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1076 *'ballooneval'* *'beval'* *'noballooneval'* *'nobeval'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1077 'ballooneval' 'beval' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1078 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1079 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1080 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1081 feature}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1082 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1083
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1084 *'balloonexpr'* *'bexpr'*
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1085 'balloonexpr' 'bexpr' string (default "")
790
c8680debe1cc updated for version 7.0230
vimboss
parents: 782
diff changeset
1086 global or local to buffer |global-local|
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1087 {not in Vi}
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1088 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1089 feature}
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
1090 Expression for text to show in evaluation balloon. It is only used
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
1091 when 'ballooneval' is on. These variables can be used:
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1092
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1093 v:beval_bufnr number of the buffer in which balloon is going to show
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1094 v:beval_winnr number of the window
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1095 v:beval_lnum line number
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1096 v:beval_col column number (byte index)
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1097 v:beval_text word under or after the mouse pointer
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1098
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1099 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects!
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1100 Example: >
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1101 function! MyBalloonExpr()
435
73f016dbb279 updated for version 7.0112
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
1102 return 'Cursor is at line ' . v:beval_lnum .
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1103 \', column ' . v:beval_col .
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1104 \ ' of file ' . bufname(v:beval_bufnr) .
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1105 \ ' on word "' . v:beval_text . '"'
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1106 endfunction
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1107 set bexpr=MyBalloonExpr()
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1108 set ballooneval
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1109 <
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1110 NOTE: The balloon is displayed only if the cursor is on a text
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1111 character. If the result of evaluating 'balloonexpr' is not empty,
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1112 Vim does not try to send a message to an external debugger (Netbeans
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1113 or Sun Workshop).
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
1114
3682
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
1115 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
1116 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
1117
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
1118 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
1119 evaluating 'balloonexpr' |textlock|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
1120
446
7472c565592a updated for version 7.0117
vimboss
parents: 438
diff changeset
1121 To check whether line breaks in the balloon text work use this check: >
435
73f016dbb279 updated for version 7.0112
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
1122 if has("balloon_multiline")
714
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
1123 < When they are supported "\n" characters will start a new line. If the
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
1124 expression evaluates to a |List| this is equal to using each List item
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
1125 as a string and putting "\n" in between them.
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
1126
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1127 *'binary'* *'bin'* *'nobinary'* *'nobin'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1128 'binary' 'bin' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1129 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1130 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1131 This option should be set before editing a binary file. You can also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1132 use the |-b| Vim argument. When this option is switched on a few
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1133 options will be changed (also when it already was on):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1134 'textwidth' will be set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1135 'wrapmargin' will be set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1136 'modeline' will be off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1137 'expandtab' will be off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1138 Also, 'fileformat' and 'fileformats' options will not be used, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1139 file is read and written like 'fileformat' was "unix" (a single <NL>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1140 separates lines).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1141 The 'fileencoding' and 'fileencodings' options will not be used, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1142 file is read without conversion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1143 NOTE: When you start editing a(nother) file while the 'bin' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1144 on, settings from autocommands may change the settings again (e.g.,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1145 'textwidth'), causing trouble when editing. You might want to set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1146 'bin' again when the file has been loaded.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1147 The previous values of these options are remembered and restored when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1148 'bin' is switched from on to off. Each buffer has its own set of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1149 saved option values.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1150 To edit a file with 'binary' set you can use the |++bin| argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1151 This avoids you have to do ":set bin", which would have effect for all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1152 files you edit.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1153 When writing a file the <EOL> for the last line is only written if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1154 there was one in the original file (normally Vim appends an <EOL> to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1155 the last line if there is none; this would make the file longer). See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1156 the 'endofline' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1157
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1158 *'bioskey'* *'biosk'* *'nobioskey'* *'nobiosk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1159 'bioskey' 'biosk' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1160 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1161 {not in Vi} {only for MS-DOS}
446
7472c565592a updated for version 7.0117
vimboss
parents: 438
diff changeset
1162 When on the BIOS is called to obtain a keyboard character. This works
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1163 better to detect CTRL-C, but only works for the console. When using a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1164 terminal over a serial port reset this option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1165 Also see |'conskey'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1166
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1167 *'bomb'* *'nobomb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1168 'bomb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1169 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1170 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1171 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1172 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1173 When writing a file and the following conditions are met, a BOM (Byte
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1174 Order Mark) is prepended to the file:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1175 - this option is on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1176 - the 'binary' option is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1177 - 'fileencoding' is "utf-8", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" or one of the little/big
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1178 endian variants.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1179 Some applications use the BOM to recognize the encoding of the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1180 Often used for UCS-2 files on MS-Windows. For other applications it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1181 causes trouble, for example: "cat file1 file2" makes the BOM of file2
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
1182 appear halfway the resulting file. Gcc doesn't accept a BOM.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1183 When Vim reads a file and 'fileencodings' starts with "ucs-bom", a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1184 check for the presence of the BOM is done and 'bomb' set accordingly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1185 Unless 'binary' is set, it is removed from the first line, so that you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1186 don't see it when editing. When you don't change the options, the BOM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1187 will be restored when writing the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1188
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1189 *'breakat'* *'brk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1190 'breakat' 'brk' string (default " ^I!@*-+;:,./?")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1191 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1192 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
1193 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1194 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1195 This option lets you choose which characters might cause a line
500
4772a5e3f9fa updated for version 7.0138
vimboss
parents: 493
diff changeset
1196 break if 'linebreak' is on. Only works for ASCII and also for 8-bit
4772a5e3f9fa updated for version 7.0138
vimboss
parents: 493
diff changeset
1197 characters when 'encoding' is an 8-bit encoding.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1198
6009
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1199 *'breakindent'* *'bri'*
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1200 'breakindent' 'bri' boolean (default off)
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1201 local to window
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1202 {not in Vi}
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1203 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1204 feature}
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1205 Every wrapped line will continue visually indented (same amount of
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1206 space as the beginning of that line), thus preserving horizontal blocks
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1207 of text.
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1208
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1209 *'breakindentopt'* *'briopt'*
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1210 'breakindentopt' 'briopt' string (default empty)
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1211 local to window
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1212 {not in Vi}
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1213 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1214 feature}
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1215 Settings for 'breakindent'. It can consist of the following optional
6026
d42a1d3b74d4 updated for version 7.4.353
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6009
diff changeset
1216 items and must be separated by a comma:
6009
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1217 min:{n} Minimum text width that will be kept after
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1218 applying 'breakindent', even if the resulting
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1219 text should normally be narrower. This prevents
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1220 text indented almost to the right window border
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1221 occupying lot of vertical space when broken.
6026
d42a1d3b74d4 updated for version 7.4.353
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6009
diff changeset
1222 shift:{n} After applying 'breakindent', the wrapped line's
d42a1d3b74d4 updated for version 7.4.353
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6009
diff changeset
1223 beginning will be shifted by the given number of
d42a1d3b74d4 updated for version 7.4.353
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6009
diff changeset
1224 characters. It permits dynamic French paragraph
6009
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1225 indentation (negative) or emphasizing the line
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1226 continuation (positive).
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1227 sbr Display the 'showbreak' value before applying the
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1228 additional indent.
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1229 The default value for min is 20 and shift is 0.
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
1230
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1231 *'browsedir'* *'bsdir'*
29
ac33b7c03fac updated for version 7.0018
vimboss
parents: 26
diff changeset
1232 'browsedir' 'bsdir' string (default: "last")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1233 global
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
1234 {not in Vi} {only for Motif, Athena, GTK, Mac and
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
1235 Win32 GUI}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1236 Which directory to use for the file browser:
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
1237 last Use same directory as with last file browser, where a
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
1238 file was opened or saved.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1239 buffer Use the directory of the related buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1240 current Use the current directory.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1241 {path} Use the specified directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1242
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1243 *'bufhidden'* *'bh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1244 'bufhidden' 'bh' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1245 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1246 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1247 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1248 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1249 This option specifies what happens when a buffer is no longer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1250 displayed in a window:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1251 <empty> follow the global 'hidden' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1252 hide hide the buffer (don't unload it), also when 'hidden'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1253 is not set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1254 unload unload the buffer, also when 'hidden' is set or using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1255 |:hide|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1256 delete delete the buffer from the buffer list, also when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1257 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1258 |:bdelete|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1259 wipe wipe out the buffer from the buffer list, also when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1260 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1261 |:bwipeout|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1262
82
366d9947baf2 updated for version 7.0033
vimboss
parents: 75
diff changeset
1263 CAREFUL: when "unload", "delete" or "wipe" is used changes in a buffer
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
1264 are lost without a warning. Also, these values may break autocommands
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
1265 that switch between buffers temporarily.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1266 This option is used together with 'buftype' and 'swapfile' to specify
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1267 special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1268
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1269 *'buflisted'* *'bl'* *'nobuflisted'* *'nobl'* *E85*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1270 'buflisted' 'bl' boolean (default: on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1271 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1272 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1273 When this option is set, the buffer shows up in the buffer list. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1274 it is reset it is not used for ":bnext", "ls", the Buffers menu, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1275 This option is reset by Vim for buffers that are only used to remember
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1276 a file name or marks. Vim sets it when starting to edit a buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1277 But not when moving to a buffer with ":buffer".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1278
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1279 *'buftype'* *'bt'* *E382*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1280 'buftype' 'bt' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1281 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1282 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1283 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1284 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1285 The value of this option specifies the type of a buffer:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1286 <empty> normal buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1287 nofile buffer which is not related to a file and will not be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1288 written
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1289 nowrite buffer which will not be written
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1290 acwrite buffer which will always be written with BufWriteCmd
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
1291 autocommands. {not available when compiled without the
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1292 |+autocmd| feature}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1293 quickfix quickfix buffer, contains list of errors |:cwindow|
648
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1294 or list of locations |:lwindow|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1295 help help buffer (you are not supposed to set this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1296 manually)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1297
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1298 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'swapfile' to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1299 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1300
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1301 Be careful with changing this option, it can have many side effects!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1302
648
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1303 A "quickfix" buffer is only used for the error list and the location
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1304 list. This value is set by the |:cwindow| and |:lwindow| commands and
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1305 you are not supposed to change it.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1306
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1307 "nofile" and "nowrite" buffers are similar:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1308 both: The buffer is not to be written to disk, ":w" doesn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1309 work (":w filename" does work though).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1310 both: The buffer is never considered to be |'modified'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1311 There is no warning when the changes will be lost, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1312 example when you quit Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1313 both: A swap file is only created when using too much memory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1314 (when 'swapfile' has been reset there is never a swap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1315 file).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1316 nofile only: The buffer name is fixed, it is not handled like a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1317 file name. It is not modified in response to a |:cd|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1318 command.
6647
3af822eb4da5 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6583
diff changeset
1319 both: When using ":e bufname" and already editing "bufname"
3af822eb4da5 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6583
diff changeset
1320 the buffer is made empty and autocommands are
3af822eb4da5 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6583
diff changeset
1321 triggered as usual for |:edit|.
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1322 *E676*
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1323 "acwrite" implies that the buffer name is not related to a file, like
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1324 "nofile", but it will be written. Thus, in contrast to "nofile" and
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1325 "nowrite", ":w" does work and a modified buffer can't be abandoned
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1326 without saving. For writing there must be matching |BufWriteCmd|,
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
1327 |FileWriteCmd| or |FileAppendCmd| autocommands.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1328
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1329 *'casemap'* *'cmp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1330 'casemap' 'cmp' string (default: "internal,keepascii")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1331 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1332 {not in Vi}
804
db73a88f4c2d updated for version 7.0b01
vimboss
parents: 799
diff changeset
1333 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
db73a88f4c2d updated for version 7.0b01
vimboss
parents: 799
diff changeset
1334 feature}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1335 Specifies details about changing the case of letters. It may contain
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1336 these words, separated by a comma:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1337 internal Use internal case mapping functions, the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1338 locale does not change the case mapping. This only
493
06364aa0d597 updated for version 7.0135
vimboss
parents: 488
diff changeset
1339 matters when 'encoding' is a Unicode encoding,
06364aa0d597 updated for version 7.0135
vimboss
parents: 488
diff changeset
1340 "latin1" or "iso-8859-15". When "internal" is
06364aa0d597 updated for version 7.0135
vimboss
parents: 488
diff changeset
1341 omitted, the towupper() and towlower() system library
06364aa0d597 updated for version 7.0135
vimboss
parents: 488
diff changeset
1342 functions are used when available.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1343 keepascii For the ASCII characters (0x00 to 0x7f) use the US
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1344 case mapping, the current locale is not effective.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1345 This probably only matters for Turkish.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1346
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1347 *'cdpath'* *'cd'* *E344* *E346*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1348 'cdpath' 'cd' string (default: equivalent to $CDPATH or ",,")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1349 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1350 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1351 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1352 |+file_in_path| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1353 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1354 |:cd| and |:lcd| commands, provided that the directory being searched
1668
0b796e045c42 updated for version 7.2b-000
vimboss
parents: 1621
diff changeset
1355 for has a relative path, not an absolute part starting with "/", "./"
0b796e045c42 updated for version 7.2b-000
vimboss
parents: 1621
diff changeset
1356 or "../", the 'cdpath' option is not used then.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1357 The 'cdpath' option's value has the same form and semantics as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1358 |'path'|. Also see |file-searching|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1359 The default value is taken from $CDPATH, with a "," prepended to look
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1360 in the current directory first.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1361 If the default value taken from $CDPATH is not what you want, include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1362 a modified version of the following command in your vimrc file to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1363 override it: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1364 :let &cdpath = ',' . substitute(substitute($CDPATH, '[, ]', '\\\0', 'g'), ':', ',', 'g')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1365 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1366 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1367 (parts of 'cdpath' can be passed to the shell to expand file names).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1368
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1369 *'cedit'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1370 'cedit' string (Vi default: "", Vim default: CTRL-F)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1371 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1372 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1373 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1374 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1375 The key used in Command-line Mode to open the command-line window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1376 The default is CTRL-F when 'compatible' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1377 Only non-printable keys are allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1378 The key can be specified as a single character, but it is difficult to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1379 type. The preferred way is to use the <> notation. Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1380 :set cedit=<C-Y>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1381 :set cedit=<Esc>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1382 < |Nvi| also has this option, but it only uses the first character.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1383 See |cmdwin|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1384
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1385 *'charconvert'* *'ccv'* *E202* *E214* *E513*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1386 'charconvert' 'ccv' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1387 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1388 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
1389 and |+eval| features}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1390 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1391 An expression that is used for character encoding conversion. It is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1392 evaluated when a file that is to be read or has been written has a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1393 different encoding from what is desired.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1394 'charconvert' is not used when the internal iconv() function is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1395 supported and is able to do the conversion. Using iconv() is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1396 preferred, because it is much faster.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1397 'charconvert' is not used when reading stdin |--|, because there is no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1398 file to convert from. You will have to save the text in a file first.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1399 The expression must return zero or an empty string for success,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1400 non-zero for failure.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1401 The possible encoding names encountered are in 'encoding'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1402 Additionally, names given in 'fileencodings' and 'fileencoding' are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1403 used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1404 Conversion between "latin1", "unicode", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" and "utf-8"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1405 is done internally by Vim, 'charconvert' is not used for this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1406 'charconvert' is also used to convert the viminfo file, if the 'c'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1407 flag is present in 'viminfo'. Also used for Unicode conversion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1408 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1409 set charconvert=CharConvert()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1410 fun CharConvert()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1411 system("recode "
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1412 \ . v:charconvert_from . ".." . v:charconvert_to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1413 \ . " <" . v:fname_in . " >" v:fname_out)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1414 return v:shell_error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1415 endfun
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1416 < The related Vim variables are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1417 v:charconvert_from name of the current encoding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1418 v:charconvert_to name of the desired encoding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1419 v:fname_in name of the input file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1420 v:fname_out name of the output file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1421 Note that v:fname_in and v:fname_out will never be the same.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1422 Note that v:charconvert_from and v:charconvert_to may be different
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1423 from 'encoding'. Vim internally uses UTF-8 instead of UCS-2 or UCS-4.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1424 Encryption is not done by Vim when using 'charconvert'. If you want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1425 to encrypt the file after conversion, 'charconvert' should take care
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1426 of this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1427 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1428 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1429
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1430 *'cindent'* *'cin'* *'nocindent'* *'nocin'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1431 'cindent' 'cin' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1432 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1433 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1434 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1435 feature}
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
1436 Enables automatic C program indenting. See 'cinkeys' to set the keys
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1437 that trigger reindenting in insert mode and 'cinoptions' to set your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1438 preferred indent style.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1439 If 'indentexpr' is not empty, it overrules 'cindent'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1440 If 'lisp' is not on and both 'indentexpr' and 'equalprg' are empty,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1441 the "=" operator indents using this algorithm rather than calling an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1442 external program.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1443 See |C-indenting|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1444 When you don't like the way 'cindent' works, try the 'smartindent'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1445 option or 'indentexpr'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1446 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1447 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1448
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1449 *'cinkeys'* *'cink'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1450 'cinkeys' 'cink' string (default "0{,0},0),:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1451 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1452 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1453 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1454 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1455 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1456 the current line. Only used if 'cindent' is on and 'indentexpr' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1457 empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1458 For the format of this option see |cinkeys-format|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1459 See |C-indenting|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1460
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1461 *'cinoptions'* *'cino'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1462 'cinoptions' 'cino' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1463 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1464 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1465 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1466 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1467 The 'cinoptions' affect the way 'cindent' reindents lines in a C
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1468 program. See |cinoptions-values| for the values of this option, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1469 |C-indenting| for info on C indenting in general.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1470
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1471
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1472 *'cinwords'* *'cinw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1473 'cinwords' 'cinw' string (default "if,else,while,do,for,switch")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1474 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1475 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1476 {not available when compiled without both the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1477 |+cindent| and the |+smartindent| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1478 These keywords start an extra indent in the next line when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1479 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is set. For 'cindent' this is only done at
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1480 an appropriate place (inside {}).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1481 Note that 'ignorecase' isn't used for 'cinwords'. If case doesn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1482 matter, include the keyword both the uppercase and lowercase:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1483 "if,If,IF".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1484
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1485 *'clipboard'* *'cb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1486 'clipboard' 'cb' string (default "autoselect,exclude:cons\|linux"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1487 for X-windows, "" otherwise)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1488 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1489 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1490 {only in GUI versions or when the |+xterm_clipboard|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1491 feature is included}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1492 This option is a list of comma separated names.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1493 These names are recognized:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1494
3674
b9aa7fb4a928 updated for version 7.3.597
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3557
diff changeset
1495 *clipboard-unnamed*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1496 unnamed When included, Vim will use the clipboard register '*'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1497 for all yank, delete, change and put operations which
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1498 would normally go to the unnamed register. When a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1499 register is explicitly specified, it will always be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1500 used regardless of whether "unnamed" is in 'clipboard'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1501 or not. The clipboard register can always be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1502 explicitly accessed using the "* notation. Also see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1503 |gui-clipboard|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1504
3682
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
1505 *clipboard-unnamedplus*
4119
61bcafd8c648 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4073
diff changeset
1506 unnamedplus A variant of the "unnamed" flag which uses the
61bcafd8c648 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4073
diff changeset
1507 clipboard register '+' (|quoteplus|) instead of
61bcafd8c648 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4073
diff changeset
1508 register '*' for all yank, delete, change and put
61bcafd8c648 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4073
diff changeset
1509 operations which would normally go to the unnamed
61bcafd8c648 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4073
diff changeset
1510 register. When "unnamed" is also included to the
61bcafd8c648 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4073
diff changeset
1511 option, yank operations (but not delete, change or
61bcafd8c648 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4073
diff changeset
1512 put) will additionally copy the text into register
61bcafd8c648 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4073
diff changeset
1513 '*'.
2662
916c90b37ea9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2654
diff changeset
1514 Only available with the |+X11| feature.
2654
2b475ed86e64 updated for version 7.3.074
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2652
diff changeset
1515 Availability can be checked with: >
2b475ed86e64 updated for version 7.3.074
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2652
diff changeset
1516 if has('unnamedplus')
2b475ed86e64 updated for version 7.3.074
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2652
diff changeset
1517 <
3682
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
1518 *clipboard-autoselect*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1519 autoselect Works like the 'a' flag in 'guioptions': If present,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1520 then whenever Visual mode is started, or the Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1521 area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1522 windowing system's global selection or put the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1523 selected text on the clipboard used by the selection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1524 register "*. See |guioptions_a| and |quotestar| for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1525 details. When the GUI is active, the 'a' flag in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1526 'guioptions' is used, when the GUI is not active, this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1527 "autoselect" flag is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1528 Also applies to the modeless selection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1529
3674
b9aa7fb4a928 updated for version 7.3.597
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3557
diff changeset
1530 *clipboard-autoselectplus*
b9aa7fb4a928 updated for version 7.3.597
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3557
diff changeset
1531 autoselectplus Like "autoselect" but using the + register instead of
b9aa7fb4a928 updated for version 7.3.597
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3557
diff changeset
1532 the * register. Compare to the 'P' flag in
b9aa7fb4a928 updated for version 7.3.597
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3557
diff changeset
1533 'guioptions'.
b9aa7fb4a928 updated for version 7.3.597
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3557
diff changeset
1534
b9aa7fb4a928 updated for version 7.3.597
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3557
diff changeset
1535 *clipboard-autoselectml*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1536 autoselectml Like "autoselect", but for the modeless selection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1537 only. Compare to the 'A' flag in 'guioptions'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1538
3674
b9aa7fb4a928 updated for version 7.3.597
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3557
diff changeset
1539 *clipboard-html*
1904
062104a823df updated for version 7.2-201
vimboss
parents: 1811
diff changeset
1540 html When the clipboard contains HTML, use this when
062104a823df updated for version 7.2-201
vimboss
parents: 1811
diff changeset
1541 pasting. When putting text on the clipboard, mark it
062104a823df updated for version 7.2-201
vimboss
parents: 1811
diff changeset
1542 as HTML. This works to copy rendered HTML from
062104a823df updated for version 7.2-201
vimboss
parents: 1811
diff changeset
1543 Firefox, paste it as raw HTML in Vim, select the HTML
062104a823df updated for version 7.2-201
vimboss
parents: 1811
diff changeset
1544 in Vim and paste it in a rich edit box in Firefox.
2240
6b4879aea261 Add test for gettabvar() and settabvar().
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2220
diff changeset
1545 You probably want to add this only temporarily,
6b4879aea261 Add test for gettabvar() and settabvar().
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2220
diff changeset
1546 possibly use BufEnter autocommands.
1904
062104a823df updated for version 7.2-201
vimboss
parents: 1811
diff changeset
1547 Only supported for GTK version 2 and later.
062104a823df updated for version 7.2-201
vimboss
parents: 1811
diff changeset
1548 Only available with the |+multi_byte| feature.
062104a823df updated for version 7.2-201
vimboss
parents: 1811
diff changeset
1549
3674
b9aa7fb4a928 updated for version 7.3.597
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3557
diff changeset
1550 *clipboard-exclude*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1551 exclude:{pattern}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1552 Defines a pattern that is matched against the name of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1553 the terminal 'term'. If there is a match, no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1554 connection will be made to the X server. This is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1555 useful in this situation:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1556 - Running Vim in a console.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1557 - $DISPLAY is set to start applications on another
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1558 display.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1559 - You do not want to connect to the X server in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1560 console, but do want this in a terminal emulator.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1561 To never connect to the X server use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1562 exclude:.*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1563 < This has the same effect as using the |-X| argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1564 Note that when there is no connection to the X server
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1565 the window title won't be restored and the clipboard
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1566 cannot be accessed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1567 The value of 'magic' is ignored, {pattern} is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1568 interpreted as if 'magic' was on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1569 The rest of the option value will be used for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1570 {pattern}, this must be the last entry.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1571
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1572 *'cmdheight'* *'ch'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1573 'cmdheight' 'ch' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1574 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1575 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1576 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line. Helps avoiding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1577 |hit-enter| prompts.
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 819
diff changeset
1578 The value of this option is stored with the tab page, so that each tab
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 819
diff changeset
1579 page can have a different value.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1580
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1581 *'cmdwinheight'* *'cwh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1582 'cmdwinheight' 'cwh' number (default 7)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1583 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1584 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1585 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1586 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1587 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line window. |cmdwin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1588
2608
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1589 *'colorcolumn'* *'cc'*
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1590 'colorcolumn' 'cc' string (default "")
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1591 local to window
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1592 {not in Vi}
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1593 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1594 feature}
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1595 'colorcolumn' is a comma separated list of screen columns that are
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1596 highlighted with ColorColumn |hl-ColorColumn|. Useful to align
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1597 text. Will make screen redrawing slower.
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1598 The screen column can be an absolute number, or a number preceded with
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1599 '+' or '-', which is added to or subtracted from 'textwidth'. >
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1600
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1601 :set cc=+1 " highlight column after 'textwidth'
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1602 :set cc=+1,+2,+3 " highlight three columns after 'textwidth'
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1603 :hi ColorColumn ctermbg=lightgrey guibg=lightgrey
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1604 <
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1605 When 'textwidth' is zero then the items with '-' and '+' are not used.
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1606 A maximum of 256 columns are highlighted.
7d8af31066c8 Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2607
diff changeset
1607
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1608 *'columns'* *'co'* *E594*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1609 'columns' 'co' number (default 80 or terminal width)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1610 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1611 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1612 Number of columns of the screen. Normally this is set by the terminal
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
1613 initialization and does not have to be set by hand. Also see
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
1614 |posix-screen-size|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1615 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1616 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1617 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1618 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1619 number of columns of the display, the display may be messed up. For
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1620 the GUI it is always possible and Vim limits the number of columns to
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1621 what fits on the screen. You can use this command to get the widest
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1622 window possible: >
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1623 :set columns=9999
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1624 < Minimum value is 12, maximum value is 10000.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1625
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1626 *'comments'* *'com'* *E524* *E525*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1627 'comments' 'com' string (default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1628 "s1:/*,mb:*,ex:*/,://,b:#,:%,:XCOMM,n:>,fb:-")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1629 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1630 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1631 {not available when compiled without the |+comments|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1632 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1633 A comma separated list of strings that can start a comment line. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1634 |format-comments|. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1635 insert a space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1636
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1637 *'commentstring'* *'cms'* *E537*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1638 'commentstring' 'cms' string (default "/*%s*/")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1639 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1640 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1641 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1642 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1643 A template for a comment. The "%s" in the value is replaced with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1644 comment text. Currently only used to add markers for folding, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1645 |fold-marker|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1646
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1647 *'compatible'* *'cp'* *'nocompatible'* *'nocp'*
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
1648 'compatible' 'cp' boolean (default on, off when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc|
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
1649 file is found)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1650 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1651 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1652 This option has the effect of making Vim either more Vi-compatible, or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1653 make Vim behave in a more useful way.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1654 This is a special kind of option, because when it's set or reset,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1655 other options are also changed as a side effect. CAREFUL: Setting or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1656 resetting this option can have a lot of unexpected effects: Mappings
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1657 are interpreted in another way, undo behaves differently, etc. If you
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1658 set this option in your vimrc file, you should probably put it at the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1659 very start.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1660 By default this option is on and the Vi defaults are used for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1661 options. This default was chosen for those people who want to use Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1662 just like Vi, and don't even (want to) know about the 'compatible'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1663 option.
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
1664 When a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file is found while Vim is starting up,
378
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1665 this option is switched off, and all options that have not been
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1666 modified will be set to the Vim defaults. Effectively, this means
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
1667 that when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file exists, Vim will use the Vim
378
6b49757d378c updated for version 7.0098
vimboss
parents: 374
diff changeset
1668 defaults, otherwise it will use the Vi defaults. (Note: This doesn't
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1669 happen for the system-wide vimrc or gvimrc file, nor for a file given
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1670 with the |-u| argument). Also see |compatible-default| and
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1671 |posix-compliance|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1672 You can also set this option with the "-C" argument, and reset it with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1673 "-N". See |-C| and |-N|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1674 Switching this option off makes the Vim defaults be used for options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1675 that have a different Vi and Vim default value. See the options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1676 marked with a '+' below. Other options are not modified.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1677 At the moment this option is set, several other options will be set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1678 or reset to make Vim as Vi-compatible as possible. See the table
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1679 below. This can be used if you want to revert to Vi compatible
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1680 editing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1681 See also 'cpoptions'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1682
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1683 option + set value effect ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1684
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1685 'allowrevins' off no CTRL-_ command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1686 'backupcopy' Unix: "yes" backup file is a copy
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1687 others: "auto" copy or rename backup file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1688 'backspace' "" normal backspace
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1689 'backup' off no backup file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1690 'cindent' off no C code indentation
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1691 'cedit' + "" no key to open the |cmdwin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1692 'cpoptions' + (all flags) Vi-compatible flags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1693 'cscopetag' off don't use cscope for ":tag"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1694 'cscopetagorder' 0 see |cscopetagorder|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1695 'cscopeverbose' off see |cscopeverbose|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1696 'digraph' off no digraphs
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1697 'esckeys' + off no <Esc>-keys in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1698 'expandtab' off tabs not expanded to spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1699 'fileformats' + "" no automatic file format detection,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1700 "dos,unix" except for DOS, Windows and OS/2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1701 'formatoptions' + "vt" Vi compatible formatting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1702 'gdefault' off no default 'g' flag for ":s"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1703 'history' + 0 no commandline history
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1704 'hkmap' off no Hebrew keyboard mapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1705 'hkmapp' off no phonetic Hebrew keyboard mapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1706 'hlsearch' off no highlighting of search matches
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1707 'incsearch' off no incremental searching
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1708 'indentexpr' "" no indenting by expression
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1709 'insertmode' off do not start in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1710 'iskeyword' + "@,48-57,_" keywords contain alphanumeric
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1711 characters and '_'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1712 'joinspaces' on insert 2 spaces after period
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1713 'modeline' + off no modelines
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1714 'more' + off no pauses in listings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1715 'revins' off no reverse insert
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1716 'ruler' off no ruler
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1717 'scrolljump' 1 no jump scroll
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1718 'scrolloff' 0 no scroll offset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1719 'shiftround' off indent not rounded to shiftwidth
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1720 'shortmess' + "" no shortening of messages
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1721 'showcmd' + off command characters not shown
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1722 'showmode' + off current mode not shown
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1723 'smartcase' off no automatic ignore case switch
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1724 'smartindent' off no smart indentation
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1725 'smarttab' off no smart tab size
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1726 'softtabstop' 0 tabs are always 'tabstop' positions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1727 'startofline' on goto startofline with some commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1728 'tagrelative' + off tag file names are not relative
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1729 'textauto' + off no automatic textmode detection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1730 'textwidth' 0 no automatic line wrap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1731 'tildeop' off tilde is not an operator
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1732 'ttimeout' off no terminal timeout
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1733 'whichwrap' + "" left-right movements don't wrap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1734 'wildchar' + CTRL-E only when the current value is <Tab>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1735 use CTRL-E for cmdline completion
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
1736 'writebackup' on or off depends on the |+writebackup| feature
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1737
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1738 *'complete'* *'cpt'* *E535*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1739 'complete' 'cpt' string (default: ".,w,b,u,t,i")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1740 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1741 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1742 This option specifies how keyword completion |ins-completion| works
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1743 when CTRL-P or CTRL-N are used. It is also used for whole-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1744 completion |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-L|. It indicates the type of completion
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1745 and the places to scan. It is a comma separated list of flags:
4186
7ffc704cb7c1 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4159
diff changeset
1746 . scan the current buffer ( 'wrapscan' is ignored)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1747 w scan buffers from other windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1748 b scan other loaded buffers that are in the buffer list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1749 u scan the unloaded buffers that are in the buffer list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1750 U scan the buffers that are not in the buffer list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1751 k scan the files given with the 'dictionary' option
703
2fae45239fb3 updated for version 7.0212
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
1752 kspell use the currently active spell checking |spell|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1753 k{dict} scan the file {dict}. Several "k" flags can be given,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1754 patterns are valid too. For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1755 :set cpt=k/usr/dict/*,k~/spanish
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1756 < s scan the files given with the 'thesaurus' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1757 s{tsr} scan the file {tsr}. Several "s" flags can be given, patterns
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1758 are valid too.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1759 i scan current and included files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1760 d scan current and included files for defined name or macro
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1761 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-D|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1762 ] tag completion
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1763 t same as "]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1764
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1765 Unloaded buffers are not loaded, thus their autocmds |:autocmd| are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1766 not executed, this may lead to unexpected completions from some files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1767 (gzipped files for example). Unloaded buffers are not scanned for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1768 whole-line completion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1769
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1770 The default is ".,w,b,u,t,i", which means to scan:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1771 1. the current buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1772 2. buffers in other windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1773 3. other loaded buffers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1774 4. unloaded buffers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1775 5. tags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1776 6. included files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1777
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1778 As you can see, CTRL-N and CTRL-P can be used to do any 'iskeyword'-
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
1779 based expansion (e.g., dictionary |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|, included patterns
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
1780 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-I|, tags |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-]| and normal expansions).
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1781
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1782 *'completefunc'* *'cfu'*
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1783 'completefunc' 'cfu' string (default: empty)
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1784 local to buffer
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
1785 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
1786 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
1787 or |+insert_expand| features}
623
bd2fe62c9d77 updated for version 7.0178
vimboss
parents: 596
diff changeset
1788 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode completion
bd2fe62c9d77 updated for version 7.0178
vimboss
parents: 596
diff changeset
1789 with CTRL-X CTRL-U. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-U|
648
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1790 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
1791 invoked and what it should return.
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2625
diff changeset
1792 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2625
diff changeset
1793 security reasons.
14
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
1794
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1795 *'completeopt'* *'cot'*
730
44348703ab1b updated for version 7.0221
vimboss
parents: 717
diff changeset
1796 'completeopt' 'cot' string (default: "menu,preview")
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1797 global
766
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
1798 {not available when compiled without the
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
1799 |+insert_expand| feature}
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1800 {not in Vi}
665
21ab9abf0f08 updated for version 7.0196
vimboss
parents: 657
diff changeset
1801 A comma separated list of options for Insert mode completion
21ab9abf0f08 updated for version 7.0196
vimboss
parents: 657
diff changeset
1802 |ins-completion|. The supported values are:
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1803
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1804 menu Use a popup menu to show the possible completions. The
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1805 menu is only shown when there is more than one match and
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1806 sufficient colors are available. |ins-completion-menu|
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
1807
707
111b7dcc8a17 updated for version 7.0213
vimboss
parents: 703
diff changeset
1808 menuone Use the popup menu also when there is only one match.
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
1809 Useful when there is additional information about the
707
111b7dcc8a17 updated for version 7.0213
vimboss
parents: 703
diff changeset
1810 match, e.g., what file it comes from.
111b7dcc8a17 updated for version 7.0213
vimboss
parents: 703
diff changeset
1811
836
5a7843c57316 updated for version 7.0e02
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1812 longest Only insert the longest common text of the matches. If
5a7843c57316 updated for version 7.0e02
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1813 the menu is displayed you can use CTRL-L to add more
5a7843c57316 updated for version 7.0e02
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1814 characters. Whether case is ignored depends on the kind
5a7843c57316 updated for version 7.0e02
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1815 of completion. For buffer text the 'ignorecase' option is
5a7843c57316 updated for version 7.0e02
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1816 used.
665
21ab9abf0f08 updated for version 7.0196
vimboss
parents: 657
diff changeset
1817
730
44348703ab1b updated for version 7.0221
vimboss
parents: 717
diff changeset
1818 preview Show extra information about the currently selected
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1819 completion in the preview window. Only works in
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1820 combination with "menu" or "menuone".
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
1821
730
44348703ab1b updated for version 7.0221
vimboss
parents: 717
diff changeset
1822
2378
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1823 *'concealcursor'* *'cocu'*
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1824 'concealcursor' 'cocu' string (default: "")
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1825 local to window
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1826 {not in Vi}
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1827 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal|
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1828 feature}
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1829 Sets the modes in which text in the cursor line can also be concealed.
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1830 When the current mode is listed then concealing happens just like in
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1831 other lines.
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1832 n Normal mode
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1833 v Visual mode
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1834 i Insert mode
2382
3a5ededa240a Add the 'c' flag to 'concealcursor'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2380
diff changeset
1835 c Command line editing, for 'incsearch'
3a5ededa240a Add the 'c' flag to 'concealcursor'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2380
diff changeset
1836
2400
e6f1424dd66a Let 'v' flag in 'concealcursor' apply to all lines in the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2394
diff changeset
1837 'v' applies to all lines in the Visual area, not only the cursor.
2382
3a5ededa240a Add the 'c' flag to 'concealcursor'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2380
diff changeset
1838 A useful value is "nc". This is used in help files. So long as you
2378
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1839 are moving around text is concealed, but when starting to insert text
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1840 or selecting a Visual area the concealed text is displayed, so that
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1841 you can see what you are doing.
2380
b47748aa3236 Don't conceal text in lines inside the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2378
diff changeset
1842 Keep in mind that the cursor position is not always where it's
b47748aa3236 Don't conceal text in lines inside the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2378
diff changeset
1843 displayed. E.g., when moving vertically it may change column.
2378
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1844
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1845
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1846 'conceallevel' 'cole' *'conceallevel'* *'cole'*
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
1847 number (default 0)
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
1848 local to window
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
1849 {not in Vi}
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
1850 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal|
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
1851 feature}
2340
99c1eba60b2d Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2337
diff changeset
1852 Determine how text with the "conceal" syntax attribute |:syn-conceal|
99c1eba60b2d Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2337
diff changeset
1853 is shown:
99c1eba60b2d Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2337
diff changeset
1854
99c1eba60b2d Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2337
diff changeset
1855 Value Effect ~
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
1856 0 Text is shown normally
2426
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
1857 1 Each block of concealed text is replaced with one
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
1858 character. If the syntax item does not have a custom
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
1859 replacement character defined (see |:syn-cchar|) the
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
1860 character defined in 'listchars' is used (default is a
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
1861 space).
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
1862 It is highlighted with the "Conceal" highlight group.
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
1863 2 Concealed text is completely hidden unless it has a
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
1864 custom replacement character defined (see
2426
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
1865 |:syn-cchar|).
2349
586a459f3980 Never hide text for conceal in cursor line. Do hide when there is
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2348
diff changeset
1866 3 Concealed text is completely hidden.
586a459f3980 Never hide text for conceal in cursor line. Do hide when there is
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2348
diff changeset
1867
586a459f3980 Never hide text for conceal in cursor line. Do hide when there is
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2348
diff changeset
1868 Note: in the cursor line concealed text is not hidden, so that you can
2378
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1869 edit and copy the text. This can be changed with the 'concealcursor'
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1870 option.
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
1871
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1872 *'confirm'* *'cf'* *'noconfirm'* *'nocf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1873 'confirm' 'cf' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1874 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1875 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1876 When 'confirm' is on, certain operations that would normally
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1877 fail because of unsaved changes to a buffer, e.g. ":q" and ":e",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1878 instead raise a |dialog| asking if you wish to save the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1879 file(s). You can still use a ! to unconditionally |abandon| a buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1880 If 'confirm' is off you can still activate confirmation for one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1881 command only (this is most useful in mappings) with the |:confirm|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1882 command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1883 Also see the |confirm()| function and the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1884
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1885 *'conskey'* *'consk'* *'noconskey'* *'noconsk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1886 'conskey' 'consk' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1887 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1888 {not in Vi} {only for MS-DOS}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1889 When on direct console I/O is used to obtain a keyboard character.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1890 This should work in most cases. Also see |'bioskey'|. Together,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1891 three methods of console input are available:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1892 'conskey' 'bioskey' action ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1893 on on or off direct console input
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1894 off on BIOS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1895 off off STDIN
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1896
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1897 *'copyindent'* *'ci'* *'nocopyindent'* *'noci'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1898 'copyindent' 'ci' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1899 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1900 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1901 Copy the structure of the existing lines indent when autoindenting a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1902 new line. Normally the new indent is reconstructed by a series of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1903 tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is enabled,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1904 in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option makes the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1905 new line copy whatever characters were used for indenting on the
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
1906 existing line. 'expandtab' has no effect on these characters, a Tab
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
1907 remains a Tab. If the new indent is greater than on the existing
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1908 line, the remaining space is filled in the normal manner.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1909 NOTE: 'copyindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1910 Also see 'preserveindent'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1911
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1912 *'cpoptions'* *'cpo'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1913 'cpoptions' 'cpo' string (Vim default: "aABceFs",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1914 Vi default: all flags)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1915 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1916 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1917 A sequence of single character flags. When a character is present
5340
22da5ab9aaa1 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
1918 this indicates Vi-compatible behavior. This is used for things where
22da5ab9aaa1 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
1919 not being Vi-compatible is mostly or sometimes preferred.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1920 'cpoptions' stands for "compatible-options".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1921 Commas can be added for readability.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1922 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1923 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1924 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1925 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1926 NOTE: This option is set to the POSIX default value at startup when
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1927 the Vi default value would be used and the $VIM_POSIX environment
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
1928 variable exists |posix|. This means Vim tries to behave like the
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
1929 POSIX specification.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1930
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1931 contains behavior ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1932 *cpo-a*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1933 a When included, a ":read" command with a file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1934 argument will set the alternate file name for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1935 current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1936 *cpo-A*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1937 A When included, a ":write" command with a file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1938 argument will set the alternate file name for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1939 current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1940 *cpo-b*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1941 b "\|" in a ":map" command is recognized as the end of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1942 the map command. The '\' is included in the mapping,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1943 the text after the '|' is interpreted as the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1944 command. Use a CTRL-V instead of a backslash to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1945 include the '|' in the mapping. Applies to all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1946 mapping, abbreviation, menu and autocmd commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1947 See also |map_bar|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1948 *cpo-B*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1949 B A backslash has no special meaning in mappings,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1950 abbreviations and the "to" part of the menu commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1951 Remove this flag to be able to use a backslash like a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1952 CTRL-V. For example, the command ":map X \<Esc>"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1953 results in X being mapped to:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1954 'B' included: "\^[" (^[ is a real <Esc>)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1955 'B' excluded: "<Esc>" (5 characters)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1956 ('<' excluded in both cases)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1957 *cpo-c*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1958 c Searching continues at the end of any match at the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1959 cursor position, but not further than the start of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1960 next line. When not present searching continues
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1961 one character from the cursor position. With 'c'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1962 "abababababab" only gets three matches when repeating
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1963 "/abab", without 'c' there are five matches.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1964 *cpo-C*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1965 C Do not concatenate sourced lines that start with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1966 backslash. See |line-continuation|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1967 *cpo-d*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1968 d Using "./" in the 'tags' option doesn't mean to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1969 the tags file relative to the current file, but the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1970 tags file in the current directory.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1971 *cpo-D*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1972 D Can't use CTRL-K to enter a digraph after Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1973 commands with a character argument, like |r|, |f| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1974 |t|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1975 *cpo-e*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1976 e When executing a register with ":@r", always add a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1977 <CR> to the last line, also when the register is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1978 linewise. If this flag is not present, the register
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1979 is not linewise and the last line does not end in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1980 <CR>, then the last line is put on the command-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1981 and can be edited before hitting <CR>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1982 *cpo-E*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1983 E It is an error when using "y", "d", "c", "g~", "gu" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1984 "gU" on an Empty region. The operators only work when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1985 at least one character is to be operate on. Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1986 This makes "y0" fail in the first column.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1987 *cpo-f*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1988 f When included, a ":read" command with a file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1989 argument will set the file name for the current buffer,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1990 if the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1991 *cpo-F*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1992 F When included, a ":write" command with a file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1993 argument will set the file name for the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1994 buffer, if the current buffer doesn't have a file name
590
de152391f6f9 updated for version 7.0167
vimboss
parents: 571
diff changeset
1995 yet. Also see |cpo-P|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1996 *cpo-g*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1997 g Goto line 1 when using ":edit" without argument.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1998 *cpo-H*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1999 H When using "I" on a line with only blanks, insert
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2000 before the last blank. Without this flag insert after
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2001 the last blank.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2002 *cpo-i*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2003 i When included, interrupting the reading of a file will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2004 leave it modified.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2005 *cpo-I*
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2006 I When moving the cursor up or down just after inserting
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2007 indent for 'autoindent', do not delete the indent.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2008 *cpo-j*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2009 j When joining lines, only add two spaces after a '.',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2010 not after '!' or '?'. Also see 'joinspaces'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2011 *cpo-J*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2012 J A |sentence| has to be followed by two spaces after
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
2013 the '.', '!' or '?'. A <Tab> is not recognized as
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2014 white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2015 *cpo-k*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2016 k Disable the recognition of raw key codes in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2017 mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of menu
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2018 commands. For example, if <Key> sends ^[OA (where ^[
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2019 is <Esc>), the command ":map X ^[OA" results in X
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2020 being mapped to:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2021 'k' included: "^[OA" (3 characters)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2022 'k' excluded: "<Key>" (one key code)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2023 Also see the '<' flag below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2024 *cpo-K*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2025 K Don't wait for a key code to complete when it is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2026 halfway a mapping. This breaks mapping <F1><F1> when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2027 only part of the second <F1> has been read. It
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2028 enables cancelling the mapping by typing <F1><Esc>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2029 *cpo-l*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2030 l Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2031 literally, only "\]", "\^", "\-" and "\\" are special.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2032 See |/[]|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2033 'l' included: "/[ \t]" finds <Space>, '\' and 't'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2034 'l' excluded: "/[ \t]" finds <Space> and <Tab>
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2035 Also see |cpo-\|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2036 *cpo-L*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2037 L When the 'list' option is set, 'wrapmargin',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2038 'textwidth', 'softtabstop' and Virtual Replace mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2039 (see |gR|) count a <Tab> as two characters, instead of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2040 the normal behavior of a <Tab>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2041 *cpo-m*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2042 m When included, a showmatch will always wait half a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2043 second. When not included, a showmatch will wait half
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2044 a second or until a character is typed. |'showmatch'|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2045 *cpo-M*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2046 M When excluded, "%" matching will take backslashes into
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2047 account. Thus in "( \( )" and "\( ( \)" the outer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2048 parenthesis match. When included "%" ignores
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2049 backslashes, which is Vi compatible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2050 *cpo-n*
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
2051 n When included, the column used for 'number' and
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
2052 'relativenumber' will also be used for text of wrapped
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
2053 lines.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2054 *cpo-o*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2055 o Line offset to search command is not remembered for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2056 next search.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2057 *cpo-O*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2058 O Don't complain if a file is being overwritten, even
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2059 when it didn't exist when editing it. This is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2060 protection against a file unexpectedly created by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2061 someone else. Vi didn't complain about this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2062 *cpo-p*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2063 p Vi compatible Lisp indenting. When not present, a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2064 slightly better algorithm is used.
590
de152391f6f9 updated for version 7.0167
vimboss
parents: 571
diff changeset
2065 *cpo-P*
de152391f6f9 updated for version 7.0167
vimboss
parents: 571
diff changeset
2066 P When included, a ":write" command that appends to a
de152391f6f9 updated for version 7.0167
vimboss
parents: 571
diff changeset
2067 file will set the file name for the current buffer, if
de152391f6f9 updated for version 7.0167
vimboss
parents: 571
diff changeset
2068 the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet and
de152391f6f9 updated for version 7.0167
vimboss
parents: 571
diff changeset
2069 the 'F' flag is also included |cpo-F|.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2070 *cpo-q*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2071 q When joining multiple lines leave the cursor at the
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2072 position where it would be when joining two lines.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2073 *cpo-r*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2074 r Redo ("." command) uses "/" to repeat a search
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2075 command, instead of the actually used search string.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2076 *cpo-R*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2077 R Remove marks from filtered lines. Without this flag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2078 marks are kept like |:keepmarks| was used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2079 *cpo-s*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2080 s Set buffer options when entering the buffer for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2081 first time. This is like it is in Vim version 3.0.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2082 And it is the default. If not present the options are
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2083 set when the buffer is created.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2084 *cpo-S*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2085 S Set buffer options always when entering a buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2086 (except 'readonly', 'fileformat', 'filetype' and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2087 'syntax'). This is the (most) Vi compatible setting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2088 The options are set to the values in the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2089 buffer. When you change an option and go to another
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2090 buffer, the value is copied. Effectively makes the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2091 buffer options global to all buffers.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2092
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2093 's' 'S' copy buffer options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2094 no no when buffer created
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2095 yes no when buffer first entered (default)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2096 X yes each time when buffer entered (vi comp.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2097 *cpo-t*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2098 t Search pattern for the tag command is remembered for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2099 "n" command. Otherwise Vim only puts the pattern in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2100 the history for search pattern, but doesn't change the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2101 last used search pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2102 *cpo-u*
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2103 u Undo is Vi compatible. See |undo-two-ways|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2104 *cpo-v*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2105 v Backspaced characters remain visible on the screen in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2106 Insert mode. Without this flag the characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2107 erased from the screen right away. With this flag the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2108 screen newly typed text overwrites backspaced
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2109 characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2110 *cpo-w*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2111 w When using "cw" on a blank character, only change one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2112 character and not all blanks until the start of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2113 next word.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2114 *cpo-W*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2115 W Don't overwrite a readonly file. When omitted, ":w!"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2116 overwrites a readonly file, if possible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2117 *cpo-x*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2118 x <Esc> on the command-line executes the command-line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2119 The default in Vim is to abandon the command-line,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2120 because <Esc> normally aborts a command. |c_<Esc>|
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2121 *cpo-X*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2122 X When using a count with "R" the replaced text is
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2123 deleted only once. Also when repeating "R" with "."
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2124 and a count.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2125 *cpo-y*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2126 y A yank command can be redone with ".".
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2127 *cpo-Z*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2128 Z When using "w!" while the 'readonly' option is set,
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2129 don't reset 'readonly'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2130 *cpo-!*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2131 ! When redoing a filter command, use the last used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2132 external command, whatever it was. Otherwise the last
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2133 used -filter- command is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2134 *cpo-$*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2135 $ When making a change to one line, don't redisplay the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2136 line, but put a '$' at the end of the changed text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2137 The changed text will be overwritten when you type the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2138 new text. The line is redisplayed if you type any
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2139 command that moves the cursor from the insertion
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2140 point.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2141 *cpo-%*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2142 % Vi-compatible matching is done for the "%" command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2143 Does not recognize "#if", "#endif", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2144 Does not recognize "/*" and "*/".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2145 Parens inside single and double quotes are also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2146 counted, causing a string that contains a paren to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2147 disturb the matching. For example, in a line like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2148 "if (strcmp("foo(", s))" the first paren does not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2149 match the last one. When this flag is not included,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2150 parens inside single and double quotes are treated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2151 specially. When matching a paren outside of quotes,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2152 everything inside quotes is ignored. When matching a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2153 paren inside quotes, it will find the matching one (if
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2154 there is one). This works very well for C programs.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2155 This flag is also used for other features, such as
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
2156 C-indenting.
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
2157 *cpo--*
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
2158 - When included, a vertical movement command fails when
632
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
2159 it would go above the first line or below the last
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
2160 line. Without it the cursor moves to the first or
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
2161 last line, unless it already was in that line.
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
2162 Applies to the commands "-", "k", CTRL-P, "+", "j",
632
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
2163 CTRL-N, CTRL-J and ":1234".
39
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2164 *cpo-+*
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2165 + When included, a ":write file" command will reset the
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2166 'modified' flag of the buffer, even though the buffer
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2167 itself may still be different from its file.
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
2168 *cpo-star*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2169 * Use ":*" in the same way as ":@". When not included,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2170 ":*" is an alias for ":'<,'>", select the Visual area.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2171 *cpo-<*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2172 < Disable the recognition of special key codes in |<>|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2173 form in mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2174 menu commands. For example, the command
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2175 ":map X <Tab>" results in X being mapped to:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2176 '<' included: "<Tab>" (5 characters)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2177 '<' excluded: "^I" (^I is a real <Tab>)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2178 Also see the 'k' flag above.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2179 *cpo->*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2180 > When appending to a register, put a line break before
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2181 the appended text.
2925
441d364773dc updated for version 7.3.235
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
2182 *cpo-;*
441d364773dc updated for version 7.3.235
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
2183 ; When using |,| or |;| to repeat the last |t| search
441d364773dc updated for version 7.3.235
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
2184 and the cursor is right in front of the searched
441d364773dc updated for version 7.3.235
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
2185 character, the cursor won't move. When not included,
441d364773dc updated for version 7.3.235
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
2186 the cursor would skip over it and jump to the
3557
9cb3a75a20b9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3513
diff changeset
2187 following occurrence.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2188
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2189 POSIX flags. These are not included in the Vi default value, except
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2190 when $VIM_POSIX was set on startup. |posix|
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2191
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2192 contains behavior ~
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
2193 *cpo-#*
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2194 # A count before "D", "o" and "O" has no effect.
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2195 *cpo-&*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2196 & When ":preserve" was used keep the swap file when
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2197 exiting normally while this buffer is still loaded.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2198 This flag is tested when exiting.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2199 *cpo-\*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2200 \ Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2201 literally, only "\]" is special See |/[]|
488
f00f0af2a320 updated for version 7.0133
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2202 '\' included: "/[ \-]" finds <Space>, '\' and '-'
f00f0af2a320 updated for version 7.0133
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2203 '\' excluded: "/[ \-]" finds <Space> and '-'
f00f0af2a320 updated for version 7.0133
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2204 Also see |cpo-l|.
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2205 *cpo-/*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2206 / When "%" is used as the replacement string in a |:s|
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2207 command, use the previous replacement string. |:s%|
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2208 *cpo-{*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2209 { The |{| and |}| commands also stop at a "{" character
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2210 at the start of a line.
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2211 *cpo-.*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2212 . The ":chdir" and ":cd" commands fail if the current
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2213 buffer is modified, unless ! is used. Vim doesn't
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2214 need this, since it remembers the full path of an
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2215 opened file.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2216 *cpo-bar*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2217 | The value of the $LINES and $COLUMNS environment
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2218 variables overrule the terminal size values obtained
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2219 with system specific functions.
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
2220
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2221
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2178
diff changeset
2222 *'cryptmethod'* *'cm'*
6336
4abac79c0b7a Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6328
diff changeset
2223 'cryptmethod' 'cm' string (default "zip")
2360
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2224 global or local to buffer |global-local|
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2178
diff changeset
2225 {not in Vi}
f60a0c9cbe6c Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2178
diff changeset
2226 Method used for encryption when the buffer is written to a file:
2184
5028c4d6d825 Fixed encryption big/little endian test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2180
diff changeset
2227 *pkzip*
2360
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2228 zip PkZip compatible method. A weak kind of encryption.
2204
c493d6bfde09 A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2184
diff changeset
2229 Backwards compatible with Vim 7.2 and older.
2184
5028c4d6d825 Fixed encryption big/little endian test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2180
diff changeset
2230 *blowfish*
6122
18ac55444b37 updated for version 7.4.399
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6110
diff changeset
2231 blowfish Blowfish method. Medium strong encryption but it has
18ac55444b37 updated for version 7.4.399
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6110
diff changeset
2232 an implementation flaw. Requires Vim 7.3 or later,
18ac55444b37 updated for version 7.4.399
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6110
diff changeset
2233 files can NOT be read by Vim 7.2 and older. This adds
18ac55444b37 updated for version 7.4.399
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6110
diff changeset
2234 a "seed" to the file, every time you write the file
18ac55444b37 updated for version 7.4.399
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6110
diff changeset
2235 the encrypted bytes will be different.
18ac55444b37 updated for version 7.4.399
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6110
diff changeset
2236 *blowfish2*
18ac55444b37 updated for version 7.4.399
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6110
diff changeset
2237 blowfish2 Blowfish method. Medium strong encryption. Requires
18ac55444b37 updated for version 7.4.399
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6110
diff changeset
2238 Vim 7.4.399 or later, files can NOT be read by Vim 7.3
18ac55444b37 updated for version 7.4.399
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6110
diff changeset
2239 and older. This adds a "seed" to the file, every time
18ac55444b37 updated for version 7.4.399
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6110
diff changeset
2240 you write the file the encrypted bytes will be
18ac55444b37 updated for version 7.4.399
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6110
diff changeset
2241 different. The whole undo file is encrypted, not just
18ac55444b37 updated for version 7.4.399
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6110
diff changeset
2242 the pieces of text.
2204
c493d6bfde09 A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2184
diff changeset
2243
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2178
diff changeset
2244 When reading an encrypted file 'cryptmethod' will be set automatically
2204
c493d6bfde09 A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2184
diff changeset
2245 to the detected method of the file being read. Thus if you write it
c493d6bfde09 A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2184
diff changeset
2246 without changing 'cryptmethod' the same method will be used.
c493d6bfde09 A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2184
diff changeset
2247 Changing 'cryptmethod' does not mark the file as modified, you have to
2360
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2248 explicitly write it, you don't get a warning unless there are other
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2249 modifications. Also see |:X|.
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2250
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2251 When setting the global value to an empty string, it will end up with
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2252 the value "zip". When setting the local value to an empty string the
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2253 buffer will use the global value.
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2254
2204
c493d6bfde09 A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2184
diff changeset
2255 When a new encryption method is added in a later version of Vim, and
c493d6bfde09 A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2184
diff changeset
2256 the current version does not recognize it, you will get *E821* .
2360
d8e4b27cef80 Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2350
diff changeset
2257 You need to edit this file with the later version of Vim.
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2178
diff changeset
2258
f60a0c9cbe6c Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2178
diff changeset
2259
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2260 *'cscopepathcomp'* *'cspc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2261 'cscopepathcomp' 'cspc' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2262 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2263 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2264 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2265 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2266 Determines how many components of the path to show in a list of tags.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2267 See |cscopepathcomp|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2268
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2269 *'cscopeprg'* *'csprg'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2270 'cscopeprg' 'csprg' string (default "cscope")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2271 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2272 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2273 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2274 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2275 Specifies the command to execute cscope. See |cscopeprg|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2276 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2277 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2278
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2279 *'cscopequickfix'* *'csqf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2280 'cscopequickfix' 'csqf' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2281 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2282 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2283 or |+quickfix| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2284 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2285 Specifies whether to use quickfix window to show cscope results.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2286 See |cscopequickfix|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2287
4869
a5352e73dc00 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4780
diff changeset
2288 *'cscoperelative'* *'csre'* *'nocscoperelative'* *'nocsre'*
2873
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2289 'cscoperelative' 'csre' boolean (default off)
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2290 global
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2291 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2292 feature}
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2293 {not in Vi}
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2294 In the absence of a prefix (-P) for cscope. setting this option enables
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2295 to use the basename of cscope.out path as the prefix.
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2296 See |cscoperelative|.
eeb1ac4f66d1 updated for version 7.3.210
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2833
diff changeset
2297
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2298 *'cscopetag'* *'cst'* *'nocscopetag'* *'nocst'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2299 'cscopetag' 'cst' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2300 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2301 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2302 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2303 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2304 Use cscope for tag commands. See |cscope-options|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2305 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2306
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2307 *'cscopetagorder'* *'csto'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2308 'cscopetagorder' 'csto' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2309 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2310 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2311 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2312 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2313 Determines the order in which ":cstag" performs a search. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2314 |cscopetagorder|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2315 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2316
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2317 *'cscopeverbose'* *'csverb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2318 *'nocscopeverbose'* *'nocsverb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2319 'cscopeverbose' 'csverb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2320 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2321 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2322 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2323 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2324 Give messages when adding a cscope database. See |cscopeverbose|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2325 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2326
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2327 *'cursorbind'* *'crb'* *'nocursorbind'* *'nocrb'*
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2328 'cursorbind' 'crb' boolean (default off)
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2329 local to window
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2330 {not in Vi}
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2331 {not available when compiled without the |+cursorbind|
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2332 feature}
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2333 When this option is set, as the cursor in the current
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2334 window moves other cursorbound windows (windows that also have
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2335 this option set) move their cursors to the corresponding line and
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2336 column. This option is useful for viewing the
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2337 differences between two versions of a file (see 'diff'); in diff mode,
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2338 inserted and deleted lines (though not characters within a line) are
2314
233eb4412f5d Added 'colorcolumn' option. Partly by Gregor Uhlenheuer.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2302
diff changeset
2339 taken into account.
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
2340
743
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2341
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2342 *'cursorcolumn'* *'cuc'* *'nocursorcolumn'* *'nocuc'*
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2343 'cursorcolumn' 'cuc' boolean (default off)
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2344 local to window
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2345 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
2346 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
743
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2347 feature}
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2348 Highlight the screen column of the cursor with CursorColumn
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2349 |hl-CursorColumn|. Useful to align text. Will make screen redrawing
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2350 slower.
826
1cdd2661f34c updated for version 7.0d01
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2351 If you only want the highlighting in the current window you can use
1cdd2661f34c updated for version 7.0d01
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2352 these autocommands: >
1cdd2661f34c updated for version 7.0d01
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2353 au WinLeave * set nocursorline nocursorcolumn
1cdd2661f34c updated for version 7.0d01
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2354 au WinEnter * set cursorline cursorcolumn
1cdd2661f34c updated for version 7.0d01
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2355 <
743
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2356
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2357 *'cursorline'* *'cul'* *'nocursorline'* *'nocul'*
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2358 'cursorline' 'cul' boolean (default off)
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2359 local to window
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2360 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
2361 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
743
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2362 feature}
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2363 Highlight the screen line of the cursor with CursorLine
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2364 |hl-CursorLine|. Useful to easily spot the cursor. Will make screen
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2365 redrawing slower.
818
1f929f3ca806 updated for version 7.0c03
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2366 When Visual mode is active the highlighting isn't used to make it
825
6675076019ae updated for version 7.0d
vimboss
parents: 824
diff changeset
2367 easier to see the selected text.
743
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2368
afac7b58ed46 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 730
diff changeset
2369
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2370 *'debug'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2371 'debug' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2372 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2373 {not in Vi}
839
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
2374 These values can be used:
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
2375 msg Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
2376 anyway.
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
2377 throw Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
2378 anyway and also throw an exception and set |v:errmsg|.
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
2379 beep A message will be given when otherwise only a beep would be
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
2380 produced.
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2381 The values can be combined, separated by a comma.
839
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
2382 "msg" and "throw" are useful for debugging 'foldexpr', 'formatexpr' or
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
2383 'indentexpr'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2384
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2385 *'define'* *'def'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2386 'define' 'def' string (default "^\s*#\s*define")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2387 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2388 {not in Vi}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2389 Pattern to be used to find a macro definition. It is a search
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2390 pattern, just like for the "/" command. This option is used for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2391 commands like "[i" and "[d" |include-search|. The 'isident' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2392 used to recognize the defined name after the match:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2393 {match with 'define'}{non-ID chars}{defined name}{non-ID char}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2394 See |option-backslash| about inserting backslashes to include a space
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2395 or backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2396 The default value is for C programs. For C++ this value would be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2397 useful, to include const type declarations: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2398 ^\(#\s*define\|[a-z]*\s*const\s*[a-z]*\)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2399 < When using the ":set" command, you need to double the backslashes!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2400
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2401 *'delcombine'* *'deco'* *'nodelcombine'* *'nodeco'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2402 'delcombine' 'deco' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2403 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2404 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2405 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2406 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2407 If editing Unicode and this option is set, backspace and Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2408 "x" delete each combining character on its own. When it is off (the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2409 default) the character along with its combining characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2410 deleted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2411 Note: When 'delcombine' is set "xx" may work different from "2x"!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2412
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2413 This is useful for Arabic, Hebrew and many other languages where one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2414 may have combining characters overtop of base characters, and want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2415 to remove only the combining ones.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2416
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2417 *'dictionary'* *'dict'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2418 'dictionary' 'dict' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2419 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2420 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2421 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2422 for keyword completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|. Each file should
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2423 contain a list of words. This can be one word per line, or several
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2424 words per line, separated by non-keyword characters (white space is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2425 preferred). Maximum line length is 510 bytes.
703
2fae45239fb3 updated for version 7.0212
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2426 When this option is empty, or an entry "spell" is present, spell
2fae45239fb3 updated for version 7.0212
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2427 checking is enabled the currently active spelling is used. |spell|
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2428 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2429 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2430 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
99
04f2e519ab18 updated for version 7.0038
vimboss
parents: 82
diff changeset
2431 This has nothing to do with the |Dictionary| variable type.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2432 Where to find a list of words?
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2433 - On FreeBSD, there is the file "/usr/share/dict/words".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2434 - In the Simtel archive, look in the "msdos/linguist" directory.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2435 - In "miscfiles" of the GNU collection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2436 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2437 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2438 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2439 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2440
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2441 *'diff'* *'nodiff'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2442 'diff' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2443 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2444 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2445 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2446 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2447 Join the current window in the group of windows that shows differences
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2448 between files. See |vimdiff|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2449
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2450 *'dex'* *'diffexpr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2451 'diffexpr' 'dex' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2452 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2453 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2454 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2455 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2456 Expression which is evaluated to obtain an ed-style diff file from two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2457 versions of a file. See |diff-diffexpr|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2458 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2459 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2460
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2461 *'dip'* *'diffopt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2462 'diffopt' 'dip' string (default "filler")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2463 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2464 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2465 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2466 feature}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2467 Option settings for diff mode. It can consist of the following items.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2468 All are optional. Items must be separated by a comma.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2469
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2470 filler Show filler lines, to keep the text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2471 synchronized with a window that has inserted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2472 lines at the same position. Mostly useful
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2473 when windows are side-by-side and 'scrollbind'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2474 is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2475
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2476 context:{n} Use a context of {n} lines between a change
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2477 and a fold that contains unchanged lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2478 When omitted a context of six lines is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2479 See |fold-diff|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2480
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2481 icase Ignore changes in case of text. "a" and "A"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2482 are considered the same. Adds the "-i" flag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2483 to the "diff" command if 'diffexpr' is empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2484
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2485 iwhite Ignore changes in amount of white space. Adds
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2486 the "-b" flag to the "diff" command if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2487 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2488 of the "diff" command for what this does
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2489 exactly. It should ignore adding trailing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2490 white space, but not leading white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2491
766
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2492 horizontal Start diff mode with horizontal splits (unless
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2493 explicitly specified otherwise).
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2494
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2495 vertical Start diff mode with vertical splits (unless
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2496 explicitly specified otherwise).
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2497
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2498 foldcolumn:{n} Set the 'foldcolumn' option to {n} when
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2499 starting diff mode. Without this 2 is used.
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2500
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2501 Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2502
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2503 :set diffopt=filler,context:4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2504 :set diffopt=
766
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
2505 :set diffopt=filler,foldcolumn:3
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2506 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2507 *'digraph'* *'dg'* *'nodigraph'* *'nodg'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2508 'digraph' 'dg' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2509 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2510 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2511 {not available when compiled without the |+digraphs|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2512 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2513 Enable the entering of digraphs in Insert mode with {char1} <BS>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2514 {char2}. See |digraphs|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2515 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2516
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2517 *'directory'* *'dir'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2518 'directory' 'dir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
5555
7818ca6de3d0 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5487
diff changeset
2519 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:\tmp,c:\temp"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2520 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,/var/tmp,/tmp")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2521 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2522 List of directory names for the swap file, separated with commas.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2523 - The swap file will be created in the first directory where this is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2524 possible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2525 - Empty means that no swap file will be used (recovery is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2526 impossible!).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2527 - A directory "." means to put the swap file in the same directory as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2528 the edited file. On Unix, a dot is prepended to the file name, so
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2529 it doesn't show in a directory listing. On MS-Windows the "hidden"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2530 attribute is set and a dot prepended if possible.
33
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2531 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2532 put the swap file relative to where the edited file is. The leading
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2533 "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
459
d9d38102399f updated for version 7.0122
vimboss
parents: 452
diff changeset
2534 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//"
d9d38102399f updated for version 7.0122
vimboss
parents: 452
diff changeset
2535 or "\\", the swap file name will be built from the complete path to
d9d38102399f updated for version 7.0122
vimboss
parents: 452
diff changeset
2536 the file with all path separators substituted to percent '%' signs.
d9d38102399f updated for version 7.0122
vimboss
parents: 452
diff changeset
2537 This will ensure file name uniqueness in the preserve directory.
1698
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
2538 On Win32, when a separating comma is following, you must use "//",
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
2539 since "\\" will include the comma in the file name.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2540 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2541 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2542 name, precede it with a backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2543 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2544 - A directory name may end in an ':' or '/'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2545 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2546 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2547 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2548 :set dir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2549 < - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2550 of the option is removed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2551 Using "." first in the list is recommended. This means that editing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2552 the same file twice will result in a warning. Using "/tmp" on Unix is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2553 discouraged: When the system crashes you lose the swap file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2554 "/var/tmp" is often not cleared when rebooting, thus is a better
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2555 choice than "/tmp". But it can contain a lot of files, your swap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2556 files get lost in the crowd. That is why a "tmp" directory in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2557 home directory is tried first.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2558 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2559 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2560 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2561 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2562 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2563 {Vi: directory to put temp file in, defaults to "/tmp"}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2564
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2565 *'display'* *'dy'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2566 'display' 'dy' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2567 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2568 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2569 Change the way text is displayed. This is comma separated list of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2570 flags:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2571 lastline When included, as much as possible of the last line
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2572 in a window will be displayed. When not included, a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2573 last line that doesn't fit is replaced with "@" lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2574 uhex Show unprintable characters hexadecimal as <xx>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2575 instead of using ^C and ~C.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2576
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2577 *'eadirection'* *'ead'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2578 'eadirection' 'ead' string (default "both")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2579 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2580 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
2581 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2582 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2583 Tells when the 'equalalways' option applies:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2584 ver vertically, width of windows is not affected
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2585 hor horizontally, height of windows is not affected
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2586 both width and height of windows is affected
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2587
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2588 *'ed'* *'edcompatible'* *'noed'* *'noedcompatible'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2589 'edcompatible' 'ed' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2590 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2591 Makes the 'g' and 'c' flags of the ":substitute" command to be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2592 toggled each time the flag is given. See |complex-change|. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2593 also 'gdefault' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2594 Switching this option on is discouraged!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2595
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2596 *'encoding'* *'enc'* *E543*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2597 'encoding' 'enc' string (default: "latin1" or value from $LANG)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2598 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2599 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2600 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2601 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2602 Sets the character encoding used inside Vim. It applies to text in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2603 the buffers, registers, Strings in expressions, text stored in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2604 viminfo file, etc. It sets the kind of characters which Vim can work
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2605 with. See |encoding-names| for the possible values.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2606
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2607 NOTE: Changing this option will not change the encoding of the
39
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2608 existing text in Vim. It may cause non-ASCII text to become invalid.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2609 It should normally be kept at its default value, or set when Vim
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
2610 starts up. See |multibyte|. To reload the menus see |:menutrans|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2611
2317
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2612 This option cannot be set from a |modeline|. It would most likely
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2613 corrupt the text.
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2614
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2615 NOTE: For GTK+ 2 it is highly recommended to set 'encoding' to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2616 "utf-8". Although care has been taken to allow different values of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2617 'encoding', "utf-8" is the natural choice for the environment and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2618 avoids unnecessary conversion overhead. "utf-8" has not been made
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2619 the default to prevent different behavior of the GUI and terminal
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2620 versions, and to avoid changing the encoding of newly created files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2621 without your knowledge (in case 'fileencodings' is empty).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2622
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2623 The character encoding of files can be different from 'encoding'.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2624 This is specified with 'fileencoding'. The conversion is done with
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2625 iconv() or as specified with 'charconvert'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2626
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2627 If you need to know whether 'encoding' is a multi-byte encoding, you
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2628 can use: >
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2629 if has("multi_byte_encoding")
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2630 <
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2631 Normally 'encoding' will be equal to your current locale. This will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2632 be the default if Vim recognizes your environment settings. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2633 'encoding' is not set to the current locale, 'termencoding' must be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2634 set to convert typed and displayed text. See |encoding-table|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2635
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2636 When you set this option, it fires the |EncodingChanged| autocommand
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2637 event so that you can set up fonts if necessary.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2638
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2639 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2640 you can set it with uppercase values too. Underscores are translated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2641 to '-' signs.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2642 When the encoding is recognized, it is changed to the standard name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2643 For example "Latin-1" becomes "latin1", "ISO_88592" becomes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2644 "iso-8859-2" and "utf8" becomes "utf-8".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2645
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2646 Note: "latin1" is also used when the encoding could not be detected.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2647 This only works when editing files in the same encoding! When the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2648 actual character set is not latin1, make sure 'fileencoding' and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2649 'fileencodings' are empty. When conversion is needed, switch to using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2650 utf-8.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2651
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2652 When "unicode", "ucs-2" or "ucs-4" is used, Vim internally uses utf-8.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2653 You don't notice this while editing, but it does matter for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2654 |viminfo-file|. And Vim expects the terminal to use utf-8 too. Thus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2655 setting 'encoding' to one of these values instead of utf-8 only has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2656 effect for encoding used for files when 'fileencoding' is empty.
448
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 446
diff changeset
2657
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 446
diff changeset
2658 When 'encoding' is set to a Unicode encoding, and 'fileencodings' was
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 446
diff changeset
2659 not set yet, the default for 'fileencodings' is changed.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2660
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2661 *'endofline'* *'eol'* *'noendofline'* *'noeol'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2662 'endofline' 'eol' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2663 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2664 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2665 When writing a file and this option is off and the 'binary' option
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2666 is on, no <EOL> will be written for the last line in the file. This
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2667 option is automatically set when starting to edit a new file, unless
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2668 the file does not have an <EOL> for the last line in the file, in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2669 which case it is reset. Normally you don't have to set or reset this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2670 option. When 'binary' is off the value is not used when writing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2671 file. When 'binary' is on it is used to remember the presence of a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2672 <EOL> for the last line in the file, so that when you write the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2673 the situation from the original file can be kept. But you can change
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2674 it if you want to.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2675
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2676 *'equalalways'* *'ea'* *'noequalalways'* *'noea'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2677 'equalalways' 'ea' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2678 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2679 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2680 When on, all the windows are automatically made the same size after
33
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2681 splitting or closing a window. This also happens the moment the
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2682 option is switched on. When off, splitting a window will reduce the
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2683 size of the current window and leave the other windows the same. When
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2684 closing a window the extra lines are given to the window next to it
f6033dcbaf31 updated for version 7.0020
vimboss
parents: 29
diff changeset
2685 (depending on 'splitbelow' and 'splitright').
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2686 When mixing vertically and horizontally split windows, a minimal size
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2687 is computed and some windows may be larger if there is room. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2688 'eadirection' option tells in which direction the size is affected.
1354
10a1b67c0885 updated for version 7.1-068
vimboss
parents: 1263
diff changeset
2689 Changing the height and width of a window can be avoided by setting
10a1b67c0885 updated for version 7.1-068
vimboss
parents: 1263
diff changeset
2690 'winfixheight' and 'winfixwidth', respectively.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2691 If a window size is specified when creating a new window sizes are
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2692 currently not equalized (it's complicated, but may be implemented in
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2693 the future).
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2694
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2695 *'equalprg'* *'ep'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2696 'equalprg' 'ep' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2697 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2698 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2699 External program to use for "=" command. When this option is empty
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
2700 the internal formatting functions are used; either 'lisp', 'cindent'
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2701 or 'indentexpr'. When Vim was compiled without internal formatting,
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2702 the "indent" program is used.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2703 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2704 about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2705 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2706 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2707
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2708 *'errorbells'* *'eb'* *'noerrorbells'* *'noeb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2709 'errorbells' 'eb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2710 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2711 Ring the bell (beep or screen flash) for error messages. This only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2712 makes a difference for error messages, the bell will be used always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2713 for a lot of errors without a message (e.g., hitting <Esc> in Normal
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2714 mode). See 'visualbell' on how to make the bell behave like a beep,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2715 screen flash or do nothing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2716
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2717 *'errorfile'* *'ef'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2718 'errorfile' 'ef' string (Amiga default: "AztecC.Err",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2719 others: "errors.err")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2720 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2721 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2722 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2723 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2724 Name of the errorfile for the QuickFix mode (see |:cf|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2725 When the "-q" command-line argument is used, 'errorfile' is set to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2726 following argument. See |-q|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2727 NOT used for the ":make" command. See 'makeef' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2728 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2729 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2730 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2731 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2732
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2733 *'errorformat'* *'efm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2734 'errorformat' 'efm' string (default is very long)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2735 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2736 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2737 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2738 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2739 Scanf-like description of the format for the lines in the error file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2740 (see |errorformat|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2741
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2742 *'esckeys'* *'ek'* *'noesckeys'* *'noek'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2743 'esckeys' 'ek' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2744 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2745 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2746 Function keys that start with an <Esc> are recognized in Insert
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2747 mode. When this option is off, the cursor and function keys cannot be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2748 used in Insert mode if they start with an <Esc>. The advantage of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2749 this is that the single <Esc> is recognized immediately, instead of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2750 after one second. Instead of resetting this option, you might want to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2751 try changing the values for 'timeoutlen' and 'ttimeoutlen'. Note that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2752 when 'esckeys' is off, you can still map anything, but the cursor keys
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2753 won't work by default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2754 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2755 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2756
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2757 *'eventignore'* *'ei'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2758 'eventignore' 'ei' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2759 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2760 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2761 {not available when compiled without the |+autocmd|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2762 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2763 A list of autocommand event names, which are to be ignored.
844
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 843
diff changeset
2764 When set to "all" or when "all" is one of the items, all autocommand
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 843
diff changeset
2765 events are ignored, autocommands will not be executed.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2766 Otherwise this is a comma separated list of event names. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2767 :set ei=WinEnter,WinLeave
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2768 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2769 *'expandtab'* *'et'* *'noexpandtab'* *'noet'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2770 'expandtab' 'et' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2771 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2772 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2773 In Insert mode: Use the appropriate number of spaces to insert a
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2774 <Tab>. Spaces are used in indents with the '>' and '<' commands and
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2775 when 'autoindent' is on. To insert a real tab when 'expandtab' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2776 on, use CTRL-V<Tab>. See also |:retab| and |ins-expandtab|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2777 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2778
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2779 *'exrc'* *'ex'* *'noexrc'* *'noex'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2780 'exrc' 'ex' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2781 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2782 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2783 Enables the reading of .vimrc, .exrc and .gvimrc in the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2784 directory. If you switch this option on you should also consider
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2785 setting the 'secure' option (see |initialization|). Using a local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2786 .exrc, .vimrc or .gvimrc is a potential security leak, use with care!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2787 also see |.vimrc| and |gui-init|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2788 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2789 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2790
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2791 *'fileencoding'* *'fenc'* *E213*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2792 'fileencoding' 'fenc' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2793 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2794 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2795 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2796 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2797 Sets the character encoding for the file of this buffer.
2317
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2798
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2799 When 'fileencoding' is different from 'encoding', conversion will be
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2800 done when writing the file. For reading see below.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2801 When 'fileencoding' is empty, the same value as 'encoding' will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2802 used (no conversion when reading or writing a file).
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2803 Conversion will also be done when 'encoding' and 'fileencoding' are
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2804 both a Unicode encoding and 'fileencoding' is not utf-8. That's
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2805 because internally Unicode is always stored as utf-8.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2806 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2807 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding, conversion
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2808 is most likely done in a way that the reverse conversion
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2809 results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not "utf-8" some
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
2810 characters may be lost!
2317
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2811
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2812 See 'encoding' for the possible values. Additionally, values may be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2813 specified that can be handled by the converter, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2814 |mbyte-conversion|.
2317
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2815
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2816 When reading a file 'fileencoding' will be set from 'fileencodings'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2817 To read a file in a certain encoding it won't work by setting
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
2818 'fileencoding', use the |++enc| argument. One exception: when
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
2819 'fileencodings' is empty the value of 'fileencoding' is used.
692
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
2820 For a new file the global value of 'fileencoding' is used.
2317
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2821
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2822 Prepending "8bit-" and "2byte-" has no meaning here, they are ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2823 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2824 you can set it with uppercase values too. '_' characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2825 replaced with '-'. If a name is recognized from the list for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2826 'encoding', it is replaced by the standard name. For example
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2827 "ISO8859-2" becomes "iso-8859-2".
2317
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2828
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2829 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2830 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
2317
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2831
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2832 Keep in mind that changing 'fenc' from a modeline happens
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2833 AFTER the text has been read, thus it applies to when the file will be
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2834 written. If you do set 'fenc' in a modeline, you might want to set
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2835 'nomodified' to avoid not being able to ":q".
2b2cd34569eb Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
2836
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2837 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2838
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2839 *'fe'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2840 NOTE: Before version 6.0 this option specified the encoding for the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2841 whole of Vim, this was a mistake. Now use 'encoding' instead. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2842 old short name was 'fe', which is no longer used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2843
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2844 *'fileencodings'* *'fencs'*
39
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2845 'fileencodings' 'fencs' string (default: "ucs-bom",
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2846 "ucs-bom,utf-8,default,latin1" when
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2847 'encoding' is set to a Unicode value)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2848 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2849 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2850 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2851 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2852 This is a list of character encodings considered when starting to edit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2853 an existing file. When a file is read, Vim tries to use the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2854 mentioned character encoding. If an error is detected, the next one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2855 in the list is tried. When an encoding is found that works,
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2856 'fileencoding' is set to it. If all fail, 'fileencoding' is set to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2857 an empty string, which means the value of 'encoding' is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2858 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2859 'encoding' is "utf-8" (or one of the other Unicode variants)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2860 conversion is most likely done in a way that the reverse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2861 conversion results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not
596
e612bbdb670f updated for version 7.0169
vimboss
parents: 593
diff changeset
2862 "utf-8" some non-ASCII characters may be lost! You can use
e612bbdb670f updated for version 7.0169
vimboss
parents: 593
diff changeset
2863 the |++bad| argument to specify what is done with characters
e612bbdb670f updated for version 7.0169
vimboss
parents: 593
diff changeset
2864 that can't be converted.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2865 For an empty file or a file with only ASCII characters most encodings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2866 will work and the first entry of 'fileencodings' will be used (except
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2867 "ucs-bom", which requires the BOM to be present). If you prefer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2868 another encoding use an BufReadPost autocommand event to test if your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2869 preferred encoding is to be used. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2870 au BufReadPost * if search('\S', 'w') == 0 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2871 \ set fenc=iso-2022-jp | endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2872 < This sets 'fileencoding' to "iso-2022-jp" if the file does not contain
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2873 non-blank characters.
596
e612bbdb670f updated for version 7.0169
vimboss
parents: 593
diff changeset
2874 When the |++enc| argument is used then the value of 'fileencodings' is
e612bbdb670f updated for version 7.0169
vimboss
parents: 593
diff changeset
2875 not used.
692
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
2876 Note that 'fileencodings' is not used for a new file, the global value
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
2877 of 'fileencoding' is used instead. You can set it with: >
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
2878 :setglobal fenc=iso-8859-2
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
2879 < This means that a non-existing file may get a different encoding than
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
2880 an empty file.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2881 The special value "ucs-bom" can be used to check for a Unicode BOM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2882 (Byte Order Mark) at the start of the file. It must not be preceded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2883 by "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding for this to work properly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2884 An entry for an 8-bit encoding (e.g., "latin1") should be the last,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2885 because Vim cannot detect an error, thus the encoding is always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2886 accepted.
39
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2887 The special value "default" can be used for the encoding from the
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2888 environment. This is the default value for 'encoding'. It is useful
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2889 when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and your environment uses a
410fa1a31baf updated for version 7.0023
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
2890 non-latin1 encoding, such as Russian.
777
f664cc974a7a updated for version 7.0227
vimboss
parents: 772
diff changeset
2891 When 'encoding' is "utf-8" and a file contains an illegal byte
f664cc974a7a updated for version 7.0227
vimboss
parents: 772
diff changeset
2892 sequence it won't be recognized as UTF-8. You can use the |8g8|
f664cc974a7a updated for version 7.0227
vimboss
parents: 772
diff changeset
2893 command to find the illegal byte sequence.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2894 WRONG VALUES: WHAT'S WRONG:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2895 latin1,utf-8 "latin1" will always be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2896 utf-8,ucs-bom,latin1 BOM won't be recognized in an utf-8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2897 file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2898 cp1250,latin1 "cp1250" will always be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2899 If 'fileencodings' is empty, 'fileencoding' is not modified.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2900 See 'fileencoding' for the possible values.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2901 Setting this option does not have an effect until the next time a file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2902 is read.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2903
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2904 *'fileformat'* *'ff'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2905 'fileformat' 'ff' string (MS-DOS, MS-Windows, OS/2 default: "dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2906 Unix default: "unix",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2907 Macintosh default: "mac")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2908 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2909 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2910 This gives the <EOL> of the current buffer, which is used for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2911 reading/writing the buffer from/to a file:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2912 dos <CR> <NL>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2913 unix <NL>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2914 mac <CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2915 When "dos" is used, CTRL-Z at the end of a file is ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2916 See |file-formats| and |file-read|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2917 For the character encoding of the file see 'fileencoding'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2918 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformat' is ignored, file I/O
4264
2d1383658bb4 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4242
diff changeset
2919 works like it was set to "unix".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2920 This option is set automatically when starting to edit a file and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2921 'fileformats' is not empty and 'binary' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2922 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2923 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2924 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2925 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to "dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2926 'textmode' is set, otherwise 'textmode' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2927
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2928 *'fileformats'* *'ffs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2929 'fileformats' 'ffs' string (default:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2930 Vim+Vi MS-DOS, MS-Windows OS/2: "dos,unix",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2931 Vim Unix: "unix,dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2932 Vim Mac: "mac,unix,dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2933 Vi Cygwin: "unix,dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2934 Vi others: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2935 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2936 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2937 This gives the end-of-line (<EOL>) formats that will be tried when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2938 starting to edit a new buffer and when reading a file into an existing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2939 buffer:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2940 - When empty, the format defined with 'fileformat' will be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2941 always. It is not set automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2942 - When set to one name, that format will be used whenever a new buffer
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2943 is opened. 'fileformat' is set accordingly for that buffer. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2944 'fileformats' name will be used when a file is read into an existing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2945 buffer, no matter what 'fileformat' for that buffer is set to.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2946 - When more than one name is present, separated by commas, automatic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2947 <EOL> detection will be done when reading a file. When starting to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2948 edit a file, a check is done for the <EOL>:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2949 1. If all lines end in <CR><NL>, and 'fileformats' includes "dos",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2950 'fileformat' is set to "dos".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2951 2. If a <NL> is found and 'fileformats' includes "unix", 'fileformat'
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2952 is set to "unix". Note that when a <NL> is found without a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2953 preceding <CR>, "unix" is preferred over "dos".
6647
3af822eb4da5 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6583
diff changeset
2954 3. If 'fileformat' has not yet been set, and if a <CR> is found, and
3af822eb4da5 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6583
diff changeset
2955 if 'fileformats' includes "mac", 'fileformat' is set to "mac".
2587
d0049ff5969e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2577
diff changeset
2956 This means that "mac" is only chosen when:
d0049ff5969e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2577
diff changeset
2957 "unix" is not present or no <NL> is found in the file, and
d0049ff5969e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2577
diff changeset
2958 "dos" is not present or no <CR><NL> is found in the file.
d0049ff5969e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2577
diff changeset
2959 Except: if "unix" was chosen, but there is a <CR> before
d0049ff5969e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2577
diff changeset
2960 the first <NL>, and there appear to be more <CR>s than <NL>s in
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2625
diff changeset
2961 the first few lines, "mac" is used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2962 4. If 'fileformat' is still not set, the first name from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2963 'fileformats' is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2964 When reading a file into an existing buffer, the same is done, but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2965 this happens like 'fileformat' has been set appropriately for that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2966 file only, the option is not changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2967 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformats' is not used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2968
2662
916c90b37ea9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2654
diff changeset
2969 Note that when Vim starts up with an empty buffer this option is not
2681
85c5a72551e2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
2970 used. Set 'fileformat' in your .vimrc instead.
2662
916c90b37ea9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2654
diff changeset
2971
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2972 For systems with a Dos-like <EOL> (<CR><NL>), when reading files that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2973 are ":source"ed and for vimrc files, automatic <EOL> detection may be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2974 done:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2975 - When 'fileformats' is empty, there is no automatic detection. Dos
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2976 format will be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2977 - When 'fileformats' is set to one or more names, automatic detection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2978 is done. This is based on the first <NL> in the file: If there is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2979 <CR> in front of it, Dos format is used, otherwise Unix format is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2980 used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2981 Also see |file-formats|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2982 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to an empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2983 string or one format (no comma is included), 'textauto' is reset,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2984 otherwise 'textauto' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2985 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2986 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2987
4264
2d1383658bb4 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4242
diff changeset
2988 *'fileignorecase'* *'fic'* *'nofileignorecase'* *'nofic'*
2d1383658bb4 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4242
diff changeset
2989 'fileignorecase' 'fic' boolean (default on for systems where case in file
2d1383658bb4 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4242
diff changeset
2990 names is normally ignored)
4242
edd0bc1f26bd updated for version 7.3.872
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4229
diff changeset
2991 global
edd0bc1f26bd updated for version 7.3.872
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4229
diff changeset
2992 {not in Vi}
edd0bc1f26bd updated for version 7.3.872
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4229
diff changeset
2993 When set case is ignored when using file names and directories.
edd0bc1f26bd updated for version 7.3.872
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4229
diff changeset
2994 See 'wildignorecase' for only ignoring case when doing completion.
edd0bc1f26bd updated for version 7.3.872
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4229
diff changeset
2995
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2996 *'filetype'* *'ft'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2997 'filetype' 'ft' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2998 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2999 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3000 {not available when compiled without the |+autocmd|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3001 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3002 When this option is set, the FileType autocommand event is triggered.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3003 All autocommands that match with the value of this option will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3004 executed. Thus the value of 'filetype' is used in place of the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3005 name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3006 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current file type.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3007 This option is normally set when the file type is detected. To enable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3008 this use the ":filetype on" command. |:filetype|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3009 Setting this option to a different value is most useful in a modeline,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3010 for a file for which the file type is not automatically recognized.
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
3011 Example, for in an IDL file:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
3012 /* vim: set filetype=idl : */ ~
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
3013 |FileType| |filetypes|
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
3014 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
3015 names. Example:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
3016 /* vim: set filetype=c.doxygen : */ ~
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
3017 This will use the "c" filetype first, then the "doxygen" filetype.
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
3018 This works both for filetype plugins and for syntax files. More than
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
3019 one dot may appear.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3020 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3021 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3022 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3023
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3024 *'fillchars'* *'fcs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3025 'fillchars' 'fcs' string (default "vert:|,fold:-")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3026 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3027 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3028 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3029 and |+folding| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3030 Characters to fill the statuslines and vertical separators.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3031 It is a comma separated list of items:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3032
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3033 item default Used for ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3034 stl:c ' ' or '^' statusline of the current window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3035 stlnc:c ' ' or '-' statusline of the non-current windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3036 vert:c '|' vertical separators |:vsplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3037 fold:c '-' filling 'foldtext'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3038 diff:c '-' deleted lines of the 'diff' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3039
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3040 Any one that is omitted will fall back to the default. For "stl" and
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3041 "stlnc" the space will be used when there is highlighting, '^' or '-'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3042 otherwise.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3043
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3044 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3045 :set fillchars=stl:^,stlnc:-,vert:\|,fold:-,diff:-
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3046 < This is similar to the default, except that these characters will also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3047 be used when there is highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3048
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
3049 for "stl" and "stlnc" only single-byte values are supported.
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
3050
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3051 The highlighting used for these items:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3052 item highlight group ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3053 stl:c StatusLine |hl-StatusLine|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3054 stlnc:c StatusLineNC |hl-StatusLineNC|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3055 vert:c VertSplit |hl-VertSplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3056 fold:c Folded |hl-Folded|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3057 diff:c DiffDelete |hl-DiffDelete|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3058
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3059 *'fkmap'* *'fk'* *'nofkmap'* *'nofk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3060 'fkmap' 'fk' boolean (default off) *E198*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3061 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3062 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3063 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3064 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3065 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Farsi character set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3066 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3067 toggle this option |i_CTRL-_|. See |farsi.txt|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3068
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3069 *'foldclose'* *'fcl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3070 'foldclose' 'fcl' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3071 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3072 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3073 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3074 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3075 When set to "all", a fold is closed when the cursor isn't in it and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3076 its level is higher than 'foldlevel'. Useful if you want folds to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3077 automatically close when moving out of them.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3078
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3079 *'foldcolumn'* *'fdc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3080 'foldcolumn' 'fdc' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3081 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3082 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3083 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3084 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3085 When non-zero, a column with the specified width is shown at the side
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3086 of the window which indicates open and closed folds. The maximum
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3087 value is 12.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3088 See |folding|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3089
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3090 *'foldenable'* *'fen'* *'nofoldenable'* *'nofen'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3091 'foldenable' 'fen' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3092 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3093 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3094 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3095 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3096 When off, all folds are open. This option can be used to quickly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3097 switch between showing all text unfolded and viewing the text with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3098 folds (including manually opened or closed folds). It can be toggled
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3099 with the |zi| command. The 'foldcolumn' will remain blank when
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3100 'foldenable' is off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3101 This option is set by commands that create a new fold or close a fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3102 See |folding|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3103
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3104 *'foldexpr'* *'fde'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3105 'foldexpr' 'fde' string (default: "0")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3106 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3107 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3108 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
3109 or |+eval| features}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3110 The expression used for when 'foldmethod' is "expr". It is evaluated
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3111 for each line to obtain its fold level. See |fold-expr|.
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
3112
3682
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
3113 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
3114 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3115 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3116 on.
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3117
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3118 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3119 evaluating 'foldexpr' |textlock|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3120
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3121 *'foldignore'* *'fdi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3122 'foldignore' 'fdi' string (default: "#")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3123 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3124 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3125 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3126 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3127 Used only when 'foldmethod' is "indent". Lines starting with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3128 characters in 'foldignore' will get their fold level from surrounding
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3129 lines. White space is skipped before checking for this character.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3130 The default "#" works well for C programs. See |fold-indent|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3131
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3132 *'foldlevel'* *'fdl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3133 'foldlevel' 'fdl' number (default: 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3134 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3135 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3136 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3137 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3138 Sets the fold level: Folds with a higher level will be closed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3139 Setting this option to zero will close all folds. Higher numbers will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3140 close fewer folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3141 This option is set by commands like |zm|, |zM| and |zR|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3142 See |fold-foldlevel|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3143
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3144 *'foldlevelstart'* *'fdls'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3145 'foldlevelstart' 'fdls' number (default: -1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3146 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3147 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3148 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3149 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3150 Sets 'foldlevel' when starting to edit another buffer in a window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3151 Useful to always start editing with all folds closed (value zero),
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3152 some folds closed (one) or no folds closed (99).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3153 This is done before reading any modeline, thus a setting in a modeline
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3154 overrules this option. Starting to edit a file for |diff-mode| also
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3155 ignores this option and closes all folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3156 It is also done before BufReadPre autocommands, to allow an autocmd to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3157 overrule the 'foldlevel' value for specific files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3158 When the value is negative, it is not used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3159
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3160 *'foldmarker'* *'fmr'* *E536*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3161 'foldmarker' 'fmr' string (default: "{{{,}}}")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3162 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3163 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3164 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3165 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3166 The start and end marker used when 'foldmethod' is "marker". There
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3167 must be one comma, which separates the start and end marker. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3168 marker is a literal string (a regular expression would be too slow).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3169 See |fold-marker|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3170
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3171 *'foldmethod'* *'fdm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3172 'foldmethod' 'fdm' string (default: "manual")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3173 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3174 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3175 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3176 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3177 The kind of folding used for the current window. Possible values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3178 |fold-manual| manual Folds are created manually.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3179 |fold-indent| indent Lines with equal indent form a fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3180 |fold-expr| expr 'foldexpr' gives the fold level of a line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3181 |fold-marker| marker Markers are used to specify folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3182 |fold-syntax| syntax Syntax highlighting items specify folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3183 |fold-diff| diff Fold text that is not changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3184
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3185 *'foldminlines'* *'fml'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3186 'foldminlines' 'fml' number (default: 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3187 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3188 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3189 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3190 feature}
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3191 Sets the number of screen lines above which a fold can be displayed
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3192 closed. Also for manually closed folds. With the default value of
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3193 one a fold can only be closed if it takes up two or more screen lines.
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3194 Set to zero to be able to close folds of just one screen line.
2826
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
3195 Note that this only has an effect on what is displayed. After using
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3196 "zc" to close a fold, which is displayed open because it's smaller
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3197 than 'foldminlines', a following "zc" may close a containing fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3198
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3199 *'foldnestmax'* *'fdn'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3200 'foldnestmax' 'fdn' number (default: 20)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3201 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3202 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3203 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3204 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3205 Sets the maximum nesting of folds for the "indent" and "syntax"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3206 methods. This avoids that too many folds will be created. Using more
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3207 than 20 doesn't work, because the internal limit is 20.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3208
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3209 *'foldopen'* *'fdo'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3210 'foldopen' 'fdo' string (default: "block,hor,mark,percent,quickfix,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3211 search,tag,undo")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3212 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3213 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3214 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3215 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3216 Specifies for which type of commands folds will be opened, if the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3217 command moves the cursor into a closed fold. It is a comma separated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3218 list of items.
2625
0aa21d63aba0 Updated runtile files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2608
diff changeset
3219 NOTE: When the command is part of a mapping this option is not used.
0aa21d63aba0 Updated runtile files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2608
diff changeset
3220 Add the |zv| command to the mapping to get the same effect.
0aa21d63aba0 Updated runtile files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2608
diff changeset
3221 (rationale: the mapping may want to control opening folds itself)
0aa21d63aba0 Updated runtile files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2608
diff changeset
3222
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3223 item commands ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3224 all any
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3225 block "(", "{", "[[", "[{", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3226 hor horizontal movements: "l", "w", "fx", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3227 insert any command in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3228 jump far jumps: "G", "gg", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3229 mark jumping to a mark: "'m", CTRL-O, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3230 percent "%"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3231 quickfix ":cn", ":crew", ":make", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3232 search search for a pattern: "/", "n", "*", "gd", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3233 (not for a search pattern in a ":" command)
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
3234 Also for |[s| and |]s|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3235 tag jumping to a tag: ":ta", CTRL-T, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3236 undo undo or redo: "u" and CTRL-R
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3237 When a movement command is used for an operator (e.g., "dl" or "y%")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3238 this option is not used. This means the operator will include the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3239 whole closed fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3240 Note that vertical movements are not here, because it would make it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3241 very difficult to move onto a closed fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3242 In insert mode the folds containing the cursor will always be open
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3243 when text is inserted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3244 To close folds you can re-apply 'foldlevel' with the |zx| command or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3245 set the 'foldclose' option to "all".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3246
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3247 *'foldtext'* *'fdt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3248 'foldtext' 'fdt' string (default: "foldtext()")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3249 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3250 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3251 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3252 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3253 An expression which is used to specify the text displayed for a closed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3254 fold. See |fold-foldtext|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3255
3682
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
3256 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
3257 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3258
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3259 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3260 evaluating 'foldtext' |textlock|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
3261
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3262 *'formatoptions'* *'fo'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3263 'formatoptions' 'fo' string (Vim default: "tcq", Vi default: "vt")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3264 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3265 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3266 This is a sequence of letters which describes how automatic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3267 formatting is to be done. See |fo-table|. When the 'paste' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3268 on, no formatting is done (like 'formatoptions' is empty). Commas can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3269 be inserted for readability.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3270 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3271 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3272 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3273 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3274
41
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3275 *'formatlistpat'* *'flp'*
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3276 'formatlistpat' 'flp' string (default: "^\s*\d\+[\]:.)}\t ]\s*")
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3277 local to buffer
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3278 {not in Vi}
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3279 A pattern that is used to recognize a list header. This is used for
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3280 the "n" flag in 'formatoptions'.
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3281 The pattern must match exactly the text that will be the indent for
140
8ecb0db93e9a updated for version 7.0045
vimboss
parents: 99
diff changeset
3282 the line below it. You can use |/\ze| to mark the end of the match
41
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3283 while still checking more characters. There must be a character
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3284 following the pattern, when it matches the whole line it is handled
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3285 like there is no match.
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3286 The default recognizes a number, followed by an optional punctuation
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3287 character and white space.
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3288
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3289 *'formatprg'* *'fp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3290 'formatprg' 'fp' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3291 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3292 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3293 The name of an external program that will be used to format the lines
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3294 selected with the |gq| operator. The program must take the input on
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3295 stdin and produce the output on stdout. The Unix program "fmt" is
557
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
3296 such a program.
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3297 If the 'formatexpr' option is not empty it will be used instead.
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3298 Otherwise, if 'formatprg' option is an empty string, the internal
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3299 format function will be used |C-indenting|.
557
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
3300 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
862863033fdd updated for version 7.0158
vimboss
parents: 548
diff changeset
3301 about including spaces and backslashes.
3682
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
3302 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
3303 security reasons.
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3304
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3305 *'formatexpr'* *'fex'*
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3306 'formatexpr' 'fex' string (default "")
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3307 local to buffer
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3308 {not in Vi}
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3309 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3310 feature}
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3311 Expression which is evaluated to format a range of lines for the |gq|
2350
06feaf4fe36a Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2349
diff changeset
3312 operator or automatic formatting (see 'formatoptions'). When this
06feaf4fe36a Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2349
diff changeset
3313 option is empty 'formatprg' is used.
844
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 843
diff changeset
3314
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 843
diff changeset
3315 The |v:lnum| variable holds the first line to be formatted.
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
3316 The |v:count| variable holds the number of lines to be formatted.
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
3317 The |v:char| variable holds the character that is going to be
2350
06feaf4fe36a Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2349
diff changeset
3318 inserted if the expression is being evaluated due to
06feaf4fe36a Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2349
diff changeset
3319 automatic formatting. This can be empty. Don't insert
06feaf4fe36a Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2349
diff changeset
3320 it yet!
844
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 843
diff changeset
3321
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3322 Example: >
681
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
3323 :set formatexpr=mylang#Format()
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3324 < This will invoke the mylang#Format() function in the
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3325 autoload/mylang.vim file in 'runtimepath'. |autoload|
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3326
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3327 The expression is also evaluated when 'textwidth' is set and adding
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3328 text beyond that limit. This happens under the same conditions as
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3329 when internal formatting is used. Make sure the cursor is kept in the
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3330 same spot relative to the text then! The |mode()| function will
2298
a3562a127cf6 When 'formatexpr' evaluates to non-zero fall back to internal formatting, also
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2290
diff changeset
3331 return "i" or "R" in this situation.
a3562a127cf6 When 'formatexpr' evaluates to non-zero fall back to internal formatting, also
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2290
diff changeset
3332
a3562a127cf6 When 'formatexpr' evaluates to non-zero fall back to internal formatting, also
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2290
diff changeset
3333 When the expression evaluates to non-zero Vim will fall back to using
a3562a127cf6 When 'formatexpr' evaluates to non-zero fall back to internal formatting, also
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2290
diff changeset
3334 the internal format mechanism.
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3335
3682
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
3336 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
3337 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. That stops the option from working,
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
3338 since changing the buffer text is not allowed.
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3339
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
3340 *'fsync'* *'fs'*
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3341 'fsync' 'fs' boolean (default on)
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3342 global
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3343 {not in Vi}
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3344 When on, the library function fsync() will be called after writing a
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3345 file. This will flush a file to disk, ensuring that it is safely
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3346 written even on filesystems which do metadata-only journaling. This
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3347 will force the harddrive to spin up on Linux systems running in laptop
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3348 mode, so it may be undesirable in some situations. Be warned that
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3349 turning this off increases the chances of data loss after a crash. On
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3350 systems without an fsync() implementation, this variable is always
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3351 off.
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3352 Also see 'swapsync' for controlling fsync() on swap files.
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
3353
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3354 *'gdefault'* *'gd'* *'nogdefault'* *'nogd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3355 'gdefault' 'gd' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3356 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3357 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3358 When on, the ":substitute" flag 'g' is default on. This means that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3359 all matches in a line are substituted instead of one. When a 'g' flag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3360 is given to a ":substitute" command, this will toggle the substitution
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3361 of all or one match. See |complex-change|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3362
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3363 command 'gdefault' on 'gdefault' off ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3364 :s/// subst. all subst. one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3365 :s///g subst. one subst. all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3366 :s///gg subst. all subst. one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3367
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3368 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3369
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3370 *'grepformat'* *'gfm'*
6213
37c24033b260 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6153
diff changeset
3371 'grepformat' 'gfm' string (default "%f:%l:%m,%f:%l%m,%f %l%m")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3372 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3373 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3374 Format to recognize for the ":grep" command output.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3375 This is a scanf-like string that uses the same format as the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3376 'errorformat' option: see |errorformat|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3377
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3378 *'grepprg'* *'gp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3379 'grepprg' 'gp' string (default "grep -n ",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3380 Unix: "grep -n $* /dev/null",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3381 Win32: "findstr /n" or "grep -n",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3382 VMS: "SEARCH/NUMBERS ")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3383 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3384 {not in Vi}
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
3385 Program to use for the |:grep| command. This option may contain '%'
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3386 and '#' characters, which are expanded like when used in a command-
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3387 line. The placeholder "$*" is allowed to specify where the arguments
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3388 will be included. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3389 |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3390 When your "grep" accepts the "-H" argument, use this to make ":grep"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3391 also work well with a single file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3392 :set grepprg=grep\ -nH
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
3393 < Special value: When 'grepprg' is set to "internal" the |:grep| command
657
b112ec5c73f0 updated for version 7.0193
vimboss
parents: 653
diff changeset
3394 works like |:vimgrep|, |:lgrep| like |:lvimgrep|, |:grepadd| like
b112ec5c73f0 updated for version 7.0193
vimboss
parents: 653
diff changeset
3395 |:vimgrepadd| and |:lgrepadd| like |:lvimgrepadd|.
41
f529edb9bab3 updated for version 7.0025
vimboss
parents: 40
diff changeset
3396 See also the section |:make_makeprg|, since most of the comments there
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3397 apply equally to 'grepprg'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3398 For Win32, the default is "findstr /n" if "findstr.exe" can be found,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3399 otherwise it's "grep -n".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3400 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3401 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3402
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3403 *'guicursor'* *'gcr'* *E545* *E546* *E548* *E549*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3404 'guicursor' 'gcr' string (default "n-v-c:block-Cursor/lCursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3405 ve:ver35-Cursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3406 o:hor50-Cursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3407 i-ci:ver25-Cursor/lCursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3408 r-cr:hor20-Cursor/lCursor,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3409 sm:block-Cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3410 -blinkwait175-blinkoff150-blinkon175",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3411 for MS-DOS and Win32 console:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3412 "n-v-c:block,o:hor50,i-ci:hor15,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3413 r-cr:hor30,sm:block")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3414 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3415 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3416 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3417 for MS-DOS and Win32 console}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3418 This option tells Vim what the cursor should look like in different
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3419 modes. It fully works in the GUI. In an MSDOS or Win32 console, only
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3420 the height of the cursor can be changed. This can be done by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3421 specifying a block cursor, or a percentage for a vertical or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3422 horizontal cursor.
6727
7c5a0c69e1ac updated for version 7.4.687
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6647
diff changeset
3423 For a console the 't_SI', 't_SR', and 't_EI' escape sequences are
7c5a0c69e1ac updated for version 7.4.687
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6647
diff changeset
3424 used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3425
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3426 The option is a comma separated list of parts. Each part consist of a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3427 mode-list and an argument-list:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3428 mode-list:argument-list,mode-list:argument-list,..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3429 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3430 n Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3431 v Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3432 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3433 if not specified)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3434 o Operator-pending mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3435 i Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3436 r Replace mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3437 c Command-line Normal (append) mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3438 ci Command-line Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3439 cr Command-line Replace mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3440 sm showmatch in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3441 a all modes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3442 The argument-list is a dash separated list of these arguments:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3443 hor{N} horizontal bar, {N} percent of the character height
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3444 ver{N} vertical bar, {N} percent of the character width
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3445 block block cursor, fills the whole character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3446 [only one of the above three should be present]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3447 blinkwait{N} *cursor-blinking*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3448 blinkon{N}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3449 blinkoff{N}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3450 blink times for cursor: blinkwait is the delay before
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3451 the cursor starts blinking, blinkon is the time that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3452 the cursor is shown and blinkoff is the time that the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3453 cursor is not shown. The times are in msec. When one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3454 of the numbers is zero, there is no blinking. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3455 default is: "blinkwait700-blinkon400-blinkoff250".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3456 These numbers are used for a missing entry. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3457 means that blinking is enabled by default. To switch
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3458 blinking off you can use "blinkon0". The cursor only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3459 blinks when Vim is waiting for input, not while
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3460 executing a command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3461 To make the cursor blink in an xterm, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3462 |xterm-blink|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3463 {group-name}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3464 a highlight group name, that sets the color and font
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3465 for the cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3466 {group-name}/{group-name}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3467 Two highlight group names, the first is used when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3468 no language mappings are used, the other when they
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3469 are. |language-mapping|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3470
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3471 Examples of parts:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3472 n-c-v:block-nCursor in Normal, Command-line and Visual mode, use a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3473 block cursor with colors from the "nCursor"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3474 highlight group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3475 i-ci:ver30-iCursor-blinkwait300-blinkon200-blinkoff150
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3476 In Insert and Command-line Insert mode, use a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3477 30% vertical bar cursor with colors from the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3478 "iCursor" highlight group. Blink a bit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3479 faster.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3480
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3481 The 'a' mode is different. It will set the given argument-list for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3482 all modes. It does not reset anything to defaults. This can be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3483 to do a common setting for all modes. For example, to switch off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3484 blinking: "a:blinkon0"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3485
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3486 Examples of cursor highlighting: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3487 :highlight Cursor gui=reverse guifg=NONE guibg=NONE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3488 :highlight Cursor gui=NONE guifg=bg guibg=fg
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3489 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3490 *'guifont'* *'gfn'*
2908
fd09a9c8468e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2873
diff changeset
3491 *E235* *E596*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3492 'guifont' 'gfn' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3493 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3494 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3495 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3496 This is a list of fonts which will be used for the GUI version of Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3497 In its simplest form the value is just one font name. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3498 the font cannot be found you will get an error message. To try other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3499 font names a list can be specified, font names separated with commas.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3500 The first valid font is used.
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3501
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3502 On systems where 'guifontset' is supported (X11) and 'guifontset' is
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3503 not empty, then 'guifont' is not used.
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3504
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3505 Spaces after a comma are ignored. To include a comma in a font name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3506 precede it with a backslash. Setting an option requires an extra
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3507 backslash before a space and a backslash. See also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3508 |option-backslash|. For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3509 :set guifont=Screen15,\ 7x13,font\\,with\\,commas
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3510 < will make Vim try to use the font "Screen15" first, and if it fails it
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3511 will try to use "7x13" and then "font,with,commas" instead.
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3512
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3513 If none of the fonts can be loaded, Vim will keep the current setting.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3514 If an empty font list is given, Vim will try using other resource
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3515 settings (for X, it will use the Vim.font resource), and finally it
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3516 will try some builtin default which should always be there ("7x13" in
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3517 the case of X). The font names given should be "normal" fonts. Vim
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3518 will try to find the related bold and italic fonts.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3519
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3520 For Win32, GTK, Motif, Mac OS and Photon: >
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3521 :set guifont=*
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3522 < will bring up a font requester, where you can pick the font you want.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3523
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3524 The font name depends on the GUI used. See |setting-guifont| for a
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3525 way to set 'guifont' for various systems.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3526
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3527 For the GTK+ 2 GUI the font name looks like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3528 :set guifont=Andale\ Mono\ 11
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3529 < That's all. XLFDs are not used. For Chinese this is reported to work
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3530 well: >
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3531 if has("gui_gtk2")
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3532 set guifont=Bitstream\ Vera\ Sans\ Mono\ 12,Fixed\ 12
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3533 set guifontwide=Microsoft\ Yahei\ 12,WenQuanYi\ Zen\ Hei\ 12
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3534 endif
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3535 <
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3536 For Mac OSX you can use something like this: >
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 168
diff changeset
3537 :set guifont=Monaco:h10
853
d10fbefd3bc1 updated for version 7.0f05
vimboss
parents: 844
diff changeset
3538 < Also see 'macatsui', it can help fix display problems.
d10fbefd3bc1 updated for version 7.0f05
vimboss
parents: 844
diff changeset
3539 *E236*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3540 Note that the fonts must be mono-spaced (all characters have the same
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3541 width). An exception is GTK 2: all fonts are accepted, but
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3542 mono-spaced fonts look best.
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3543
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3544 To preview a font on X11, you might be able to use the "xfontsel"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3545 program. The "xlsfonts" program gives a list of all available fonts.
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3546
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3547 For the Win32 GUI *E244* *E245*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3548 - takes these options in the font name:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3549 hXX - height is XX (points, can be floating-point)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3550 wXX - width is XX (points, can be floating-point)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3551 b - bold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3552 i - italic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3553 u - underline
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3554 s - strikeout
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
3555 cXX - character set XX. Valid charsets are: ANSI, ARABIC,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3556 BALTIC, CHINESEBIG5, DEFAULT, EASTEUROPE, GB2312, GREEK,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3557 HANGEUL, HEBREW, JOHAB, MAC, OEM, RUSSIAN, SHIFTJIS,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3558 SYMBOL, THAI, TURKISH, VIETNAMESE ANSI and BALTIC.
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 20
diff changeset
3559 Normally you would use "cDEFAULT".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3560
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3561 Use a ':' to separate the options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3562 - A '_' can be used in the place of a space, so you don't need to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3563 backslashes to escape the spaces.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3564 - Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3565 :set guifont=courier_new:h12:w5:b:cRUSSIAN
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3566 :set guifont=Andale_Mono:h7.5:w4.5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3567 < See also |font-sizes|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3568
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3569 *'guifontset'* *'gfs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3570 *E250* *E252* *E234* *E597* *E598*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3571 'guifontset' 'gfs' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3572 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3573 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3574 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3575 with the |+xfontset| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3576 {not available in the GTK+ 2 GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3577 When not empty, specifies two (or more) fonts to be used. The first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3578 one for normal English, the second one for your special language. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3579 |xfontset|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3580 Setting this option also means that all font names will be handled as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3581 a fontset name. Also the ones used for the "font" argument of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3582 |:highlight| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3583 The fonts must match with the current locale. If fonts for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3584 character sets that the current locale uses are not included, setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3585 'guifontset' will fail.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3586 Note the difference between 'guifont' and 'guifontset': In 'guifont'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3587 the comma-separated names are alternative names, one of which will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3588 used. In 'guifontset' the whole string is one fontset name,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3589 including the commas. It is not possible to specify alternative
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3590 fontset names.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3591 This example works on many X11 systems: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3592 :set guifontset=-*-*-medium-r-normal--16-*-*-*-c-*-*-*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3593 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3594 *'guifontwide'* *'gfw'* *E231* *E533* *E534*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3595 'guifontwide' 'gfw' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3596 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3597 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3598 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3599 When not empty, specifies a comma-separated list of fonts to be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3600 for double-width characters. The first font that can be loaded is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3601 used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3602 Note: The size of these fonts must be exactly twice as wide as the one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3603 specified with 'guifont' and the same height.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3604
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3605 All GUI versions but GTK+ 2:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3606
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3607 'guifontwide' is only used when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3608 'guifontset' is empty or invalid.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3609 When 'guifont' is set and a valid font is found in it and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3610 'guifontwide' is empty Vim will attempt to find a matching
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3611 double-width font and set 'guifontwide' to it.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3612
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3613 GTK+ 2 GUI only: *guifontwide_gtk2*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3614
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3615 If set and valid, 'guifontwide' is always used for double width
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3616 characters, even if 'encoding' is not set to "utf-8".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3617 Vim does not attempt to find an appropriate value for 'guifontwide'
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3618 automatically. If 'guifontwide' is empty Pango/Xft will choose the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3619 font for characters not available in 'guifont'. Thus you do not need
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3620 to set 'guifontwide' at all unless you want to override the choice
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3621 made by Pango/Xft.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3622
4055
0de969850c06 updated for version 7.3.782
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3920
diff changeset
3623 Windows +multibyte only: *guifontwide_win_mbyte*
0de969850c06 updated for version 7.3.782
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3920
diff changeset
3624
4073
e362db8b2d7b Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4055
diff changeset
3625 If set and valid, 'guifontwide' is used for IME instead of 'guifont'.
4055
0de969850c06 updated for version 7.3.782
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3920
diff changeset
3626
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3627 *'guiheadroom'* *'ghr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3628 'guiheadroom' 'ghr' number (default 50)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3629 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3630 {not in Vi} {only for GTK and X11 GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3631 The number of pixels subtracted from the screen height when fitting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3632 the GUI window on the screen. Set this before the GUI is started,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3633 e.g., in your |gvimrc| file. When zero, the whole screen height will
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3634 be used by the window. When positive, the specified number of pixel
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3635 lines will be left for window decorations and other items on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3636 screen. Set it to a negative value to allow windows taller than the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3637 screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3638
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3639 *'guioptions'* *'go'*
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
3640 'guioptions' 'go' string (default "egmrLtT" (MS-Windows),
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
3641 "aegimrLtT" (GTK, Motif and Athena))
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3642 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3643 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3644 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
3645 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim. It is a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3646 sequence of letters which describes what components and options of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3647 GUI should be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3648 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3649 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3650
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3651 Valid letters are as follows:
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3652 *guioptions_a* *'go-a'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3653 'a' Autoselect: If present, then whenever VISUAL mode is started,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3654 or the Visual area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3655 the windowing system's global selection. This means that the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3656 Visually highlighted text is available for pasting into other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3657 applications as well as into Vim itself. When the Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3658 ends, possibly due to an operation on the text, or when an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3659 application wants to paste the selection, the highlighted text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3660 is automatically yanked into the "* selection register.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3661 Thus the selection is still available for pasting into other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3662 applications after the VISUAL mode has ended.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3663 If not present, then Vim won't become the owner of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3664 windowing system's global selection unless explicitly told to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3665 by a yank or delete operation for the "* register.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3666 The same applies to the modeless selection.
3674
b9aa7fb4a928 updated for version 7.3.597
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3557
diff changeset
3667 *'go-P'*
b9aa7fb4a928 updated for version 7.3.597
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3557
diff changeset
3668 'P' Like autoselect but using the "+ register instead of the "*
b9aa7fb4a928 updated for version 7.3.597
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3557
diff changeset
3669 register.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3670 *'go-A'*
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3671 'A' Autoselect for the modeless selection. Like 'a', but only
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3672 applies to the modeless selection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3673
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3674 'guioptions' autoselect Visual autoselect modeless ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3675 "" - -
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3676 "a" yes yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3677 "A" - yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3678 "aA" yes yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3679
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3680 *'go-c'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3681 'c' Use console dialogs instead of popup dialogs for simple
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3682 choices.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3683 *'go-e'*
697
f08390485cd3 updated for version 7.0210
vimboss
parents: 694
diff changeset
3684 'e' Add tab pages when indicated with 'showtabline'.
688
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3685 'guitablabel' can be used to change the text in the labels.
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3686 When 'e' is missing a non-GUI tab pages line may be used.
857
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
3687 The GUI tabs are only supported on some systems, currently
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
3688 GTK, Motif, Mac OS/X and MS-Windows.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3689 *'go-f'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3690 'f' Foreground: Don't use fork() to detach the GUI from the shell
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3691 where it was started. Use this for programs that wait for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3692 editor to finish (e.g., an e-mail program). Alternatively you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3693 can use "gvim -f" or ":gui -f" to start the GUI in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3694 foreground. |gui-fork|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3695 Note: Set this option in the vimrc file. The forking may have
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
3696 happened already when the |gvimrc| file is read.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3697 *'go-i'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3698 'i' Use a Vim icon. For GTK with KDE it is used in the left-upper
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3699 corner of the window. It's black&white on non-GTK, because of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3700 limitations of X11. For a color icon, see |X11-icon|.
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3701 *'go-m'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3702 'm' Menu bar is present.
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3703 *'go-M'*
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3704 'M' The system menu "$VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim" is not sourced. Note
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3705 that this flag must be added in the .vimrc file, before
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
3706 switching on syntax or filetype recognition (when the |gvimrc|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3707 file is sourced the system menu has already been loaded; the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3708 ":syntax on" and ":filetype on" commands load the menu too).
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3709 *'go-g'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3710 'g' Grey menu items: Make menu items that are not active grey. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3711 'g' is not included inactive menu items are not shown at all.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3712 Exception: Athena will always use grey menu items.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3713 *'go-t'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3714 't' Include tearoff menu items. Currently only works for Win32,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3715 GTK+, and Motif 1.2 GUI.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3716 *'go-T'*
236
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
3717 'T' Include Toolbar. Currently only in Win32, GTK+, Motif, Photon
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
3718 and Athena GUIs.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3719 *'go-r'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3720 'r' Right-hand scrollbar is always present.
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3721 *'go-R'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3722 'R' Right-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3723 split window.
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3724 *'go-l'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3725 'l' Left-hand scrollbar is always present.
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3726 *'go-L'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3727 'L' Left-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3728 split window.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3729 *'go-b'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3730 'b' Bottom (horizontal) scrollbar is present. Its size depends on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3731 the longest visible line, or on the cursor line if the 'h'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3732 flag is included. |gui-horiz-scroll|
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3733 *'go-h'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3734 'h' Limit horizontal scrollbar size to the length of the cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3735 line. Reduces computations. |gui-horiz-scroll|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3736
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3737 And yes, you may even have scrollbars on the left AND the right if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3738 you really want to :-). See |gui-scrollbars| for more information.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3739
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3740 *'go-v'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3741 'v' Use a vertical button layout for dialogs. When not included,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3742 a horizontal layout is preferred, but when it doesn't fit a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3743 vertical layout is used anyway.
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3744 *'go-p'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3745 'p' Use Pointer callbacks for X11 GUI. This is required for some
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3746 window managers. If the cursor is not blinking or hollow at
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3747 the right moment, try adding this flag. This must be done
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
3748 before starting the GUI. Set it in your |gvimrc|. Adding or
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3749 removing it after the GUI has started has no effect.
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3750 *'go-F'*
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3751 'F' Add a footer. Only for Motif. See |gui-footer|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3752
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
3753
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3754 *'guipty'* *'noguipty'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3755 'guipty' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3756 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3757 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3758 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3759 Only in the GUI: If on, an attempt is made to open a pseudo-tty for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3760 I/O to/from shell commands. See |gui-pty|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3761
688
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3762 *'guitablabel'* *'gtl'*
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3763 'guitablabel' 'gtl' string (default empty)
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3764 global
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3765 {not in Vi}
692
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
3766 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
3767 with the |+windows| feature}
688
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3768 When nonempty describes the text to use in a label of the GUI tab
857
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
3769 pages line. When empty and when the result is empty Vim will use a
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
3770 default label. See |setting-guitablabel| for more info.
688
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3771
692
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
3772 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'.
839
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3773 'guitabtooltip' is used for the tooltip, see below.
692
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
3774
688
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3775 Only used when the GUI tab pages line is displayed. 'e' must be
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3776 present in 'guioptions'. For the non-GUI tab pages line 'tabline' is
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3777 used.
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
3778
839
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3779 *'guitabtooltip'* *'gtt'*
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3780 'guitabtooltip' 'gtt' string (default empty)
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3781 global
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3782 {not in Vi}
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3783 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
3784 with the |+windows| feature}
839
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3785 When nonempty describes the text to use in a tooltip for the GUI tab
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3786 pages line. When empty Vim will use a default tooltip.
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3787 This option is otherwise just like 'guitablabel' above.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3788 You can include a line break. Simplest method is to use |:let|: >
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3789 :let &guitabtooltip = "line one\nline two"
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
3790 <
839
1f3b1021f002 updated for version 7.0e05
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
3791
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3792 *'helpfile'* *'hf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3793 'helpfile' 'hf' string (default (MSDOS) "$VIMRUNTIME\doc\help.txt"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3794 (others) "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3795 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3796 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3797 Name of the main help file. All distributed help files should be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3798 placed together in one directory. Additionally, all "doc" directories
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3799 in 'runtimepath' will be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3800 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. For example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3801 "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt". If $VIMRUNTIME is not set, $VIM is also
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3802 tried. Also see |$VIMRUNTIME| and |option-backslash| about including
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3803 spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3804 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3805 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3806
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3807 *'helpheight'* *'hh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3808 'helpheight' 'hh' number (default 20)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3809 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3810 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
3811 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3812 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3813 Minimal initial height of the help window when it is opened with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3814 ":help" command. The initial height of the help window is half of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3815 current window, or (when the 'ea' option is on) the same as other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3816 windows. When the height is less than 'helpheight', the height is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3817 set to 'helpheight'. Set to zero to disable.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3818
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3819 *'helplang'* *'hlg'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3820 'helplang' 'hlg' string (default: messages language or empty)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3821 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3822 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_lang|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3823 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3824 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3825 Comma separated list of languages. Vim will use the first language
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3826 for which the desired help can be found. The English help will always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3827 be used as a last resort. You can add "en" to prefer English over
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3828 another language, but that will only find tags that exist in that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3829 language and not in the English help.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3830 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3831 :set helplang=de,it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3832 < This will first search German, then Italian and finally English help
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3833 files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3834 When using |CTRL-]| and ":help!" in a non-English help file Vim will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3835 try to find the tag in the current language before using this option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3836 See |help-translated|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3837
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3838 *'hidden'* *'hid'* *'nohidden'* *'nohid'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3839 'hidden' 'hid' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3840 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3841 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3842 When off a buffer is unloaded when it is |abandon|ed. When on a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3843 buffer becomes hidden when it is |abandon|ed. If the buffer is still
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3844 displayed in another window, it does not become hidden, of course.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3845 The commands that move through the buffer list sometimes make a buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3846 hidden although the 'hidden' option is off: When the buffer is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3847 modified, 'autowrite' is off or writing is not possible, and the '!'
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3848 flag was used. See also |windows.txt|.
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
3849 To only make one buffer hidden use the 'bufhidden' option.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3850 This option is set for one command with ":hide {command}" |:hide|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3851 WARNING: It's easy to forget that you have changes in hidden buffers.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3852 Think twice when using ":q!" or ":qa!".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3853
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3854 *'highlight'* *'hl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3855 'highlight' 'hl' string (default (as a single string):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3856 "8:SpecialKey,@:NonText,d:Directory,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3857 e:ErrorMsg,i:IncSearch,l:Search,m:MoreMsg,
3445
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
3858 M:ModeMsg,n:LineNr,N:CursorLineNr,
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
3859 r:Question,s:StatusLine,S:StatusLineNC,
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
3860 c:VertSplit, t:Title,v:Visual,
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
3861 w:WarningMsg,W:WildMenu,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3862 f:Folded,F:FoldColumn,A:DiffAdd,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3863 C:DiffChange,D:DiffDelete,T:DiffText,
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3864 >:SignColumn,B:SpellBad,P:SpellCap,
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
3865 R:SpellRare,L:SpellLocal,-:Conceal,
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3866 +:Pmenu,=:PmenuSel,
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3867 x:PmenuSbar,X:PmenuThumb")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3868 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3869 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3870 This option can be used to set highlighting mode for various
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3871 occasions. It is a comma separated list of character pairs. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3872 first character in a pair gives the occasion, the second the mode to
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3873 use for that occasion. The occasions are:
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3874 |hl-SpecialKey| 8 Meta and special keys listed with ":map"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3875 |hl-NonText| @ '~' and '@' at the end of the window and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3876 characters from 'showbreak'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3877 |hl-Directory| d directories in CTRL-D listing and other special
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3878 things in listings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3879 |hl-ErrorMsg| e error messages
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3880 h (obsolete, ignored)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3881 |hl-IncSearch| i 'incsearch' highlighting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3882 |hl-Search| l last search pattern highlighting (see 'hlsearch')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3883 |hl-MoreMsg| m |more-prompt|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3884 |hl-ModeMsg| M Mode (e.g., "-- INSERT --")
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
3885 |hl-LineNr| n line number for ":number" and ":#" commands, and
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
3886 when 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set.
4073
e362db8b2d7b Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4055
diff changeset
3887 |hl-CursorLineNr| N like n for when 'cursorline' or 'relativenumber' is
e362db8b2d7b Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4055
diff changeset
3888 set.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3889 |hl-Question| r |hit-enter| prompt and yes/no questions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3890 |hl-StatusLine| s status line of current window |status-line|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3891 |hl-StatusLineNC| S status lines of not-current windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3892 |hl-Title| t Titles for output from ":set all", ":autocmd" etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3893 |hl-VertSplit| c column used to separate vertically split windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3894 |hl-Visual| v Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3895 |hl-VisualNOS| V Visual mode when Vim does is "Not Owning the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3896 Selection" Only X11 Gui's |gui-x11| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3897 |xterm-clipboard|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3898 |hl-WarningMsg| w warning messages
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3899 |hl-WildMenu| W wildcard matches displayed for 'wildmenu'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3900 |hl-Folded| f line used for closed folds
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3901 |hl-FoldColumn| F 'foldcolumn'
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3902 |hl-DiffAdd| A added line in diff mode
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3903 |hl-DiffChange| C changed line in diff mode
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3904 |hl-DiffDelete| D deleted line in diff mode
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
3905 |hl-DiffText| T inserted text in diff mode
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3906 |hl-SignColumn| > column used for |signs|
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
3907 |hl-SpellBad| B misspelled word |spell|
2337
a0f87fc19d1d Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2324
diff changeset
3908 |hl-SpellCap| P word that should start with capital |spell|
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
3909 |hl-SpellRare| R rare word |spell|
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
3910 |hl-SpellLocal| L word from other region |spell|
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
3911 |hl-Conceal| - the placeholders used for concealed characters
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
3912 (see 'conceallevel')
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3913 |hl-Pmenu| + popup menu normal line
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3914 |hl-PmenuSel| = popup menu normal line
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3915 |hl-PmenuSbar| x popup menu scrollbar
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
3916 |hl-PmenuThumb| X popup menu scrollbar thumb
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3917
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3918 The display modes are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3919 r reverse (termcap entry "mr" and "me")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3920 i italic (termcap entry "ZH" and "ZR")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3921 b bold (termcap entry "md" and "me")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3922 s standout (termcap entry "so" and "se")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3923 u underline (termcap entry "us" and "ue")
205
d292c40ca788 updated for version 7.0060
vimboss
parents: 199
diff changeset
3924 c undercurl (termcap entry "Cs" and "Ce")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3925 n no highlighting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3926 - no highlighting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3927 : use a highlight group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3928 The default is used for occasions that are not included.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3929 If you want to change what the display modes do, see |dos-colors|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3930 for an example.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3931 When using the ':' display mode, this must be followed by the name of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3932 a highlight group. A highlight group can be used to define any type
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3933 of highlighting, including using color. See |:highlight| on how to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3934 define one. The default uses a different group for each occasion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3935 See |highlight-default| for the default highlight groups.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3936
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3937 *'hlsearch'* *'hls'* *'nohlsearch'* *'nohls'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3938 'hlsearch' 'hls' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3939 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3940 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3941 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3942 |+extra_search| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3943 When there is a previous search pattern, highlight all its matches.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3944 The type of highlighting used can be set with the 'l' occasion in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3945 'highlight' option. This uses the "Search" highlight group by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3946 default. Note that only the matching text is highlighted, any offsets
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3947 are not applied.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3948 See also: 'incsearch' and |:match|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3949 When you get bored looking at the highlighted matches, you can turn it
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
3950 off with |:nohlsearch|. This does not change the option value, as
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
3951 soon as you use a search command, the highlighting comes back.
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
3952 'redrawtime' specifies the maximum time spent on finding matches.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3953 When the search pattern can match an end-of-line, Vim will try to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3954 highlight all of the matched text. However, this depends on where the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
3955 search starts. This will be the first line in the window or the first
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3956 line below a closed fold. A match in a previous line which is not
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
3957 drawn may not continue in a newly drawn line.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
3958 You can specify whether the highlight status is restored on startup
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
3959 with the 'h' flag in 'viminfo' |viminfo-h|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3960 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3961
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3962 *'history'* *'hi'*
5991
a42ba1e50992 updated for version 7.4.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5968
diff changeset
3963 'history' 'hi' number (Vim default: 50, Vi default: 0)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3964 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3965 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3966 A history of ":" commands, and a history of previous search patterns
5991
a42ba1e50992 updated for version 7.4.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5968
diff changeset
3967 is remembered. This option decides how many entries may be stored in
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3968 each of these histories (see |cmdline-editing|).
5991
a42ba1e50992 updated for version 7.4.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5968
diff changeset
3969 The maximum value is 10000.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3970 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3971 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3972
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3973 *'hkmap'* *'hk'* *'nohkmap'* *'nohk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3974 'hkmap' 'hk' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3975 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3976 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3977 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3978 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3979 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Hebrew character set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3980 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3981 toggle this option. See |rileft.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3982 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3983
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3984 *'hkmapp'* *'hkp'* *'nohkmapp'* *'nohkp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3985 'hkmapp' 'hkp' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3986 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3987 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3988 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3989 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3990 When on, phonetic keyboard mapping is used. 'hkmap' must also be on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3991 This is useful if you have a non-Hebrew keyboard.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3992 See |rileft.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3993 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3994
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3995 *'icon'* *'noicon'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3996 'icon' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3997 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3998 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3999 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4000 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4001 When on, the icon text of the window will be set to the value of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4002 'iconstring' (if it is not empty), or to the name of the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4003 currently being edited. Only the last part of the name is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4004 Overridden by the 'iconstring' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4005 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icons (currently
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4006 only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option - these are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4007 Unix xterm and iris-ansi by default, where 't_IS' is taken from the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4008 builtin termcap).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4009 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
4010 restored if possible |X11|. See |X11-icon| for changing the icon on
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4011 X11.
6259
bd18da914be9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6243
diff changeset
4012 For MS-Windows the icon can be changed, see |windows-icon|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4013
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4014 *'iconstring'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4015 'iconstring' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4016 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4017 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4018 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4019 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4020 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the icon text of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4021 the window. This happens only when the 'icon' option is on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4022 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icon text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4023 (currently only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4024 Does not work for MS Windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4025 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4026 restored if possible |X11|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4027 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4028 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. See
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4029 'titlestring' for example settings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4030 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4031
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4032 *'ignorecase'* *'ic'* *'noignorecase'* *'noic'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4033 'ignorecase' 'ic' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4034 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4035 Ignore case in search patterns. Also used when searching in the tags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4036 file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4037 Also see 'smartcase'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4038 Can be overruled by using "\c" or "\C" in the pattern, see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4039 |/ignorecase|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4040
5008
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4041 *'imactivatefunc'* *'imaf'*
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4042 'imactivatefunc' 'imaf' string (default "")
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4043 global
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4044 {not in Vi}
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4045 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4046 |+GUI_GTK|}
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4047 This option specifies a function that will be called to
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4048 activate/inactivate Input Method.
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4049
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4050 Example: >
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4051 function ImActivateFunc(active)
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4052 if a:active
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4053 ... do something
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4054 else
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4055 ... do something
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4056 endif
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4057 " return value is not used
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4058 endfunction
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4059 set imactivatefunc=ImActivateFunc
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4060 <
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4061 *'imactivatekey'* *'imak'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4062 'imactivatekey' 'imak' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4063 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4064 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4065 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
2209
d0ddf7ba1630 Included the patch to support netbeans in a terminal.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
4066 |+GUI_GTK|} *E599*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4067 Specifies the key that your Input Method in X-Windows uses for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4068 activation. When this is specified correctly, vim can fully control
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4069 IM with 'imcmdline', 'iminsert' and 'imsearch'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4070 You can't use this option to change the activation key, the option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4071 tells Vim what the key is.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4072 Format:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4073 [MODIFIER_FLAG-]KEY_STRING
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4074
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4075 These characters can be used for MODIFIER_FLAG (case is ignored):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4076 S Shift key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4077 L Lock key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4078 C Control key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4079 1 Mod1 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4080 2 Mod2 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4081 3 Mod3 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4082 4 Mod4 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4083 5 Mod5 key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4084 Combinations are allowed, for example "S-C-space" or "SC-space" are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4085 both shift+ctrl+space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4086 See <X11/keysymdef.h> and XStringToKeysym for KEY_STRING.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4087
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4088 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4089 :set imactivatekey=S-space
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4090 < "S-space" means shift+space. This is the activation key for kinput2 +
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4091 canna (Japanese), and ami (Korean).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4092
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4093 *'imcmdline'* *'imc'* *'noimcmdline'* *'noimc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4094 'imcmdline' 'imc' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4095 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4096 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
4097 {only available when compiled with the |+xim|,
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
4098 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime| features}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4099 When set the Input Method is always on when starting to edit a command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4100 line, unless entering a search pattern (see 'imsearch' for that).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4101 Setting this option is useful when your input method allows entering
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4102 English characters directly, e.g., when it's used to type accented
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4103 characters with dead keys.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4104
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4105 *'imdisable'* *'imd'* *'noimdisable'* *'noimd'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4106 'imdisable' 'imd' boolean (default off, on for some systems (SGI))
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4107 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4108 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
4109 {only available when compiled with the |+xim|,
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
4110 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime| features}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4111 When set the Input Method is never used. This is useful to disable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4112 the IM when it doesn't work properly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4113 Currently this option is on by default for SGI/IRIX machines. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4114 may change in later releases.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4115
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4116 *'iminsert'* *'imi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4117 'iminsert' 'imi' number (default 0, 2 when an input method is supported)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4118 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4119 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4120 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4121 Insert mode. Valid values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4122 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4123 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4124 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4125 2 is available only when compiled with the |+multi_byte_ime|, |+xim|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4126 or |global-ime|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4127 To always reset the option to zero when leaving Insert mode with <Esc>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4128 this can be used: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4129 :inoremap <ESC> <ESC>:set iminsert=0<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4130 < This makes :lmap and IM turn off automatically when leaving Insert
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4131 mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4132 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4133 |i_CTRL-^|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4134 The value is set to 1 when setting 'keymap' to a valid keymap name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4135 It is also used for the argument of commands like "r" and "f".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4136 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4137 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4138
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4139 *'imsearch'* *'ims'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4140 'imsearch' 'ims' number (default 0, 2 when an input method is supported)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4141 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4142 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4143 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4144 entering a search pattern. Valid values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4145 -1 the value of 'iminsert' is used, makes it look like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4146 'iminsert' is also used when typing a search pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4147 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4148 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4149 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4150 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Command-line mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4151 |c_CTRL-^|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4152 The value is set to 1 when it is not -1 and setting the 'keymap'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4153 option to a valid keymap name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4154 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4155 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4156
5008
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4157 *'imstatusfunc'* *'imsf'*
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4158 'imstatusfunc' 'imsf' string (default "")
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4159 global
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4160 {not in Vi}
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4161 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4162 |+GUI_GTK|}
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4163 This option specifies a function that is called to obtain the status
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4164 of Input Method. It must return a positive number when IME is active.
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4165
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4166 Example: >
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4167 function ImStatusFunc()
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4168 let is_active = ...do something
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4169 return is_active ? 1 : 0
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4170 endfunction
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4171 set imstatusfunc=ImStatusFunc
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4172 <
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4173 NOTE: This function is invoked very often. Keep it fast.
3717d569027d updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4869
diff changeset
4174
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4175 *'include'* *'inc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4176 'include' 'inc' string (default "^\s*#\s*include")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4177 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4178 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4179 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4180 |+find_in_path| feature}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4181 Pattern to be used to find an include command. It is a search
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4182 pattern, just like for the "/" command (See |pattern|). The default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4183 value is for C programs. This option is used for the commands "[i",
532
7052f11a3dc9 updated for version 7.0150
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
4184 "]I", "[d", etc.
7052f11a3dc9 updated for version 7.0150
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
4185 Normally the 'isfname' option is used to recognize the file name that
534
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
4186 comes after the matched pattern. But if "\zs" appears in the pattern
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
4187 then the text matched from "\zs" to the end, or until "\ze" if it
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
4188 appears, is used as the file name. Use this to include characters
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
4189 that are not in 'isfname', such as a space. You can then use
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
4190 'includeexpr' to process the matched text.
532
7052f11a3dc9 updated for version 7.0150
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
4191 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4192
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4193 *'includeexpr'* *'inex'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4194 'includeexpr' 'inex' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4195 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4196 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4197 {not available when compiled without the
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
4198 |+find_in_path| or |+eval| features}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4199 Expression to be used to transform the string found with the 'include'
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4200 option to a file name. Mostly useful to change "." to "/" for Java: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4201 :set includeexpr=substitute(v:fname,'\\.','/','g')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4202 < The "v:fname" variable will be set to the file name that was detected.
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4203
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4204 Also used for the |gf| command if an unmodified file name can't be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4205 found. Allows doing "gf" on the name after an 'include' statement.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4206 Also used for |<cfile>|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4207
3682
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
4208 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
4209 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4210
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4211 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4212 evaluating 'includeexpr' |textlock|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4213
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4214 *'incsearch'* *'is'* *'noincsearch'* *'nois'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4215 'incsearch' 'is' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4216 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4217 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4218 {not available when compiled without the
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
4219 |+extra_search| features}
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4220 While typing a search command, show where the pattern, as it was typed
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4221 so far, matches. The matched string is highlighted. If the pattern
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4222 is invalid or not found, nothing is shown. The screen will be updated
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4223 often, this is only useful on fast terminals.
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4224 Note that the match will be shown, but the cursor will return to its
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4225 original position when no match is found and when pressing <Esc>. You
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4226 still need to finish the search command with <Enter> to move the
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4227 cursor to the match.
1521
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
4228 When compiled with the |+reltime| feature Vim only searches for about
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
4229 half a second. With a complicated pattern and/or a lot of text the
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
4230 match may not be found. This is to avoid that Vim hangs while you
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
4231 are typing the pattern.
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4232 The highlighting can be set with the 'i' flag in 'highlight'.
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
4233 See also: 'hlsearch'.
772
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
4234 CTRL-L can be used to add one character from after the current match
2302
488be8cbe19c Make CTRL-L in command line mode respect 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase'. (Martin
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
4235 to the command line. If 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase' are set and the
488be8cbe19c Make CTRL-L in command line mode respect 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase'. (Martin
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
4236 command line has no uppercase characters, the added character is
488be8cbe19c Make CTRL-L in command line mode respect 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase'. (Martin
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
4237 converted to lowercase.
772
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
4238 CTRL-R CTRL-W can be used to add the word at the end of the current
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
4239 match, excluding the characters that were already typed.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4240 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4241
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4242 *'indentexpr'* *'inde'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4243 'indentexpr' 'inde' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4244 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4245 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4246 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4247 or |+eval| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4248 Expression which is evaluated to obtain the proper indent for a line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4249 It is used when a new line is created, for the |=| operator and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4250 in Insert mode as specified with the 'indentkeys' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4251 When this option is not empty, it overrules the 'cindent' and
2833
c869ff170ddc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
4252 'smartindent' indenting. When 'lisp' is set, this option is
c869ff170ddc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
4253 overridden by the Lisp indentation algorithm.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4254 When 'paste' is set this option is not used for indenting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4255 The expression is evaluated with |v:lnum| set to the line number for
534
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
4256 which the indent is to be computed. The cursor is also in this line
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4257 when the expression is evaluated (but it may be moved around).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4258 The expression must return the number of spaces worth of indent. It
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4259 can return "-1" to keep the current indent (this means 'autoindent' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4260 used for the indent).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4261 Functions useful for computing the indent are |indent()|, |cindent()|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4262 and |lispindent()|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4263 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! It must
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4264 not change the text, jump to another window, etc. Afterwards the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4265 cursor position is always restored, thus the cursor may be moved.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4266 Normally this option would be set to call a function: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4267 :set indentexpr=GetMyIndent()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4268 < Error messages will be suppressed, unless the 'debug' option contains
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4269 "msg".
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4270 See |indent-expression|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4271 NOTE: This option is made empty when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4272
3682
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
4273 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
4274 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4275
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4276 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4277 evaluating 'indentexpr' |textlock|.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4278
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4279
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4280 *'indentkeys'* *'indk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4281 'indentkeys' 'indk' string (default "0{,0},:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4282 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4283 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4284 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4285 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4286 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4287 the current line. Only happens if 'indentexpr' isn't empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4288 The format is identical to 'cinkeys', see |indentkeys-format|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4289 See |C-indenting| and |indent-expression|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4290
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4291 *'infercase'* *'inf'* *'noinfercase'* *'noinf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4292 'infercase' 'inf' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4293 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4294 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4295 When doing keyword completion in insert mode |ins-completion|, and
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4296 'ignorecase' is also on, the case of the match is adjusted depending
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4297 on the typed text. If the typed text contains a lowercase letter
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4298 where the match has an upper case letter, the completed part is made
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4299 lowercase. If the typed text has no lowercase letters and the match
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4300 has a lowercase letter where the typed text has an uppercase letter,
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4301 and there is a letter before it, the completed part is made uppercase.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4302 With 'noinfercase' the match is used as-is.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4303
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4304 *'insertmode'* *'im'* *'noinsertmode'* *'noim'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4305 'insertmode' 'im' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4306 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4307 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4308 Makes Vim work in a way that Insert mode is the default mode. Useful
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4309 if you want to use Vim as a modeless editor. Used for |evim|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4310 These Insert mode commands will be useful:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4311 - Use the cursor keys to move around.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4312 - Use CTRL-O to execute one Normal mode command |i_CTRL-O|). When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4313 this is a mapping, it is executed as if 'insertmode' was off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4314 Normal mode remains active until the mapping is finished.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4315 - Use CTRL-L to execute a number of Normal mode commands, then use
477
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 464
diff changeset
4316 <Esc> to get back to Insert mode. Note that CTRL-L moves the cursor
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 464
diff changeset
4317 left, like <Esc> does when 'insertmode' isn't set. |i_CTRL-L|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4318
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4319 These items change when 'insertmode' is set:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4320 - when starting to edit of a file, Vim goes to Insert mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4321 - <Esc> in Insert mode is a no-op and beeps.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4322 - <Esc> in Normal mode makes Vim go to Insert mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4323 - CTRL-L in Insert mode is a command, it is not inserted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4324 - CTRL-Z in Insert mode suspends Vim, see |CTRL-Z|. *i_CTRL-Z*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4325 However, when <Esc> is used inside a mapping, it behaves like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4326 'insertmode' was not set. This was done to be able to use the same
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4327 mappings with 'insertmode' set or not set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4328 When executing commands with |:normal| 'insertmode' is not used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4329
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4330 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4331
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4332 *'isfname'* *'isf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4333 'isfname' 'isf' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4334 "@,48-57,/,\,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,{,},[,],:,@-@,!,~,="
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4335 for AMIGA: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,$,:"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4336 for VMS: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,<,>,[,],:,;,~"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4337 for OS/390: "@,240-249,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,="
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4338 otherwise: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4339 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4340 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4341 The characters specified by this option are included in file names and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4342 path names. Filenames are used for commands like "gf", "[i" and in
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4343 the tags file. It is also used for "\f" in a |pattern|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4344 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4345 characters up to 255 are specified with this option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4346 For UTF-8 the characters 0xa0 to 0xff are included as well.
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4347 Think twice before adding white space to this option. Although a
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4348 space may appear inside a file name, the effect will be that Vim
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4349 doesn't know where a file name starts or ends when doing completion.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4350 It most likely works better without a space in 'isfname'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4351
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4352 Note that on systems using a backslash as path separator, Vim tries to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4353 do its best to make it work as you would expect. That is a bit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4354 tricky, since Vi originally used the backslash to escape special
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4355 characters. Vim will not remove a backslash in front of a normal file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4356 name character on these systems, but it will on Unix and alikes. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4357 '&' and '^' are not included by default, because these are special for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4358 cmd.exe.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4359
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4360 The format of this option is a list of parts, separated with commas.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4361 Each part can be a single character number or a range. A range is two
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4362 character numbers with '-' in between. A character number can be a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4363 decimal number between 0 and 255 or the ASCII character itself (does
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4364 not work for digits). Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4365 "_,-,128-140,#-43" (include '_' and '-' and the range
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4366 128 to 140 and '#' to 43)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4367 If a part starts with '^', the following character number or range
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4368 will be excluded from the option. The option is interpreted from left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4369 to right. Put the excluded character after the range where it is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4370 included. To include '^' itself use it as the last character of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4371 option or the end of a range. Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4372 "^a-z,#,^" (exclude 'a' to 'z', include '#' and '^')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4373 If the character is '@', all characters where isalpha() returns TRUE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4374 are included. Normally these are the characters a to z and A to Z,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4375 plus accented characters. To include '@' itself use "@-@". Examples:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4376 "@,^a-z" All alphabetic characters, excluding lower
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
4377 case ASCII letters.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4378 "a-z,A-Z,@-@" All letters plus the '@' character.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4379 A comma can be included by using it where a character number is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4380 expected. Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4381 "48-57,,,_" Digits, comma and underscore.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4382 A comma can be excluded by prepending a '^'. Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4383 " -~,^,,9" All characters from space to '~', excluding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4384 comma, plus <Tab>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4385 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4386
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4387 *'isident'* *'isi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4388 'isident' 'isi' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4389 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4390 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4391 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4392 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4393 The characters given by this option are included in identifiers.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4394 Identifiers are used in recognizing environment variables and after a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4395 match of the 'define' option. It is also used for "\i" in a
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
4396 |pattern|. See 'isfname' for a description of the format of this
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4397 option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4398 Careful: If you change this option, it might break expanding
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4399 environment variables. E.g., when '/' is included and Vim tries to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4400 expand "$HOME/.viminfo". Maybe you should change 'iskeyword' instead.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4401
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4402 *'iskeyword'* *'isk'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4403 'iskeyword' 'isk' string (Vim default for MS-DOS and Win32:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4404 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4405 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4406 Vi default: "@,48-57,_")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4407 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4408 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4409 Keywords are used in searching and recognizing with many commands:
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4410 "w", "*", "[i", etc. It is also used for "\k" in a |pattern|. See
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4411 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. For C
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4412 programs you could use "a-z,A-Z,48-57,_,.,-,>".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4413 For a help file it is set to all non-blank printable characters except
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4414 '*', '"' and '|' (so that CTRL-] on a command finds the help for that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4415 command).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4416 When the 'lisp' option is on the '-' character is always included.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4417 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4418 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4419
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4420 *'isprint'* *'isp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4421 'isprint' 'isp' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32, OS/2 and Macintosh:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4422 "@,~-255"; otherwise: "@,161-255")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4423 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4424 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4425 The characters given by this option are displayed directly on the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4426 screen. It is also used for "\p" in a |pattern|. The characters from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4427 space (ASCII 32) to '~' (ASCII 126) are always displayed directly,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4428 even when they are not included in 'isprint' or excluded. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4429 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4430
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4431 Non-printable characters are displayed with two characters:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4432 0 - 31 "^@" - "^_"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4433 32 - 126 always single characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4434 127 "^?"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4435 128 - 159 "~@" - "~_"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4436 160 - 254 "| " - "|~"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4437 255 "~?"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4438 When 'encoding' is a Unicode one, illegal bytes from 128 to 255 are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4439 displayed as <xx>, with the hexadecimal value of the byte.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4440 When 'display' contains "uhex" all unprintable characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4441 displayed as <xx>.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4442 The SpecialKey highlighting will be used for unprintable characters.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4443 |hl-SpecialKey|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4444
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4445 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4446 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. When a character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4447 is printable but it is not available in the current font, a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4448 replacement character will be shown.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4449 Unprintable and zero-width Unicode characters are displayed as <xxxx>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4450 There is no option to specify these characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4451
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4452 *'joinspaces'* *'js'* *'nojoinspaces'* *'nojs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4453 'joinspaces' 'js' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4454 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4455 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4456 Insert two spaces after a '.', '?' and '!' with a join command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4457 When 'cpoptions' includes the 'j' flag, only do this after a '.'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4458 Otherwise only one space is inserted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4459 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4460
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4461 *'key'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4462 'key' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4463 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4464 {not in Vi}
2283
7e1bd501306d Mainly documentation updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2265
diff changeset
4465 {only available when compiled with the |+cryptv|
7e1bd501306d Mainly documentation updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2265
diff changeset
4466 feature}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4467 The key that is used for encrypting and decrypting the current buffer.
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2178
diff changeset
4468 See |encryption| and 'cryptmethod'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4469 Careful: Do not set the key value by hand, someone might see the typed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4470 key. Use the |:X| command. But you can make 'key' empty: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4471 :set key=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4472 < It is not possible to get the value of this option with ":set key" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4473 "echo &key". This is to avoid showing it to someone who shouldn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4474 know. It also means you cannot see it yourself once you have set it,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4475 be careful not to make a typing error!
2698
b6471224d2af Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2681
diff changeset
4476 You can use "&key" in an expression to detect whether encryption is
b6471224d2af Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2681
diff changeset
4477 enabled. When 'key' is set it returns "*****" (five stars).
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4478
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4479 *'keymap'* *'kmp'* *E544*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4480 'keymap' 'kmp' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4481 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4482 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4483 {only available when compiled with the |+keymap|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4484 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4485 Name of a keyboard mapping. See |mbyte-keymap|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4486 Setting this option to a valid keymap name has the side effect of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4487 setting 'iminsert' to one, so that the keymap becomes effective.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4488 'imsearch' is also set to one, unless it was -1
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
4489 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4490
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4491 *'keymodel'* *'km'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4492 'keymodel' 'km' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4493 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4494 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4495 List of comma separated words, which enable special things that keys
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4496 can do. These values can be used:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4497 startsel Using a shifted special key starts selection (either
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4498 Select mode or Visual mode, depending on "key" being
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4499 present in 'selectmode').
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4500 stopsel Using a not-shifted special key stops selection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4501 Special keys in this context are the cursor keys, <End>, <Home>,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4502 <PageUp> and <PageDown>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4503 The 'keymodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4504
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4505 *'keywordprg'* *'kp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4506 'keywordprg' 'kp' string (default "man" or "man -s", DOS: ":help",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4507 OS/2: "view /", VMS: "help")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4508 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4509 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4510 Program to use for the |K| command. Environment variables are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4511 expanded |:set_env|. ":help" may be used to access the Vim internal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4512 help. (Note that previously setting the global option to the empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4513 value did this, which is now deprecated.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4514 When "man" is used, Vim will automatically translate a count for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4515 "K" command to a section number. Also for "man -s", in which case the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4516 "-s" is removed when there is no count.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4517 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4518 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4519 :set keywordprg=man\ -s
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4520 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4521 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4522
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4523 *'langmap'* *'lmap'* *E357* *E358*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4524 'langmap' 'lmap' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4525 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4526 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4527 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4528 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4529 This option allows switching your keyboard into a special language
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4530 mode. When you are typing text in Insert mode the characters are
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4531 inserted directly. When in command mode the 'langmap' option takes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4532 care of translating these special characters to the original meaning
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4533 of the key. This means you don't have to change the keyboard mode to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4534 be able to execute Normal mode commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4535 This is the opposite of the 'keymap' option, where characters are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4536 mapped in Insert mode.
6369
c5d53d4c3e2e Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6339
diff changeset
4537 Also consider setting 'langnoremap' to avoid 'langmap' applies to
c5d53d4c3e2e Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6339
diff changeset
4538 characters resulting from a mapping.
5908
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
4539 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
4540 security reasons.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4541
699
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
4542 Example (for Greek, in UTF-8): *greek* >
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
4543 :set langmap=ΑA,ΒB,ΨC,ΔD,ΕE,ΦF,ΓG,ΗH,ΙI,ΞJ,ΚK,ΛL,ΜM,ΝN,ΟO,ΠP,QQ,ΡR,ΣS,ΤT,ΘU,ΩV,WW,ΧX,ΥY,ΖZ,αa,βb,ψc,δd,εe,φf,γg,ηh,ιi,ξj,κk,λl,μm,νn,οo,πp,qq,ρr,σs,τt,θu,ωv,ςw,χx,υy,ζz
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4544 < Example (exchanges meaning of z and y for commands): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4545 :set langmap=zy,yz,ZY,YZ
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4546 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4547 The 'langmap' option is a list of parts, separated with commas. Each
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4548 part can be in one of two forms:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4549 1. A list of pairs. Each pair is a "from" character immediately
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4550 followed by the "to" character. Examples: "aA", "aAbBcC".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4551 2. A list of "from" characters, a semi-colon and a list of "to"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4552 characters. Example: "abc;ABC"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4553 Example: "aA,fgh;FGH,cCdDeE"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4554 Special characters need to be preceded with a backslash. These are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4555 ";", ',' and backslash itself.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4556
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4557 This will allow you to activate vim actions without having to switch
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4558 back and forth between the languages. Your language characters will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4559 be understood as normal vim English characters (according to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4560 langmap mappings) in the following cases:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4561 o Normal/Visual mode (commands, buffer/register names, user mappings)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4562 o Insert/Replace Mode: Register names after CTRL-R
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4563 o Insert/Replace Mode: Mappings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4564 Characters entered in Command-line mode will NOT be affected by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4565 this option. Note that this option can be changed at any time
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4566 allowing to switch between mappings for different languages/encodings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4567 Use a mapping to avoid having to type it each time!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4568
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4569 *'langmenu'* *'lm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4570 'langmenu' 'lm' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4571 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4572 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4573 {only available when compiled with the |+menu| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4574 |+multi_lang| features}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4575 Language to use for menu translation. Tells which file is loaded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4576 from the "lang" directory in 'runtimepath': >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4577 "lang/menu_" . &langmenu . ".vim"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4578 < (without the spaces). For example, to always use the Dutch menus, no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4579 matter what $LANG is set to: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4580 :set langmenu=nl_NL.ISO_8859-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4581 < When 'langmenu' is empty, |v:lang| is used.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
4582 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4583 If your $LANG is set to a non-English language but you do want to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4584 the English menus: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4585 :set langmenu=none
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4586 < This option must be set before loading menus, switching on filetype
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4587 detection or syntax highlighting. Once the menus are defined setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4588 this option has no effect. But you could do this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4589 :source $VIMRUNTIME/delmenu.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4590 :set langmenu=de_DE.ISO_8859-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4591 :source $VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4592 < Warning: This deletes all menus that you defined yourself!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4593
6339
7b28dc1d756e updated for version 7.4.502
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6336
diff changeset
4594 *'langnoremap'* *'lnr'*
7b28dc1d756e updated for version 7.4.502
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6336
diff changeset
4595 'langnoremap' 'lnr' boolean (default off)
7b28dc1d756e updated for version 7.4.502
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6336
diff changeset
4596 global
7b28dc1d756e updated for version 7.4.502
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6336
diff changeset
4597 {not in Vi}
7b28dc1d756e updated for version 7.4.502
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6336
diff changeset
4598 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
7b28dc1d756e updated for version 7.4.502
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6336
diff changeset
4599 feature}
7b28dc1d756e updated for version 7.4.502
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6336
diff changeset
4600 When on, setting 'langmap' does not apply to characters resulting from
7b28dc1d756e updated for version 7.4.502
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6336
diff changeset
4601 a mapping. This basically means, if you noticed that setting
7b28dc1d756e updated for version 7.4.502
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6336
diff changeset
4602 'langmap' disables some of your mappings, try setting this option.
7b28dc1d756e updated for version 7.4.502
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6336
diff changeset
4603 This option defaults to off for backwards compatibility. Set it on if
7b28dc1d756e updated for version 7.4.502
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6336
diff changeset
4604 that works for you to avoid mappings to break.
7b28dc1d756e updated for version 7.4.502
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6336
diff changeset
4605
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4606 *'laststatus'* *'ls'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4607 'laststatus' 'ls' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4608 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4609 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4610 The value of this option influences when the last window will have a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4611 status line:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4612 0: never
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4613 1: only if there are at least two windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4614 2: always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4615 The screen looks nicer with a status line if you have several
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4616 windows, but it takes another screen line. |status-line|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4617
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4618 *'lazyredraw'* *'lz'* *'nolazyredraw'* *'nolz'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4619 'lazyredraw' 'lz' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4620 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4621 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4622 When this option is set, the screen will not be redrawn while
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4623 executing macros, registers and other commands that have not been
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4624 typed. Also, updating the window title is postponed. To force an
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4625 update use |:redraw|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4626
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4627 *'linebreak'* *'lbr'* *'nolinebreak'* *'nolbr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4628 'linebreak' 'lbr' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4629 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4630 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
4631 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4632 feature}
6009
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
4633 If on, Vim will wrap long lines at a character in 'breakat' rather
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4634 than at the last character that fits on the screen. Unlike
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4635 'wrapmargin' and 'textwidth', this does not insert <EOL>s in the file,
6009
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
4636 it only affects the way the file is displayed, not its contents.
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
4637 If 'breakindent' is set, line is visually indented. Then, the value
7b83c190d370 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5991
diff changeset
4638 of 'showbreak' is used to put in front of wrapped lines. This option
6026
d42a1d3b74d4 updated for version 7.4.353
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6009
diff changeset
4639 is not used when the 'wrap' option is off.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4640 Note that <Tab> characters after an <EOL> are mostly not displayed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4641 with the right amount of white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4642
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4643 *'lines'* *E593*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4644 'lines' number (default 24 or terminal height)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4645 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4646 Number of lines of the Vim window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4647 Normally you don't need to set this. It is done automatically by the
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 148
diff changeset
4648 terminal initialization code. Also see |posix-screen-size|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4649 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4650 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4651 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4652 Vim limits the number of lines to what fits on the screen. You can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4653 use this command to get the tallest window possible: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4654 :set lines=999
571
0ae54f30d5bc updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 557
diff changeset
4655 < Minimum value is 2, maximum value is 1000.
0ae54f30d5bc updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 557
diff changeset
4656 If you get less lines than expected, check the 'guiheadroom' option.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4657 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4658 number of lines of the display, the display may be messed up.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4659
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4660 *'linespace'* *'lsp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4661 'linespace' 'lsp' number (default 0, 1 for Win32 GUI)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4662 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4663 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4664 {only in the GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4665 Number of pixel lines inserted between characters. Useful if the font
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4666 uses the full character cell height, making lines touch each other.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4667 When non-zero there is room for underlining.
180
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4668 With some fonts there can be too much room between lines (to have
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4669 space for ascents and descents). Then it makes sense to set
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4670 'linespace' to a negative value. This may cause display problems
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
4671 though!
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4672
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4673 *'lisp'* *'nolisp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4674 'lisp' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4675 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4676 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4677 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4678 Lisp mode: When <Enter> is typed in insert mode set the indent for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4679 the next line to Lisp standards (well, sort of). Also happens with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4680 "cc" or "S". 'autoindent' must also be on for this to work. The 'p'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4681 flag in 'cpoptions' changes the method of indenting: Vi compatible or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4682 better. Also see 'lispwords'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4683 The '-' character is included in keyword characters. Redefines the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4684 "=" operator to use this same indentation algorithm rather than
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4685 calling an external program if 'equalprg' is empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4686 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4687 {Vi: Does it a little bit differently}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4688
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4689 *'lispwords'* *'lw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4690 'lispwords' 'lw' string (default is very long)
5712
06e5f65c34d8 updated for version 7.4.201
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5690
diff changeset
4691 global or local to buffer |global-local|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4692 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4693 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4694 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4695 Comma separated list of words that influence the Lisp indenting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4696 |'lisp'|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4697
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4698 *'list'* *'nolist'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4699 'list' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4700 local to window
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4701 List mode: Show tabs as CTRL-I is displayed, display $ after end of
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4702 line. Useful to see the difference between tabs and spaces and for
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4703 trailing blanks. Further changed by the 'listchars' option.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4704
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4705 The cursor is displayed at the start of the space a Tab character
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4706 occupies, not at the end as usual in Normal mode. To get this cursor
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4707 position while displaying Tabs with spaces, use: >
5161
f7add3891e95 Updated runtime files. Fix NL translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5146
diff changeset
4708 :set list lcs=tab:\ \
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4709 <
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4710 Note that list mode will also affect formatting (set with 'textwidth'
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4711 or 'wrapmargin') when 'cpoptions' includes 'L'. See 'listchars' for
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4712 changing the way tabs are displayed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4713
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4714 *'listchars'* *'lcs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4715 'listchars' 'lcs' string (default "eol:$")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4716 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4717 {not in Vi}
2458
22a6f99e6477 Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2426
diff changeset
4718 Strings to use in 'list' mode and for the |:list| command. It is a
22a6f99e6477 Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2426
diff changeset
4719 comma separated list of string settings.
6777
a8962f0e0d34 patch 7.4.710
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6727
diff changeset
4720 *lcs-eol*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4721 eol:c Character to show at the end of each line. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4722 omitted, there is no extra character at the end of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4723 line.
6777
a8962f0e0d34 patch 7.4.710
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6727
diff changeset
4724 *lcs-tab*
1263
57361514f73a updated for version 7.1
vimboss
parents: 1213
diff changeset
4725 tab:xy Two characters to be used to show a tab. The first
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4726 char is used once. The second char is repeated to
1263
57361514f73a updated for version 7.1
vimboss
parents: 1213
diff changeset
4727 fill the space that the tab normally occupies.
57361514f73a updated for version 7.1
vimboss
parents: 1213
diff changeset
4728 "tab:>-" will show a tab that takes four spaces as
57361514f73a updated for version 7.1
vimboss
parents: 1213
diff changeset
4729 ">---". When omitted, a tab is show as ^I.
6777
a8962f0e0d34 patch 7.4.710
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6727
diff changeset
4730 *lcs-space*
a8962f0e0d34 patch 7.4.710
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6727
diff changeset
4731 space:c Character to show for a space. When omitted, spaces
a8962f0e0d34 patch 7.4.710
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6727
diff changeset
4732 are left blank.
a8962f0e0d34 patch 7.4.710
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6727
diff changeset
4733 *lcs-trail*
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4734 trail:c Character to show for trailing spaces. When omitted,
6777
a8962f0e0d34 patch 7.4.710
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6727
diff changeset
4735 trailing spaces are blank. Overrides the "space"
a8962f0e0d34 patch 7.4.710
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6727
diff changeset
4736 setting for trailing spaces.
a8962f0e0d34 patch 7.4.710
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6727
diff changeset
4737 *lcs-extends*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4738 extends:c Character to show in the last column, when 'wrap' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4739 off and the line continues beyond the right of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4740 screen.
6777
a8962f0e0d34 patch 7.4.710
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6727
diff changeset
4741 *lcs-precedes*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4742 precedes:c Character to show in the first column, when 'wrap'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4743 is off and there is text preceding the character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4744 visible in the first column.
6777
a8962f0e0d34 patch 7.4.710
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6727
diff changeset
4745 *lcs-conceal*
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2249
diff changeset
4746 conceal:c Character to show in place of concealed text, when
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
4747 'conceallevel' is set to 1.
6777
a8962f0e0d34 patch 7.4.710
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6727
diff changeset
4748 *lcs-nbsp*
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
4749 nbsp:c Character to show for a non-breakable space (character
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
4750 0xA0, 160). Left blank when omitted.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4751
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
4752 The characters ':' and ',' should not be used. UTF-8 characters can
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4753 be used when 'encoding' is "utf-8", otherwise only printable
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
4754 characters are allowed. All characters must be single width.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4755
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4756 Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4757 :set lcs=tab:>-,trail:-
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
4758 :set lcs=tab:>-,eol:<,nbsp:%
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4759 :set lcs=extends:>,precedes:<
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4760 < The "NonText" highlighting will be used for "eol", "extends" and
6777
a8962f0e0d34 patch 7.4.710
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6727
diff changeset
4761 "precedes". "SpecialKey" for "nbsp", "space", "tab" and "trail".
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4762 |hl-NonText| |hl-SpecialKey|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4763
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4764 *'lpl'* *'nolpl'* *'loadplugins'* *'noloadplugins'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4765 'loadplugins' 'lpl' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4766 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4767 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4768 When on the plugin scripts are loaded when starting up |load-plugins|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4769 This option can be reset in your |vimrc| file to disable the loading
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4770 of plugins.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4771 Note that using the "-u NONE" and "--noplugin" command line arguments
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4772 reset this option. |-u| |--noplugin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4773
842
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4774 *'macatsui'* *'nomacatsui'*
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4775 'macatsui' boolean (default on)
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4776 global
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4777 {only available in Mac GUI version}
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4778 This is a workaround for when drawing doesn't work properly. When set
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4779 and compiled with multi-byte support ATSUI text drawing is used. When
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4780 not set ATSUI text drawing is not used. Switch this option off when
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4781 you experience drawing problems. In a future version the problems may
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4782 be solved and this option becomes obsolete. Therefore use this method
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4783 to unset it: >
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4784 if exists('&macatsui')
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4785 set nomacatsui
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 839
diff changeset
4786 endif
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4787 < Another option to check if you have drawing problems is
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4788 'termencoding'.
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4789
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4790 *'magic'* *'nomagic'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4791 'magic' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4792 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4793 Changes the special characters that can be used in search patterns.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4794 See |pattern|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4795 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with using patterns, always keep
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4796 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4797 old Vi scripts. In any other situation write patterns that work when
20
4ac1dce8dd5e updated for version 7.0012
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
4798 'magic' is on. Include "\M" when you want to |/\M|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4799
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4800 *'makeef'* *'mef'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4801 'makeef' 'mef' string (default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4802 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4803 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4804 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4805 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4806 Name of the errorfile for the |:make| command (see |:make_makeprg|)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4807 and the |:grep| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4808 When it is empty, an internally generated temp file will be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4809 When "##" is included, it is replaced by a number to make the name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4810 unique. This makes sure that the ":make" command doesn't overwrite an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4811 existing file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4812 NOT used for the ":cf" command. See 'errorfile' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4813 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4814 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4815 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4816 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4817
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4818 *'makeprg'* *'mp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4819 'makeprg' 'mp' string (default "make", VMS: "MMS")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4820 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4821 {not in Vi}
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4822 Program to use for the ":make" command. See |:make_makeprg|.
5690
40f18a1c1592 updated for version 7.4.191
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5555
diff changeset
4823 This option may contain '%' and '#' characters (see |:_%| and |:_#|),
40f18a1c1592 updated for version 7.4.191
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5555
diff changeset
4824 which are expanded to the current and alternate file name. Use |::S|
40f18a1c1592 updated for version 7.4.191
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5555
diff changeset
4825 to escape file names in case they contain special characters.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4826 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4827 about including spaces and backslashes.
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4828 Note that a '|' must be escaped twice: once for ":set" and once for
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4829 the interpretation of a command. When you use a filter called
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4830 "myfilter" do it like this: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4831 :set makeprg=gmake\ \\\|\ myfilter
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4832 < The placeholder "$*" can be given (even multiple times) to specify
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4833 where the arguments will be included, for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4834 :set makeprg=latex\ \\\\nonstopmode\ \\\\input\\{$*}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4835 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4836 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4837
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4838 *'matchpairs'* *'mps'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4839 'matchpairs' 'mps' string (default "(:),{:},[:]")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4840 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4841 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4842 Characters that form pairs. The |%| command jumps from one to the
4073
e362db8b2d7b Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4055
diff changeset
4843 other.
e362db8b2d7b Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4055
diff changeset
4844 Only character pairs are allowed that are different, thus you cannot
e362db8b2d7b Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4055
diff changeset
4845 jump between two double quotes.
e362db8b2d7b Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4055
diff changeset
4846 The characters must be separated by a colon.
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4847 The pairs must be separated by a comma. Example for including '<' and
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4848 '>' (HTML): >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4849 :set mps+=<:>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4850
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4851 < A more exotic example, to jump between the '=' and ';' in an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4852 assignment, useful for languages like C and Java: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4853 :au FileType c,cpp,java set mps+==:;
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4854
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4855 < For a more advanced way of using "%", see the matchit.vim plugin in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4856 the $VIMRUNTIME/macros directory. |add-local-help|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4857
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4858 *'matchtime'* *'mat'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4859 'matchtime' 'mat' number (default 5)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4860 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4861 {not in Vi}{in Nvi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4862 Tenths of a second to show the matching paren, when 'showmatch' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4863 set. Note that this is not in milliseconds, like other options that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4864 set a time. This is to be compatible with Nvi.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4865
714
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4866 *'maxcombine'* *'mco'*
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4867 'maxcombine' 'mco' number (default 2)
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4868 global
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4869 {not in Vi}
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4870 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4871 feature}
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4872 The maximum number of combining characters supported for displaying.
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4873 Only used when 'encoding' is "utf-8".
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4874 The default is OK for most languages. Hebrew may require 4.
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4875 Maximum value is 6.
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4876 Even when this option is set to 2 you can still edit text with more
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4877 combining characters, you just can't see them. Use |g8| or |ga|.
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4878 See |mbyte-combining|.
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
4879
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4880 *'maxfuncdepth'* *'mfd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4881 'maxfuncdepth' 'mfd' number (default 100)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4882 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4883 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
4884 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4885 feature}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4886 Maximum depth of function calls for user functions. This normally
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4887 catches endless recursion. When using a recursive function with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4888 more depth, set 'maxfuncdepth' to a bigger number. But this will use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4889 more memory, there is the danger of failing when memory is exhausted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4890 See also |:function|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4891
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4892 *'maxmapdepth'* *'mmd'* *E223*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4893 'maxmapdepth' 'mmd' number (default 1000)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4894 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4895 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4896 Maximum number of times a mapping is done without resulting in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4897 character to be used. This normally catches endless mappings, like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4898 ":map x y" with ":map y x". It still does not catch ":map g wg",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4899 because the 'w' is used before the next mapping is done. See also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4900 |key-mapping|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4901
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4902 *'maxmem'* *'mm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4903 'maxmem' 'mm' number (default between 256 to 5120 (system
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4904 dependent) or half the amount of memory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4905 available)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4906 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4907 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4908 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for one buffer. When this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4909 limit is reached allocating extra memory for a buffer will cause
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4910 other memory to be freed. The maximum usable value is about 2000000.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4911 Use this to work without a limit. Also see 'maxmemtot'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4912
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4913 *'maxmempattern'* *'mmp'*
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4914 'maxmempattern' 'mmp' number (default 1000)
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4915 global
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4916 {not in Vi}
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4917 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for pattern matching.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4918 The maximum value is about 2000000. Use this to work without a limit.
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4919 *E363*
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4920 When Vim runs into the limit it gives an error message and mostly
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
4921 behaves like CTRL-C was typed.
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4922 Running into the limit often means that the pattern is very
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4923 inefficient or too complex. This may already happen with the pattern
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4924 "\(.\)*" on a very long line. ".*" works much better.
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4925 Vim may run out of memory before hitting the 'maxmempattern' limit.
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
4926
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4927 *'maxmemtot'* *'mmt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4928 'maxmemtot' 'mmt' number (default between 2048 and 10240 (system
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4929 dependent) or half the amount of memory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4930 available)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4931 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4932 {not in Vi}
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4933 Maximum amount of memory in Kbyte to use for all buffers together.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4934 The maximum usable value is about 2000000 (2 Gbyte). Use this to work
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4935 without a limit. On 64 bit machines higher values might work. But
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4936 hey, do you really need more than 2 Gbyte for text editing?
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
4937 Also see 'maxmem'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4938
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4939 *'menuitems'* *'mis'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4940 'menuitems' 'mis' number (default 25)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4941 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4942 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4943 {not available when compiled without the |+menu|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4944 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4945 Maximum number of items to use in a menu. Used for menus that are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4946 generated from a list of items, e.g., the Buffers menu. Changing this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4947 option has no direct effect, the menu must be refreshed first.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4948
484
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4949 *'mkspellmem'* *'msm'*
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4950 'mkspellmem' 'msm' string (default "460000,2000,500")
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4951 global
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4952 {not in Vi}
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4953 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4954 feature}
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4955 Parameters for |:mkspell|. This tunes when to start compressing the
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4956 word tree. Compression can be slow when there are many words, but
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4957 it's needed to avoid running out of memory. The amount of memory used
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4958 per word depends very much on how similar the words are, that's why
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4959 this tuning is complicated.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4960
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4961 There are three numbers, separated by commas:
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4962 {start},{inc},{added}
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4963
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4964 For most languages the uncompressed word tree fits in memory. {start}
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4965 gives the amount of memory in Kbyte that can be used before any
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4966 compression is done. It should be a bit smaller than the amount of
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4967 memory that is available to Vim.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4968
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4969 When going over the {start} limit the {inc} number specifies the
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4970 amount of memory in Kbyte that can be allocated before another
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4971 compression is done. A low number means compression is done after
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4972 less words are added, which is slow. A high number means more memory
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4973 will be allocated.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4974
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4975 After doing compression, {added} times 1024 words can be added before
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4976 the {inc} limit is ignored and compression is done when any extra
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4977 amount of memory is needed. A low number means there is a smaller
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4978 chance of hitting the {inc} limit, less memory is used but it's
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4979 slower.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4980
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4981 The languages for which these numbers are important are Italian and
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4982 Hungarian. The default works for when you have about 512 Mbyte. If
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4983 you have 1 Gbyte you could use: >
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4984 :set mkspellmem=900000,3000,800
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4985 < If you have less than 512 Mbyte |:mkspell| may fail for some
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4986 languages, no matter what you set 'mkspellmem' to.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
4987
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4988 *'modeline'* *'ml'* *'nomodeline'* *'noml'*
1111
53fd0a213cff updated for version 7.0-237
vimboss
parents: 1004
diff changeset
4989 'modeline' 'ml' boolean (Vim default: on (off for root),
53fd0a213cff updated for version 7.0-237
vimboss
parents: 1004
diff changeset
4990 Vi default: off)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4991 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4992 *'modelines'* *'mls'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4993 'modelines' 'mls' number (default 5)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4994 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4995 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4996 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4997 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4998 no lines are checked. See |modeline|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4999 NOTE: 'modeline' is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5000 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5001
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5002 *'modifiable'* *'ma'* *'nomodifiable'* *'noma'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5003 'modifiable' 'ma' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5004 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5005 {not in Vi} *E21*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5006 When off the buffer contents cannot be changed. The 'fileformat' and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5007 'fileencoding' options also can't be changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5008 Can be reset with the |-M| command line argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5009
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5010 *'modified'* *'mod'* *'nomodified'* *'nomod'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5011 'modified' 'mod' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5012 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5013 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5014 When on, the buffer is considered to be modified. This option is set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5015 when:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5016 1. A change was made to the text since it was last written. Using the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5017 |undo| command to go back to the original text will reset the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5018 option. But undoing changes that were made before writing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5019 buffer will set the option again, since the text is different from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5020 when it was written.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5021 2. 'fileformat' or 'fileencoding' is different from its original
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5022 value. The original value is set when the buffer is read or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5023 written. A ":set nomodified" command also resets the original
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5024 values to the current values and the 'modified' option will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5025 reset.
3082
3502a7f991fc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
5026 This option is not set when a change is made to the buffer as the
3502a7f991fc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
5027 result of a BufNewFile, BufRead/BufReadPost, BufWritePost,
3502a7f991fc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
5028 FileAppendPost or VimLeave autocommand event. See |gzip-example| for
3502a7f991fc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
5029 an explanation.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5030 When 'buftype' is "nowrite" or "nofile" this option may be set, but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5031 will be ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5032
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5033 *'more'* *'nomore'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5034 'more' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5035 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5036 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5037 When on, listings pause when the whole screen is filled. You will get
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5038 the |more-prompt|. When this option is off there are no pauses, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5039 listing continues until finished.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5040 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5041 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5042
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5043 *'mouse'* *E538*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5044 'mouse' string (default "", "a" for GUI, MS-DOS and Win32)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5045 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5046 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5047 Enable the use of the mouse. Only works for certain terminals
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
5048 (xterm, MS-DOS, Win32 |win32-mouse|, QNX pterm, *BSD console with
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
5049 sysmouse and Linux console with gpm). For using the mouse in the
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
5050 GUI, see |gui-mouse|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5051 The mouse can be enabled for different modes:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5052 n Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5053 v Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5054 i Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5055 c Command-line mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5056 h all previous modes when editing a help file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5057 a all previous modes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5058 r for |hit-enter| and |more-prompt| prompt
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5059 Normally you would enable the mouse in all four modes with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5060 :set mouse=a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5061 < When the mouse is not enabled, the GUI will still use the mouse for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5062 modeless selection. This doesn't move the text cursor.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5063
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5064 See |mouse-using|. Also see |'clipboard'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5065
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5066 Note: When enabling the mouse in a terminal, copy/paste will use the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5067 "* register if there is access to an X-server. The xterm handling of
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5068 the mouse buttons can still be used by keeping the shift key pressed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5069 Also see the 'clipboard' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5070
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5071 *'mousefocus'* *'mousef'* *'nomousefocus'* *'nomousef'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5072 'mousefocus' 'mousef' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5073 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5074 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5075 {only works in the GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5076 The window that the mouse pointer is on is automatically activated.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5077 When changing the window layout or window focus in another way, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5078 mouse pointer is moved to the window with keyboard focus. Off is the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5079 default because it makes using the pull down menus a little goofy, as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5080 a pointer transit may activate a window unintentionally.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5081
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5082 *'mousehide'* *'mh'* *'nomousehide'* *'nomh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5083 'mousehide' 'mh' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5084 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5085 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5086 {only works in the GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5087 When on, the mouse pointer is hidden when characters are typed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5088 The mouse pointer is restored when the mouse is moved.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5089
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5090 *'mousemodel'* *'mousem'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5091 'mousemodel' 'mousem' string (default "extend", "popup" for MS-DOS and Win32)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5092 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5093 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5094 Sets the model to use for the mouse. The name mostly specifies what
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5095 the right mouse button is used for:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5096 extend Right mouse button extends a selection. This works
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5097 like in an xterm.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5098 popup Right mouse button pops up a menu. The shifted left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5099 mouse button extends a selection. This works like
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
5100 with Microsoft Windows.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5101 popup_setpos Like "popup", but the cursor will be moved to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5102 position where the mouse was clicked, and thus the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5103 selected operation will act upon the clicked object.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5104 If clicking inside a selection, that selection will
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
5105 be acted upon, i.e. no cursor move. This implies of
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5106 course, that right clicking outside a selection will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5107 end Visual mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5108 Overview of what button does what for each model:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5109 mouse extend popup(_setpos) ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5110 left click place cursor place cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5111 left drag start selection start selection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5112 shift-left search word extend selection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5113 right click extend selection popup menu (place cursor)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5114 right drag extend selection -
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5115 middle click paste paste
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5116
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5117 In the "popup" model the right mouse button produces a pop-up menu.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5118 You need to define this first, see |popup-menu|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5119
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5120 Note that you can further refine the meaning of buttons with mappings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5121 See |gui-mouse-mapping|. But mappings are NOT used for modeless
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5122 selection (because that's handled in the GUI code directly).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5123
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5124 The 'mousemodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5125
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5126 *'mouseshape'* *'mouses'* *E547*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5127 'mouseshape' 'mouses' string (default "i:beam,r:beam,s:updown,sd:cross,
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
5128 m:no,ml:up-arrow,v:rightup-arrow")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5129 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5130 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5131 {only available when compiled with the |+mouseshape|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5132 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5133 This option tells Vim what the mouse pointer should look like in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5134 different modes. The option is a comma separated list of parts, much
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5135 like used for 'guicursor'. Each part consist of a mode/location-list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5136 and an argument-list:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5137 mode-list:shape,mode-list:shape,..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5138 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes/locations:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5139 In a normal window: ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5140 n Normal mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5141 v Visual mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5142 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5143 if not specified)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5144 o Operator-pending mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5145 i Insert mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5146 r Replace mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5147
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5148 Others: ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5149 c appending to the command-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5150 ci inserting in the command-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5151 cr replacing in the command-line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5152 m at the 'Hit ENTER' or 'More' prompts
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5153 ml idem, but cursor in the last line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5154 e any mode, pointer below last window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5155 s any mode, pointer on a status line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5156 sd any mode, while dragging a status line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5157 vs any mode, pointer on a vertical separator line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5158 vd any mode, while dragging a vertical separator line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5159 a everywhere
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5160
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5161 The shape is one of the following:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5162 avail name looks like ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5163 w x arrow Normal mouse pointer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5164 w x blank no pointer at all (use with care!)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5165 w x beam I-beam
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5166 w x updown up-down sizing arrows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5167 w x leftright left-right sizing arrows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5168 w x busy The system's usual busy pointer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5169 w x no The system's usual 'no input' pointer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5170 x udsizing indicates up-down resizing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5171 x lrsizing indicates left-right resizing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5172 x crosshair like a big thin +
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5173 x hand1 black hand
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5174 x hand2 white hand
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5175 x pencil what you write with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5176 x question big ?
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5177 x rightup-arrow arrow pointing right-up
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5178 w x up-arrow arrow pointing up
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5179 x <number> any X11 pointer number (see X11/cursorfont.h)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5180
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5181 The "avail" column contains a 'w' if the shape is available for Win32,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5182 x for X11.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5183 Any modes not specified or shapes not available use the normal mouse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5184 pointer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5185
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5186 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5187 :set mouseshape=s:udsizing,m:no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5188 < will make the mouse turn to a sizing arrow over the status lines and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5189 indicate no input when the hit-enter prompt is displayed (since
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5190 clicking the mouse has no effect in this state.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5191
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5192 *'mousetime'* *'mouset'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5193 'mousetime' 'mouset' number (default 500)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5194 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5195 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5196 Only for GUI, MS-DOS, Win32 and Unix with xterm. Defines the maximum
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5197 time in msec between two mouse clicks for the second click to be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5198 recognized as a multi click.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5199
14
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5200 *'mzquantum'* *'mzq'*
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5201 'mzquantum' 'mzq' number (default 100)
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5202 global
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5203 {not in Vi}
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5204 {not available when compiled without the |+mzscheme|
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5205 feature}
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5206 The number of milliseconds between polls for MzScheme threads.
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5207 Negative or zero value means no thread scheduling.
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5208
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5209 *'nrformats'* *'nf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5210 'nrformats' 'nf' string (default "octal,hex")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5211 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5212 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5213 This defines what bases Vim will consider for numbers when using the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5214 CTRL-A and CTRL-X commands for adding to and subtracting from a number
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5215 respectively; see |CTRL-A| for more info on these commands.
625
81fe2ccc1207 updated for version 7.0179
vimboss
parents: 623
diff changeset
5216 alpha If included, single alphabetical characters will be
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5217 incremented or decremented. This is useful for a list with a
3237
91e53bcb7946 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3224
diff changeset
5218 letter index a), b), etc. *octal-nrformats*
625
81fe2ccc1207 updated for version 7.0179
vimboss
parents: 623
diff changeset
5219 octal If included, numbers that start with a zero will be considered
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5220 to be octal. Example: Using CTRL-A on "007" results in "010".
625
81fe2ccc1207 updated for version 7.0179
vimboss
parents: 623
diff changeset
5221 hex If included, numbers starting with "0x" or "0X" will be
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5222 considered to be hexadecimal. Example: Using CTRL-X on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5223 "0x100" results in "0x0ff".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5224 Numbers which simply begin with a digit in the range 1-9 are always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5225 considered decimal. This also happens for numbers that are not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5226 recognized as octal or hex.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5227
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5228 *'number'* *'nu'* *'nonumber'* *'nonu'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5229 'number' 'nu' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5230 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5231 Print the line number in front of each line. When the 'n' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5232 excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped line will not use the column of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5233 line numbers (this is the default when 'compatible' isn't set).
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5234 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5235 number.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5236 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5237 characters are put before the number.
3445
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
5238 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
5239 the number.
4780
2b11ac90d9e9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4681
diff changeset
5240 *number_relativenumber*
2b11ac90d9e9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4681
diff changeset
5241 The 'relativenumber' option changes the displayed number to be
2b11ac90d9e9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4681
diff changeset
5242 relative to the cursor. Together with 'number' there are these
2b11ac90d9e9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4681
diff changeset
5243 four combinations (cursor in line 3):
2b11ac90d9e9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4681
diff changeset
5244
2b11ac90d9e9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4681
diff changeset
5245 'nonu' 'nu' 'nonu' 'nu'
2b11ac90d9e9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4681
diff changeset
5246 'nornu' 'nornu' 'rnu' 'rnu'
2b11ac90d9e9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4681
diff changeset
5247
2b11ac90d9e9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4681
diff changeset
5248 |apple | 1 apple | 2 apple | 2 apple
2b11ac90d9e9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4681
diff changeset
5249 |pear | 2 pear | 1 pear | 1 pear
2b11ac90d9e9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4681
diff changeset
5250 |nobody | 3 nobody | 0 nobody |3 nobody
2b11ac90d9e9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4681
diff changeset
5251 |there | 4 there | 1 there | 1 there
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5252
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5253 *'numberwidth'* *'nuw'*
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5254 'numberwidth' 'nuw' number (Vim default: 4 Vi default: 8)
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5255 local to window
14
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5256 {not in Vi}
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5257 {only available when compiled with the |+linebreak|
946da5994c01 updated for version 7.0006
vimboss
parents: 13
diff changeset
5258 feature}
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5259 Minimal number of columns to use for the line number. Only relevant
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5260 when the 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set or printing lines
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5261 with a line number. Since one space is always between the number and
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5262 the text, there is one less character for the number itself.
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5263 The value is the minimum width. A bigger width is used when needed to
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5264 fit the highest line number in the buffer respectively the number of
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5265 rows in the window, depending on whether 'number' or 'relativenumber'
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5266 is set. Thus with the Vim default of 4 there is room for a line number
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5267 up to 999. When the buffer has 1000 lines five columns will be used.
13
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5268 The minimum value is 1, the maximum value is 10.
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5269 NOTE: 'numberwidth' is reset to 8 when 'compatible' is set.
24d5189d3956 updated for version 7.0005
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
5270
523
a7ae7e043e43 updated for version 7.0146
vimboss
parents: 519
diff changeset
5271 *'omnifunc'* *'ofu'*
a7ae7e043e43 updated for version 7.0146
vimboss
parents: 519
diff changeset
5272 'omnifunc' 'ofu' string (default: empty)
502
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
5273 local to buffer
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
5274 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
5275 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
5276 or |+insert_expand| features}
623
bd2fe62c9d77 updated for version 7.0178
vimboss
parents: 596
diff changeset
5277 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode omni
bd2fe62c9d77 updated for version 7.0178
vimboss
parents: 596
diff changeset
5278 completion with CTRL-X CTRL-O. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-O|
648
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
5279 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
5280 invoked and what it should return.
1004
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5281 This option is usually set by a filetype plugin:
859
99305c4c42d4 updated for version 7.0g02
vimboss
parents: 857
diff changeset
5282 |:filetype-plugin-on|
3682
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
5283 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
5284 security reasons.
502
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
5285
52e76e2b5b65 updated for version 7.0140
vimboss
parents: 500
diff changeset
5286
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
5287 *'opendevice'* *'odev'* *'noopendevice'* *'noodev'*
1004
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5288 'opendevice' 'odev' boolean (default off)
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5289 global
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5290 {not in Vi}
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5291 {only for MS-DOS, MS-Windows and OS/2}
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5292 Enable reading and writing from devices. This may get Vim stuck on a
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5293 device that can be opened but doesn't actually do the I/O. Therefore
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5294 it is off by default.
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5295 Note that on MS-Windows editing "aux.h", "lpt1.txt" and the like also
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5296 result in editing a device.
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5297
09d0e83c29b8 updated for version 7.0-130
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5298
593
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5299 *'operatorfunc'* *'opfunc'*
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5300 'operatorfunc' 'opfunc' string (default: empty)
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5301 global
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5302 {not in Vi}
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5303 This option specifies a function to be called by the |g@| operator.
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5304 See |:map-operator| for more info and an example.
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5305
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5306 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5307 security reasons.
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5308
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
5309
2908
fd09a9c8468e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2873
diff changeset
5310 *'osfiletype'* *'oft'*
fd09a9c8468e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2873
diff changeset
5311 'osfiletype' 'oft' string (default: "")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5312 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5313 {not in Vi}
2908
fd09a9c8468e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2873
diff changeset
5314 This option was supported on RISC OS, which has been removed.
fd09a9c8468e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2873
diff changeset
5315
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5316
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5317 *'paragraphs'* *'para'*
1564
8c9396275bfa updated for version 7.1-277
vimboss
parents: 1521
diff changeset
5318 'paragraphs' 'para' string (default "IPLPPPQPP TPHPLIPpLpItpplpipbp")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5319 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5320 Specifies the nroff macros that separate paragraphs. These are pairs
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5321 of two letters (see |object-motions|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5322
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5323 *'paste'* *'nopaste'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5324 'paste' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5325 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5326 {not in Vi}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5327 Put Vim in Paste mode. This is useful if you want to cut or copy
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5328 some text from one window and paste it in Vim. This will avoid
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5329 unexpected effects.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5330 Setting this option is useful when using Vim in a terminal, where Vim
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5331 cannot distinguish between typed text and pasted text. In the GUI, Vim
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5332 knows about pasting and will mostly do the right thing without 'paste'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5333 being set. The same is true for a terminal where Vim handles the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5334 mouse clicks itself.
148
72aefd4c1e0d updated for version 7.0046
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
5335 This option is reset when starting the GUI. Thus if you set it in
72aefd4c1e0d updated for version 7.0046
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
5336 your .vimrc it will work in a terminal, but not in the GUI. Setting
72aefd4c1e0d updated for version 7.0046
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
5337 'paste' in the GUI has side effects: e.g., the Paste toolbar button
72aefd4c1e0d updated for version 7.0046
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
5338 will no longer work in Insert mode, because it uses a mapping.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5339 When the 'paste' option is switched on (also when it was already on):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5340 - mapping in Insert mode and Command-line mode is disabled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5341 - abbreviations are disabled
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5342 - 'textwidth' is set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5343 - 'wrapmargin' is set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5344 - 'autoindent' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5345 - 'smartindent' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5346 - 'softtabstop' is set to 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5347 - 'revins' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5348 - 'ruler' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5349 - 'showmatch' is reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5350 - 'formatoptions' is used like it is empty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5351 These options keep their value, but their effect is disabled:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5352 - 'lisp'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5353 - 'indentexpr'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5354 - 'cindent'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5355 NOTE: When you start editing another file while the 'paste' option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5356 on, settings from the modelines or autocommands may change the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5357 settings again, causing trouble when pasting text. You might want to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5358 set the 'paste' option again.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5359 When the 'paste' option is reset the mentioned options are restored to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5360 the value before the moment 'paste' was switched from off to on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5361 Resetting 'paste' before ever setting it does not have any effect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5362 Since mapping doesn't work while 'paste' is active, you need to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5363 the 'pastetoggle' option to toggle the 'paste' option with some key.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5364
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5365 *'pastetoggle'* *'pt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5366 'pastetoggle' 'pt' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5367 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5368 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5369 When non-empty, specifies the key sequence that toggles the 'paste'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5370 option. This is like specifying a mapping: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5371 :map {keys} :set invpaste<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5372 < Where {keys} is the value of 'pastetoggle'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5373 The difference is that it will work even when 'paste' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5374 'pastetoggle' works in Insert mode and Normal mode, but not in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5375 Command-line mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5376 Mappings are checked first, thus overrule 'pastetoggle'. However,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5377 when 'paste' is on mappings are ignored in Insert mode, thus you can do
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5378 this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5379 :map <F10> :set paste<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5380 :map <F11> :set nopaste<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5381 :imap <F10> <C-O>:set paste<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5382 :imap <F11> <nop>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5383 :set pastetoggle=<F11>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5384 < This will make <F10> start paste mode and <F11> stop paste mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5385 Note that typing <F10> in paste mode inserts "<F10>", since in paste
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5386 mode everything is inserted literally, except the 'pastetoggle' key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5387 sequence.
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
5388 When the value has several bytes 'ttimeoutlen' applies.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5389
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5390 *'pex'* *'patchexpr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5391 'patchexpr' 'pex' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5392 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5393 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5394 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5395 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5396 Expression which is evaluated to apply a patch to a file and generate
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5397 the resulting new version of the file. See |diff-patchexpr|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5398
6091
7090d7f160f7 Update runtime files. Add vroom file support.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6032
diff changeset
5399 *'patchmode'* *'pm'* *E205* *E206*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5400 'patchmode' 'pm' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5401 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5402 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5403 When non-empty the oldest version of a file is kept. This can be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5404 to keep the original version of a file if you are changing files in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5405 source distribution. Only the first time that a file is written a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5406 copy of the original file will be kept. The name of the copy is the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5407 name of the original file with the string in the 'patchmode' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5408 appended. This option should start with a dot. Use a string like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5409 ".org". 'backupdir' must not be empty for this to work (Detail: The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5410 backup file is renamed to the patchmode file after the new file has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5411 been successfully written, that's why it must be possible to write a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5412 backup file). If there was no file to be backed up, an empty file is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5413 created.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5414 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a patchmode file is not made.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5415 Using 'patchmode' for compressed files appends the extension at the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5416 end (e.g., "file.gz.orig"), thus the resulting name isn't always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5417 recognized as a compressed file.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
5418 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5419
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
5420 *'path'* *'pa'* *E343* *E345* *E347* *E854*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5421 'path' 'pa' string (default on Unix: ".,/usr/include,,"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5422 on OS/2: ".,/emx/include,,"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5423 other systems: ".,,")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5424 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5425 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5426 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
1668
0b796e045c42 updated for version 7.2b-000
vimboss
parents: 1621
diff changeset
5427 |gf|, [f, ]f, ^Wf, |:find|, |:sfind|, |:tabfind| and other commands,
0b796e045c42 updated for version 7.2b-000
vimboss
parents: 1621
diff changeset
5428 provided that the file being searched for has a relative path (not
0b796e045c42 updated for version 7.2b-000
vimboss
parents: 1621
diff changeset
5429 starting with "/", "./" or "../"). The directories in the 'path'
0b796e045c42 updated for version 7.2b-000
vimboss
parents: 1621
diff changeset
5430 option may be relative or absolute.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5431 - Use commas to separate directory names: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5432 :set path=.,/usr/local/include,/usr/include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5433 < - Spaces can also be used to separate directory names (for backwards
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5434 compatibility with version 3.0). To have a space in a directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5435 name, precede it with an extra backslash, and escape the space: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5436 :set path=.,/dir/with\\\ space
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5437 < - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with an extra
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5438 backslash: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5439 :set path=.,/dir/with\\,comma
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5440 < - To search relative to the directory of the current file, use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5441 :set path=.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5442 < - To search in the current directory use an empty string between two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5443 commas: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5444 :set path=,,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5445 < - A directory name may end in a ':' or '/'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5446 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5447 - When using |netrw.vim| URLs can be used. For example, adding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5448 "http://www.vim.org" will make ":find index.html" work.
1668
0b796e045c42 updated for version 7.2b-000
vimboss
parents: 1621
diff changeset
5449 - Search upwards and downwards in a directory tree using "*", "**" and
0b796e045c42 updated for version 7.2b-000
vimboss
parents: 1621
diff changeset
5450 ";". See |file-searching| for info and syntax.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5451 {not available when compiled without the |+path_extra| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5452 - Careful with '\' characters, type two to get one in the option: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5453 :set path=.,c:\\include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5454 < Or just use '/' instead: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5455 :set path=.,c:/include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5456 < Don't forget "." or files won't even be found in the same directory as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5457 the file!
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5458 The maximum length is limited. How much depends on the system, mostly
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5459 it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5460 You can check if all the include files are found, using the value of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5461 'path', see |:checkpath|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5462 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5463 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5464 uses another default. To remove the current directory use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5465 :set path-=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5466 < To add the current directory use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5467 :set path+=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5468 < To use an environment variable, you probably need to replace the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5469 separator. Here is an example to append $INCL, in which directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5470 names are separated with a semi-colon: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5471 :let &path = &path . "," . substitute($INCL, ';', ',', 'g')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5472 < Replace the ';' with a ':' or whatever separator is used. Note that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5473 this doesn't work when $INCL contains a comma or white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5474
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5475 *'preserveindent'* *'pi'* *'nopreserveindent'* *'nopi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5476 'preserveindent' 'pi' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5477 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5478 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5479 When changing the indent of the current line, preserve as much of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5480 indent structure as possible. Normally the indent is replaced by a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5481 series of tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5482 enabled, in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5483 means the indent will preserve as many existing characters as possible
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5484 for indenting, and only add additional tabs or spaces as required.
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
5485 'expandtab' does not apply to the preserved white space, a Tab remains
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
5486 a Tab.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5487 NOTE: When using ">>" multiple times the resulting indent is a mix of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5488 tabs and spaces. You might not like this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5489 NOTE: 'preserveindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5490 Also see 'copyindent'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5491 Use |:retab| to clean up white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5492
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5493 *'previewheight'* *'pvh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5494 'previewheight' 'pvh' number (default 12)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5495 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5496 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5497 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
5498 |+quickfix| features}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5499 Default height for a preview window. Used for |:ptag| and associated
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5500 commands. Used for |CTRL-W_}| when no count is given.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5501
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5502 *'previewwindow'* *'nopreviewwindow'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5503 *'pvw'* *'nopvw'* *E590*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5504 'previewwindow' 'pvw' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5505 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5506 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5507 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
5508 |+quickfix| features}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5509 Identifies the preview window. Only one window can have this option
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5510 set. It's normally not set directly, but by using one of the commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5511 |:ptag|, |:pedit|, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5512
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5513 *'printdevice'* *'pdev'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5514 'printdevice' 'pdev' string (default empty)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5515 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5516 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5517 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5518 feature}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5519 The name of the printer to be used for |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5520 See |pdev-option|.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
5521 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
5522 security reasons.
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5523
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5524 *'printencoding'* *'penc'*
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5525 'printencoding' 'penc' String (default empty, except for some systems)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5526 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5527 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5528 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5529 and |+postscript| features}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5530 Sets the character encoding used when printing.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5531 See |penc-option|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5532
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5533 *'printexpr'* *'pexpr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5534 'printexpr' 'pexpr' String (default: see below)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5535 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5536 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5537 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5538 and |+postscript| features}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5539 Expression used to print the PostScript produced with |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5540 See |pexpr-option|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5541
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5542 *'printfont'* *'pfn'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5543 'printfont' 'pfn' string (default "courier")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5544 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5545 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5546 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5547 feature}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5548 The name of the font that will be used for |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5549 See |pfn-option|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5550
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5551 *'printheader'* *'pheader'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5552 'printheader' 'pheader' string (default "%<%f%h%m%=Page %N")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5553 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5554 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5555 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5556 feature}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5557 The format of the header produced in |:hardcopy| output.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5558 See |pheader-option|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5559
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5560 *'printmbcharset'* *'pmbcs'*
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5561 'printmbcharset' 'pmbcs' string (default "")
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5562 global
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5563 {not in Vi}
180
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
5564 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|,
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
5565 |+postscript| and |+multi_byte| features}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5566 The CJK character set to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5567 See |pmbcs-option|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5568
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5569 *'printmbfont'* *'pmbfn'*
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5570 'printmbfont' 'pmbfn' string (default "")
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5571 global
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5572 {not in Vi}
180
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
5573 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|,
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
5574 |+postscript| and |+multi_byte| features}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5575 List of font names to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5576 See |pmbfn-option|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5577
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5578 *'printoptions'* *'popt'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5579 'printoptions' 'popt' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5580 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5581 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5582 {only available when compiled with |+printer| feature}
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5583 List of items that control the format of the output of |:hardcopy|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5584 See |popt-option|.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 14
diff changeset
5585
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5586 *'prompt'* *'noprompt'*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5587 'prompt' boolean (default on)
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5588 global
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5589 When on a ":" prompt is used in Ex mode.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
5590
766
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5591 *'pumheight'* *'ph'*
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5592 'pumheight' 'ph' number (default 0)
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5593 global
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5594 {not available when compiled without the
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5595 |+insert_expand| feature}
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5596 {not in Vi}
853
d10fbefd3bc1 updated for version 7.0f05
vimboss
parents: 844
diff changeset
5597 Determines the maximum number of items to show in the popup menu for
d10fbefd3bc1 updated for version 7.0f05
vimboss
parents: 844
diff changeset
5598 Insert mode completion. When zero as much space as available is used.
766
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5599 |ins-completion-menu|.
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5600
f0d0d3d3a1e2 updated for version 7.0225
vimboss
parents: 743
diff changeset
5601
140
8ecb0db93e9a updated for version 7.0045
vimboss
parents: 99
diff changeset
5602 *'quoteescape'* *'qe'*
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5603 'quoteescape' 'qe' string (default "\")
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5604 local to buffer
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5605 {not in Vi}
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5606 The characters that are used to escape quotes in a string. Used for
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5607 objects like a', a" and a` |a'|.
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5608 When one of the characters in this option is found inside a string,
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5609 the following character will be skipped. The default value makes the
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5610 text "foo\"bar\\" considered to be one string.
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 11
diff changeset
5611
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5612 *'readonly'* *'ro'* *'noreadonly'* *'noro'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5613 'readonly' 'ro' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5614 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5615 If on, writes fail unless you use a '!'. Protects you from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5616 accidentally overwriting a file. Default on when Vim is started
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5617 in read-only mode ("vim -R") or when the executable is called "view".
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
5618 When using ":w!" the 'readonly' option is reset for the current
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
5619 buffer, unless the 'Z' flag is in 'cpoptions'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5620 {not in Vi:} When using the ":view" command the 'readonly' option is
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
5621 set for the newly edited buffer.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5622
1521
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5623 *'redrawtime'* *'rdt'*
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5624 'redrawtime' 'rdt' number (default 2000)
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5625 global
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5626 {not in Vi}
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5627 {only available when compiled with the |+reltime|
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5628 feature}
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5629 The time in milliseconds for redrawing the display. This applies to
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5630 searching for patterns for 'hlsearch' and |:match| highlighting.
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5631 When redrawing takes more than this many milliseconds no further
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5632 matches will be highlighted. This is used to avoid that Vim hangs
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5633 when using a very complicated pattern.
cc4fe241baa3 updated for version 7.1-236
vimboss
parents: 1354
diff changeset
5634
4681
2eb30f341e8d Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4502
diff changeset
5635 *'regexpengine'* *'re'*
4502
605c9ce57ec3 Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4358
diff changeset
5636 'regexpengine' 're' number (default 0)
605c9ce57ec3 Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4358
diff changeset
5637 global
605c9ce57ec3 Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4358
diff changeset
5638 {not in Vi}
605c9ce57ec3 Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4358
diff changeset
5639 This selects the default regexp engine. |two-engines|
605c9ce57ec3 Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4358
diff changeset
5640 The possible values are:
605c9ce57ec3 Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4358
diff changeset
5641 0 automatic selection
605c9ce57ec3 Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4358
diff changeset
5642 1 old engine
605c9ce57ec3 Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4358
diff changeset
5643 2 NFA engine
605c9ce57ec3 Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4358
diff changeset
5644 Note that when using the NFA engine and the pattern contains something
605c9ce57ec3 Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4358
diff changeset
5645 that is not supported the pattern will not match. This is only useful
605c9ce57ec3 Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4358
diff changeset
5646 for debugging the regexp engine.
6328
adfbffe1e642 updated for version 7.4.497
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6259
diff changeset
5647 Using automatic selection enables Vim to switch the engine, if the
adfbffe1e642 updated for version 7.4.497
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6259
diff changeset
5648 default engine becomes too costly. E.g., when the NFA engine uses too
adfbffe1e642 updated for version 7.4.497
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6259
diff changeset
5649 many states. This should prevent Vim from hanging on a combination of
adfbffe1e642 updated for version 7.4.497
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6259
diff changeset
5650 a complex pattern with long text.
4502
605c9ce57ec3 Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4358
diff changeset
5651
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5652 *'relativenumber'* *'rnu'* *'norelativenumber'* *'nornu'*
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5653 'relativenumber' 'rnu' boolean (default off)
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5654 local to window
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5655 {not in Vi}
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5656 Show the line number relative to the line with the cursor in front of
2207
b17bbfa96fa0 Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2204
diff changeset
5657 each line. Relative line numbers help you use the |count| you can
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5658 precede some vertical motion commands (e.g. j k + -) with, without
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5659 having to calculate it yourself. Especially useful in combination with
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5660 other commands (e.g. y d c < > gq gw =).
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5661 When the 'n' option is excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5662 line will not use the column of line numbers (this is the default when
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5663 'compatible' isn't set).
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5664 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5665 number.
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5666 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-'
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5667 characters are put before the number.
3445
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
5668 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
5669 the number.
4780
2b11ac90d9e9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4681
diff changeset
5670
2b11ac90d9e9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4681
diff changeset
5671 The number in front of the cursor line also depends on the value of
2b11ac90d9e9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4681
diff changeset
5672 'number', see |number_relativenumber| for all combinations of the two
2b11ac90d9e9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4681
diff changeset
5673 options.
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
5674
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5675 *'remap'* *'noremap'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5676 'remap' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5677 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5678 Allows for mappings to work recursively. If you do not want this for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5679 a single entry, use the :noremap[!] command.
717
2fa8cb05b861 updated for version 7.0218
vimboss
parents: 714
diff changeset
5680 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with Vim scripts, always keep
2fa8cb05b861 updated for version 7.0218
vimboss
parents: 714
diff changeset
5681 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with
2fa8cb05b861 updated for version 7.0218
vimboss
parents: 714
diff changeset
5682 old Vi scripts.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5683
6110
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5684 *'renderoptions'* *'rop'*
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5685 'renderoptions' 'rop' string (default: empty)
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5686 global
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5687 {not in Vi}
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5688 {only available when compiled with GUI and DIRECTX on
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5689 MS-Windows}
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5690 Select a text renderer and set its options. The options depend on the
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5691 renderer.
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5692
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5693 Syntax: >
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5694 set rop=type:{renderer}(,{name}:{value})*
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5695 <
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5696 Currently, only one optional renderer is available.
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5697
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5698 render behavior ~
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5699 directx Vim will draw text using DirectX (DirectWrite). It makes
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5700 drawn glyphs more beautiful than default GDI.
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5701 It requires 'encoding' is "utf-8", and only works on
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5702 MS-Windows Vista or newer version.
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5703
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5704 Options:
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5705 name meaning type value ~
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5706 gamma gamma float 1.0 - 2.2 (maybe)
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5707 contrast enhancedContrast float (unknown)
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5708 level clearTypeLevel float (unknown)
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5709 geom pixelGeometry int 0 - 2 (see below)
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5710 renmode renderingMode int 0 - 6 (see below)
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5711 taamode textAntialiasMode int 0 - 3 (see below)
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5712
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5713 See this URL for detail:
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5714 http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368190.aspx
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5715
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5716 For geom: structure of a device pixel.
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5717 0 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_FLAT
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5718 1 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_RGB
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5719 2 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_BGR
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5720
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5721 See this URL for detail:
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5722 http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368114.aspx
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5723
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5724 For renmode: method of rendering glyphs.
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5725 0 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_DEFAULT
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5726 1 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_ALIASED
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5727 2 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_GDI_CLASSIC
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5728 3 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_GDI_NATURAL
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5729 4 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_NATURAL
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5730 5 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_NATURAL_SYMMETRIC
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5731 6 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_OUTLINE
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5732
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5733 See this URL for detail:
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5734 http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368118.aspx
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5735
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5736 For taamode: antialiasing mode used for drawing text.
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5737 0 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_DEFAULT
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5738 1 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_CLEARTYPE
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5739 2 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_GRAYSCALE
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5740 3 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_ALIASED
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5741
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5742 See this URL for detail:
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5743 http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368170.aspx
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5744
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5745 Example: >
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5746 set encoding=utf-8
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5747 set gfn=Ricty_Diminished:h12:cSHIFTJIS
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5748 set rop=type:directx
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5749 <
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5750 If select a raster font (Courier, Terminal or FixedSys) to
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5751 'guifont', it fallbacks to be drawn by GDI automatically.
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5752
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5753 Other render types are currently not supported.
1bff71d20262 updated for version 7.4.393
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6091
diff changeset
5754
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5755 *'report'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5756 'report' number (default 2)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5757 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5758 Threshold for reporting number of lines changed. When the number of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5759 changed lines is more than 'report' a message will be given for most
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5760 ":" commands. If you want it always, set 'report' to 0.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5761 For the ":substitute" command the number of substitutions is used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5762 instead of the number of lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5763
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5764 *'restorescreen'* *'rs'* *'norestorescreen'* *'nors'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5765 'restorescreen' 'rs' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5766 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5767 {not in Vi} {only in Windows 95/NT console version}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5768 When set, the screen contents is restored when exiting Vim. This also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5769 happens when executing external commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5770
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5771 For non-Windows Vim: You can set or reset the 't_ti' and 't_te'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5772 options in your .vimrc. To disable restoring:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5773 set t_ti= t_te=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5774 To enable restoring (for an xterm):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5775 set t_ti=^[7^[[r^[[?47h t_te=^[[?47l^[8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5776 (Where ^[ is an <Esc>, type CTRL-V <Esc> to insert it)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5777
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5778 *'revins'* *'ri'* *'norevins'* *'nori'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5779 'revins' 'ri' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5780 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5781 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5782 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5783 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5784 Inserting characters in Insert mode will work backwards. See "typing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5785 backwards" |ins-reverse|. This option can be toggled with the CTRL-_
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5786 command in Insert mode, when 'allowrevins' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5787 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' or 'paste' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5788
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5789 *'rightleft'* *'rl'* *'norightleft'* *'norl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5790 'rightleft' 'rl' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5791 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5792 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5793 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5794 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5795 When on, display orientation becomes right-to-left, i.e., characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5796 that are stored in the file appear from the right to the left.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5797 Using this option, it is possible to edit files for languages that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5798 are written from the right to the left such as Hebrew and Arabic.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5799 This option is per window, so it is possible to edit mixed files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5800 simultaneously, or to view the same file in both ways (this is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5801 useful whenever you have a mixed text file with both right-to-left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5802 and left-to-right strings so that both sets are displayed properly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5803 in different windows). Also see |rileft.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5804
2341
9272cc83214f Minor runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2340
diff changeset
5805 *'rightleftcmd'* *'rlc'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5806 'rightleftcmd' 'rlc' string (default "search")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5807 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5808 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5809 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5810 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5811 Each word in this option enables the command line editing to work in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5812 right-to-left mode for a group of commands:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5813
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5814 search "/" and "?" commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5815
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5816 This is useful for languages such as Hebrew, Arabic and Farsi.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5817 The 'rightleft' option must be set for 'rightleftcmd' to take effect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5818
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5819 *'ruler'* *'ru'* *'noruler'* *'noru'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5820 'ruler' 'ru' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5821 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5822 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5823 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5824 |+cmdline_info| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5825 Show the line and column number of the cursor position, separated by a
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5826 comma. When there is room, the relative position of the displayed
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5827 text in the file is shown on the far right:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5828 Top first line is visible
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5829 Bot last line is visible
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5830 All first and last line are visible
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5831 45% relative position in the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5832 If 'rulerformat' is set, it will determine the contents of the ruler.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5833 Each window has its own ruler. If a window has a status line, the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5834 ruler is shown there. Otherwise it is shown in the last line of the
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
5835 screen. If the statusline is given by 'statusline' (i.e. not empty),
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5836 this option takes precedence over 'ruler' and 'rulerformat'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5837 If the number of characters displayed is different from the number of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5838 bytes in the text (e.g., for a TAB or a multi-byte character), both
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5839 the text column (byte number) and the screen column are shown,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5840 separated with a dash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5841 For an empty line "0-1" is shown.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5842 For an empty buffer the line number will also be zero: "0,0-1".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5843 This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5844 If you don't want to see the ruler all the time but want to know where
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5845 you are, use "g CTRL-G" |g_CTRL-G|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5846 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5847
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5848 *'rulerformat'* *'ruf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5849 'rulerformat' 'ruf' string (default empty)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5850 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5851 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5852 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5853 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5854 When this option is not empty, it determines the content of the ruler
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5855 string, as displayed for the 'ruler' option.
692
a28f83d37113 updated for version 7.0208
vimboss
parents: 688
diff changeset
5856 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5857 The default ruler width is 17 characters. To make the ruler 15
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5858 characters wide, put "%15(" at the start and "%)" at the end.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5859 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5860 :set rulerformat=%15(%c%V\ %p%%%)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5861 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5862 *'runtimepath'* *'rtp'* *vimfiles*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5863 'runtimepath' 'rtp' string (default:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5864 Unix: "$HOME/.vim,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5865 $VIM/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5866 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5867 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5868 $HOME/.vim/after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5869 Amiga: "home:vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5870 $VIM/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5871 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5872 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5873 home:vimfiles/after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5874 PC, OS/2: "$HOME/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5875 $VIM/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5876 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5877 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5878 $HOME/vimfiles/after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5879 Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5880 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5881 $VIM:vimfiles:after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5882 RISC-OS: "Choices:vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5883 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5884 Choices:vimfiles/after"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5885 VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5886 $VIM/vimfiles,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5887 $VIMRUNTIME,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5888 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
5889 sys$login:vimfiles/after")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5890 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5891 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5892 This is a list of directories which will be searched for runtime
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5893 files:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5894 filetype.vim filetypes by file name |new-filetype|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5895 scripts.vim filetypes by file contents |new-filetype-scripts|
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
5896 autoload/ automatically loaded scripts |autoload-functions|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5897 colors/ color scheme files |:colorscheme|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5898 compiler/ compiler files |:compiler|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5899 doc/ documentation |write-local-help|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5900 ftplugin/ filetype plugins |write-filetype-plugin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5901 indent/ indent scripts |indent-expression|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5902 keymap/ key mapping files |mbyte-keymap|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5903 lang/ menu translations |:menutrans|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5904 menu.vim GUI menus |menu.vim|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5905 plugin/ plugin scripts |write-plugin|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5906 print/ files for printing |postscript-print-encoding|
650
662e40bd2be1 updated for version 7.0191
vimboss
parents: 648
diff changeset
5907 spell/ spell checking files |spell|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5908 syntax/ syntax files |mysyntaxfile|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5909 tutor/ files for vimtutor |tutor|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5910
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5911 And any other file searched for with the |:runtime| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5912
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5913 The defaults for most systems are setup to search five locations:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5914 1. In your home directory, for your personal preferences.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5915 2. In a system-wide Vim directory, for preferences from the system
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5916 administrator.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5917 3. In $VIMRUNTIME, for files distributed with Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5918 *after-directory*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5919 4. In the "after" directory in the system-wide Vim directory. This is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5920 for the system administrator to overrule or add to the distributed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5921 defaults (rarely needed)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5922 5. In the "after" directory in your home directory. This is for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5923 personal preferences to overrule or add to the distributed defaults
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5924 or system-wide settings (rarely needed).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5925
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5926 Note that, unlike 'path', no wildcards like "**" are allowed. Normal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5927 wildcards are allowed, but can significantly slow down searching for
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5928 runtime files. For speed, use as few items as possible and avoid
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5929 wildcards.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5930 See |:runtime|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5931 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5932 :set runtimepath=~/vimruntime,/mygroup/vim,$VIMRUNTIME
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5933 < This will use the directory "~/vimruntime" first (containing your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5934 personal Vim runtime files), then "/mygroup/vim" (shared between a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5935 group of people) and finally "$VIMRUNTIME" (the distributed runtime
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5936 files).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5937 You probably should always include $VIMRUNTIME somewhere, to use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5938 distributed runtime files. You can put a directory before $VIMRUNTIME
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5939 to find files which replace a distributed runtime files. You can put
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5940 a directory after $VIMRUNTIME to find files which add to distributed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5941 runtime files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5942 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5943 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5944
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5945 *'scroll'* *'scr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5946 'scroll' 'scr' number (default: half the window height)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5947 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5948 Number of lines to scroll with CTRL-U and CTRL-D commands. Will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5949 set to half the number of lines in the window when the window size
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5950 changes. If you give a count to the CTRL-U or CTRL-D command it will
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
5951 be used as the new value for 'scroll'. Reset to half the window
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5952 height with ":set scroll=0". {Vi is a bit different: 'scroll' gives
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5953 the number of screen lines instead of file lines, makes a difference
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5954 when lines wrap}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5955
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5956 *'scrollbind'* *'scb'* *'noscrollbind'* *'noscb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5957 'scrollbind' 'scb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5958 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5959 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5960 {not available when compiled without the |+scrollbind|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5961 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5962 See also |scroll-binding|. When this option is set, the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5963 window scrolls as other scrollbind windows (windows that also have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5964 this option set) scroll. This option is useful for viewing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5965 differences between two versions of a file, see 'diff'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5966 See |'scrollopt'| for options that determine how this option should be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5967 interpreted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5968 This option is mostly reset when splitting a window to edit another
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5969 file. This means that ":split | edit file" results in two windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5970 with scroll-binding, but ":split file" does not.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5971
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5972 *'scrolljump'* *'sj'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5973 'scrolljump' 'sj' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5974 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5975 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5976 Minimal number of lines to scroll when the cursor gets off the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5977 screen (e.g., with "j"). Not used for scroll commands (e.g., CTRL-E,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5978 CTRL-D). Useful if your terminal scrolls very slowly.
532
7052f11a3dc9 updated for version 7.0150
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
5979 When set to a negative number from -1 to -100 this is used as the
7052f11a3dc9 updated for version 7.0150
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
5980 percentage of the window height. Thus -50 scrolls half the window
7052f11a3dc9 updated for version 7.0150
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
5981 height.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5982 NOTE: This option is set to 1 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5983
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5984 *'scrolloff'* *'so'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5985 'scrolloff' 'so' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5986 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5987 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5988 Minimal number of screen lines to keep above and below the cursor.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5989 This will make some context visible around where you are working. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5990 you set it to a very large value (999) the cursor line will always be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5991 in the middle of the window (except at the start or end of the file or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5992 when long lines wrap).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5993 For scrolling horizontally see 'sidescrolloff'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5994 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5995
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5996 *'scrollopt'* *'sbo'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5997 'scrollopt' 'sbo' string (default "ver,jump")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5998 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5999 {not available when compiled without the |+scrollbind|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6000 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6001 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6002 This is a comma-separated list of words that specifies how
236
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
6003 'scrollbind' windows should behave. 'sbo' stands for ScrollBind
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
6004 Options.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6005 The following words are available:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6006 ver Bind vertical scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6007 hor Bind horizontal scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6008 jump Applies to the offset between two windows for vertical
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6009 scrolling. This offset is the difference in the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6010 displayed line of the bound windows. When moving
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6011 around in a window, another 'scrollbind' window may
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6012 reach a position before the start or after the end of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6013 the buffer. The offset is not changed though, when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6014 moving back the 'scrollbind' window will try to scroll
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6015 to the desired position when possible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6016 When now making that window the current one, two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6017 things can be done with the relative offset:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6018 1. When "jump" is not included, the relative offset is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6019 adjusted for the scroll position in the new current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6020 window. When going back to the other window, the
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
6021 new relative offset will be used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6022 2. When "jump" is included, the other windows are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6023 scrolled to keep the same relative offset. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6024 going back to the other window, it still uses the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6025 same relative offset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6026 Also see |scroll-binding|.
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
6027 When 'diff' mode is active there always is vertical scroll binding,
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
6028 even when "ver" isn't there.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6029
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6030 *'sections'* *'sect'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6031 'sections' 'sect' string (default "SHNHH HUnhsh")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6032 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6033 Specifies the nroff macros that separate sections. These are pairs of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6034 two letters (See |object-motions|). The default makes a section start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6035 at the nroff macros ".SH", ".NH", ".H", ".HU", ".nh" and ".sh".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6036
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6037 *'secure'* *'nosecure'* *E523*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6038 'secure' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6039 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6040 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6041 When on, ":autocmd", shell and write commands are not allowed in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6042 ".vimrc" and ".exrc" in the current directory and map commands are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6043 displayed. Switch it off only if you know that you will not run into
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6044 problems, or when the 'exrc' option is off. On Unix this option is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6045 only used if the ".vimrc" or ".exrc" is not owned by you. This can be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6046 dangerous if the systems allows users to do a "chown". You better set
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6047 'secure' at the end of your ~/.vimrc then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6048 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6049 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6050
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6051 *'selection'* *'sel'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6052 'selection' 'sel' string (default "inclusive")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6053 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6054 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6055 This option defines the behavior of the selection. It is only used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6056 in Visual and Select mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6057 Possible values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6058 value past line inclusive ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6059 old no yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6060 inclusive yes yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6061 exclusive yes no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6062 "past line" means that the cursor is allowed to be positioned one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6063 character past the line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6064 "inclusive" means that the last character of the selection is included
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6065 in an operation. For example, when "x" is used to delete the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6066 selection.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6067 Note that when "exclusive" is used and selecting from the end
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6068 backwards, you cannot include the last character of a line, when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6069 starting in Normal mode and 'virtualedit' empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6070
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6071 The 'selection' option is set by the |:behave| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6072
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6073 *'selectmode'* *'slm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6074 'selectmode' 'slm' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6075 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6076 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6077 This is a comma separated list of words, which specifies when to start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6078 Select mode instead of Visual mode, when a selection is started.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6079 Possible values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6080 mouse when using the mouse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6081 key when using shifted special keys
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6082 cmd when using "v", "V" or CTRL-V
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6083 See |Select-mode|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6084 The 'selectmode' option is set by the |:behave| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6085
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6086 *'sessionoptions'* *'ssop'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6087 'sessionoptions' 'ssop' string (default: "blank,buffers,curdir,folds,
827
fd1b3406fd1c updated for version 7.0d02
vimboss
parents: 826
diff changeset
6088 help,options,tabpages,winsize")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6089 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6090 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
6091 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6092 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6093 Changes the effect of the |:mksession| command. It is a comma
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6094 separated list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6095 something:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6096 word save and restore ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6097 blank empty windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6098 buffers hidden and unloaded buffers, not just those in windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6099 curdir the current directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6100 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6101 fold options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6102 globals global variables that start with an uppercase letter
75
388f285bda1b updated for version 7.0031
vimboss
parents: 41
diff changeset
6103 and contain at least one lowercase letter. Only
388f285bda1b updated for version 7.0031
vimboss
parents: 41
diff changeset
6104 String and Number types are stored.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6105 help the help window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6106 localoptions options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6107 global values for local options)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6108 options all options and mappings (also global values for local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6109 options)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6110 resize size of the Vim window: 'lines' and 'columns'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6111 sesdir the directory in which the session file is located
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6112 will become the current directory (useful with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6113 projects accessed over a network from different
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6114 systems)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6115 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6116 slashes
827
fd1b3406fd1c updated for version 7.0d02
vimboss
parents: 826
diff changeset
6117 tabpages all tab pages; without this only the current tab page
fd1b3406fd1c updated for version 7.0d02
vimboss
parents: 826
diff changeset
6118 is restored, so that you can make a session for each
fd1b3406fd1c updated for version 7.0d02
vimboss
parents: 826
diff changeset
6119 tab page separately
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6120 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6121 on Windows or DOS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6122 winpos position of the whole Vim window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6123 winsize window sizes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6124
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6125 Don't include both "curdir" and "sesdir".
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6126 When neither "curdir" nor "sesdir" is included, file names are stored
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6127 with absolute paths.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6128 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing session files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6129 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6130 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6131
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6132 *'shell'* *'sh'* *E91*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6133 'shell' 'sh' string (default $SHELL or "sh",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6134 MS-DOS and Win32: "command.com" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6135 "cmd.exe", OS/2: "cmd")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6136 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6137 Name of the shell to use for ! and :! commands. When changing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6138 value also check these options: 'shelltype', 'shellpipe', 'shellslash'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6139 'shellredir', 'shellquote', 'shellxquote' and 'shellcmdflag'.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6140 It is allowed to give an argument to the command, e.g. "csh -f".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6141 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6142 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6143 If the name of the shell contains a space, you might need to enclose
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6144 it in quotes. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6145 :set shell=\"c:\program\ files\unix\sh.exe\"\ -f
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6146 < Note the backslash before each quote (to avoid starting a comment) and
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6147 each space (to avoid ending the option value). Also note that the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6148 "-f" is not inside the quotes, because it is not part of the command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6149 name. And Vim automagically recognizes the backslashes that are path
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6150 separators.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6151 For Dos 32 bits (DJGPP), you can set the $DJSYSFLAGS environment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6152 variable to change the way external commands are executed. See the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6153 libc.inf file of DJGPP.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6154 Under MS-Windows, when the executable ends in ".com" it must be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6155 included. Thus setting the shell to "command.com" or "4dos.com"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6156 works, but "command" and "4dos" do not work for all commands (e.g.,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6157 filtering).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6158 For unknown reasons, when using "4dos.com" the current directory is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6159 changed to "C:\". To avoid this set 'shell' like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6160 :set shell=command.com\ /c\ 4dos
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6161 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6162 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6163
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6164 *'shellcmdflag'* *'shcf'*
3356
b37888de599c Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3352
diff changeset
6165 'shellcmdflag' 'shcf' string (default: "-c";
3371
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6166 MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell' does not
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6167 contain "sh" somewhere: "/c")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6168 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6169 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6170 Flag passed to the shell to execute "!" and ":!" commands; e.g.,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6171 "bash.exe -c ls" or "command.com /c dir". For the MS-DOS-like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6172 systems, the default is set according to the value of 'shell', to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6173 reduce the need to set this option by the user. It's not used for
3082
3502a7f991fc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
6174 OS/2 (EMX figures this out itself).
3502a7f991fc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
6175 On Unix it can have more than one flag. Each white space separated
3502a7f991fc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
6176 part is passed as an argument to the shell command.
3502a7f991fc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
6177 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3502a7f991fc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
6178 Also see |dos-shell| for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6179 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6180 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6181
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6182 *'shellpipe'* *'sp'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6183 'shellpipe' 'sp' string (default ">", "| tee", "|& tee" or "2>&1| tee")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6184 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6185 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6186 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6187 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6188 String to be used to put the output of the ":make" command in the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6189 error file. See also |:make_makeprg|. See |option-backslash| about
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6190 including spaces and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6191 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6192 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6193 of this option).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6194 For the Amiga and MS-DOS the default is ">". The output is directly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6195 saved in a file and not echoed to the screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6196 For Unix the default it "| tee". The stdout of the compiler is saved
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6197 in a file and echoed to the screen. If the 'shell' option is "csh" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6198 "tcsh" after initializations, the default becomes "|& tee". If the
2788
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2729
diff changeset
6199 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "mksh", "pdksh", "zsh" or "bash" the
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2729
diff changeset
6200 default becomes "2>&1| tee". This means that stderr is also included.
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2729
diff changeset
6201 Before using the 'shell' option a path is removed, thus "/bin/sh" uses
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2729
diff changeset
6202 "sh".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6203 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6204 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6205 there, the 'shellpipe' option changes automatically, unless it was
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6206 explicitly set before.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6207 When 'shellpipe' is set to an empty string, no redirection of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6208 ":make" output will be done. This is useful if you use a 'makeprg'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6209 that writes to 'makeef' by itself. If you want no piping, but do
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6210 want to include the 'makeef', set 'shellpipe' to a single space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6211 Don't forget to precede the space with a backslash: ":set sp=\ ".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6212 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6213 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6214 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6215 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6216
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6217 *'shellquote'* *'shq'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6218 'shellquote' 'shq' string (default: ""; MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6219 contains "sh" somewhere: "\"")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6220 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6221 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6222 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6223 the "!" and ":!" commands. The redirection is kept outside of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6224 quoting. See 'shellxquote' to include the redirection. It's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6225 probably not useful to set both options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6226 This is an empty string by default. Only known to be useful for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6227 third-party shells on MS-DOS-like systems, such as the MKS Korn Shell
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6228 or bash, where it should be "\"". The default is adjusted according
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6229 the value of 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option by the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6230 user. See |dos-shell|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6231 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6232 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6233
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6234 *'shellredir'* *'srr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6235 'shellredir' 'srr' string (default ">", ">&" or ">%s 2>&1")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6236 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6237 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6238 String to be used to put the output of a filter command in a temporary
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6239 file. See also |:!|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6240 and backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6241 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6242 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6243 of this option).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6244 The default is ">". For Unix, if the 'shell' option is "csh", "tcsh"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6245 or "zsh" during initializations, the default becomes ">&". If the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6246 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh" or "bash" the default becomes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6247 ">%s 2>&1". This means that stderr is also included.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6248 For Win32, the Unix checks are done and additionally "cmd" is checked
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6249 for, which makes the default ">%s 2>&1". Also, the same names with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6250 ".exe" appended are checked for.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6251 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6252 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6253 there, the 'shellredir' option changes automatically unless it was
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6254 explicitly set before.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6255 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6256 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6257 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6258 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6259
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6260 *'shellslash'* *'ssl'* *'noshellslash'* *'nossl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6261 'shellslash' 'ssl' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6262 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6263 {not in Vi} {only for MSDOS, MS-Windows and OS/2}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6264 When set, a forward slash is used when expanding file names. This is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6265 useful when a Unix-like shell is used instead of command.com or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6266 cmd.exe. Backward slashes can still be typed, but they are changed to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6267 forward slashes by Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6268 Note that setting or resetting this option has no effect for some
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6269 existing file names, thus this option needs to be set before opening
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6270 any file for best results. This might change in the future.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6271 'shellslash' only works when a backslash can be used as a path
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6272 separator. To test if this is so use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6273 if exists('+shellslash')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6274 <
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6275 *'shelltemp'* *'stmp'* *'noshelltemp'* *'nostmp'*
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6276 'shelltemp' 'stmp' boolean (Vi default off, Vim default on)
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6277 global
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6278 {not in Vi}
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6279 When on, use temp files for shell commands. When off use a pipe.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6280 When using a pipe is not possible temp files are used anyway.
2965
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2925
diff changeset
6281 Currently a pipe is only supported on Unix and MS-Windows 2K and
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2925
diff changeset
6282 later. You can check it with: >
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6283 :if has("filterpipe")
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6284 < The advantage of using a pipe is that nobody can read the temp file
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6285 and the 'shell' command does not need to support redirection.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6286 The advantage of using a temp file is that the file type and encoding
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6287 can be detected.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6288 The |FilterReadPre|, |FilterReadPost| and |FilterWritePre|,
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6289 |FilterWritePost| autocommands event are not triggered when
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6290 'shelltemp' is off.
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6291
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6292 *'shelltype'* *'st'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6293 'shelltype' 'st' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6294 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6295 {not in Vi} {only for the Amiga}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6296 On the Amiga this option influences the way how the commands work
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6297 which use a shell.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6298 0 and 1: always use the shell
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6299 2 and 3: use the shell only to filter lines
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6300 4 and 5: use shell only for ':sh' command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6301 When not using the shell, the command is executed directly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6302
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6303 0 and 2: use "shell 'shellcmdflag' cmd" to start external commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6304 1 and 3: use "shell cmd" to start external commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6305
3371
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6306 *'shellxescape'* *'sxe'*
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6307 'shellxescape' 'sxe' string (default: "";
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6308 for MS-DOS and MS-Windows: "\"&|<>()@^")
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6309 global
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6310 {not in Vi}
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6311 When 'shellxquote' is set to "(" then the characters listed in this
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6312 option will be escaped with a '^' character. This makes it possible
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6313 to execute most external commands with cmd.exe.
8dcf3ea92b63 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3359
diff changeset
6314
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6315 *'shellxquote'* *'sxq'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6316 'shellxquote' 'sxq' string (default: "";
3359
20ca2e05ae20 updated for version 7.3.446
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3356
diff changeset
6317 for Win32, when 'shell' is cmd.exe: "("
20ca2e05ae20 updated for version 7.3.446
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3356
diff changeset
6318 for Win32, when 'shell' contains "sh"
20ca2e05ae20 updated for version 7.3.446
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3356
diff changeset
6319 somewhere: "\""
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6320 for Unix, when using system(): "\"")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6321 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6322 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6323 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6324 the "!" and ":!" commands. Includes the redirection. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6325 'shellquote' to exclude the redirection. It's probably not useful
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6326 to set both options.
3359
20ca2e05ae20 updated for version 7.3.446
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3356
diff changeset
6327 When the value is '(' then ')' is appended. When the value is '"('
20ca2e05ae20 updated for version 7.3.446
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3356
diff changeset
6328 then ')"' is appended.
20ca2e05ae20 updated for version 7.3.446
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3356
diff changeset
6329 When the value is '(' then also see 'shellxescape'.
3352
de050fcc24cf updated for version 7.3.443
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3281
diff changeset
6330 This is an empty string by default on most systems, but is known to be
de050fcc24cf updated for version 7.3.443
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3281
diff changeset
6331 useful for on Win32 version, either for cmd.exe which automatically
de050fcc24cf updated for version 7.3.443
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3281
diff changeset
6332 strips off the first and last quote on a command, or 3rd-party shells
de050fcc24cf updated for version 7.3.443
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3281
diff changeset
6333 such as the MKS Korn Shell or bash, where it should be "\"". The
de050fcc24cf updated for version 7.3.443
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3281
diff changeset
6334 default is adjusted according the value of 'shell', to reduce the need
de050fcc24cf updated for version 7.3.443
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3281
diff changeset
6335 to set this option by the user. See |dos-shell|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6336 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6337 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6338
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6339 *'shiftround'* *'sr'* *'noshiftround'* *'nosr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6340 'shiftround' 'sr' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6341 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6342 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6343 Round indent to multiple of 'shiftwidth'. Applies to > and <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6344 commands. CTRL-T and CTRL-D in Insert mode always round the indent to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6345 a multiple of 'shiftwidth' (this is Vi compatible).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6346 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6347
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6348 *'shiftwidth'* *'sw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6349 'shiftwidth' 'sw' number (default 8)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6350 local to buffer
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6351 Number of spaces to use for each step of (auto)indent. Used for
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6352 |'cindent'|, |>>|, |<<|, etc.
3893
c3036f1dca68 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3750
diff changeset
6353 When zero the 'ts' value will be used. Use the |shiftwidth()|
c3036f1dca68 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3750
diff changeset
6354 function to get the effective shiftwidth value.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6355
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6356 *'shortmess'* *'shm'*
168
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6357 'shortmess' 'shm' string (Vim default "filnxtToO", Vi default: "",
4d9eabb1396e updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
6358 POSIX default: "A")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6359 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6360 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6361 This option helps to avoid all the |hit-enter| prompts caused by file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6362 messages, for example with CTRL-G, and to avoid some other messages.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6363 It is a list of flags:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6364 flag meaning when present ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6365 f use "(3 of 5)" instead of "(file 3 of 5)"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6366 i use "[noeol]" instead of "[Incomplete last line]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6367 l use "999L, 888C" instead of "999 lines, 888 characters"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6368 m use "[+]" instead of "[Modified]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6369 n use "[New]" instead of "[New File]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6370 r use "[RO]" instead of "[readonly]"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6371 w use "[w]" instead of "written" for file write message
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6372 and "[a]" instead of "appended" for ':w >> file' command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6373 x use "[dos]" instead of "[dos format]", "[unix]" instead of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6374 "[unix format]" and "[mac]" instead of "[mac format]".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6375 a all of the above abbreviations
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6376
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6377 o overwrite message for writing a file with subsequent message
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6378 for reading a file (useful for ":wn" or when 'autowrite' on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6379 O message for reading a file overwrites any previous message.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6380 Also for quickfix message (e.g., ":cn").
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6381 s don't give "search hit BOTTOM, continuing at TOP" or "search
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6382 hit TOP, continuing at BOTTOM" messages
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6383 t truncate file message at the start if it is too long to fit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6384 on the command-line, "<" will appear in the left most column.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6385 Ignored in Ex mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6386 T truncate other messages in the middle if they are too long to
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6387 fit on the command line. "..." will appear in the middle.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6388 Ignored in Ex mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6389 W don't give "written" or "[w]" when writing a file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6390 A don't give the "ATTENTION" message when an existing swap file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6391 is found.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6392 I don't give the intro message when starting Vim |:intro|.
5946
4d7af1962d6c updated for version 7.4.314
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5908
diff changeset
6393 c don't give |ins-completion-menu| messages. For example,
4d7af1962d6c updated for version 7.4.314
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5908
diff changeset
6394 "-- XXX completion (YYY)", "match 1 of 2", "The only match",
4d7af1962d6c updated for version 7.4.314
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5908
diff changeset
6395 "Pattern not found", "Back at original", etc.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6396
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6397 This gives you the opportunity to avoid that a change between buffers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6398 requires you to hit <Enter>, but still gives as useful a message as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6399 possible for the space available. To get the whole message that you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6400 would have got with 'shm' empty, use ":file!"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6401 Useful values:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6402 shm= No abbreviation of message.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6403 shm=a Abbreviation, but no loss of information.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6404 shm=at Abbreviation, and truncate message when necessary.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6405
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6406 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6407 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6408
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6409 *'shortname'* *'sn'* *'noshortname'* *'nosn'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6410 'shortname' 'sn' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6411 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6412 {not in Vi, not in MS-DOS versions}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6413 Filenames are assumed to be 8 characters plus one extension of 3
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6414 characters. Multiple dots in file names are not allowed. When this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6415 option is on, dots in file names are replaced with underscores when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6416 adding an extension (".~" or ".swp"). This option is not available
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6417 for MS-DOS, because then it would always be on. This option is useful
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6418 when editing files on an MS-DOS compatible filesystem, e.g., messydos
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6419 or crossdos. When running the Win32 GUI version under Win32s, this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6420 option is always on by default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6421
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6422 *'showbreak'* *'sbr'* *E595*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6423 'showbreak' 'sbr' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6424 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6425 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
6426 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6427 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6428 String to put at the start of lines that have been wrapped. Useful
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6429 values are "> " or "+++ ": >
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6430 :set showbreak=>\
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6431 < Note the backslash to escape the trailing space. It's easier like
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6432 this: >
2314
233eb4412f5d Added 'colorcolumn' option. Partly by Gregor Uhlenheuer.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2302
diff changeset
6433 :let &showbreak = '+++ '
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6434 < Only printable single-cell characters are allowed, excluding <Tab> and
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6435 comma (in a future version the comma might be used to separate the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6436 part that is shown at the end and at the start of a line).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6437 The characters are highlighted according to the '@' flag in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6438 'highlight'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6439 Note that tabs after the showbreak will be displayed differently.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6440 If you want the 'showbreak' to appear in between line numbers, add the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6441 "n" flag to 'cpoptions'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6442
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6443 *'showcmd'* *'sc'* *'noshowcmd'* *'nosc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6444 'showcmd' 'sc' boolean (Vim default: on, off for Unix, Vi default:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6445 off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6446 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6447 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6448 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6449 |+cmdline_info| feature}
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
6450 Show (partial) command in the last line of the screen. Set this
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
6451 option off if your terminal is slow.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6452 In Visual mode the size of the selected area is shown:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6453 - When selecting characters within a line, the number of characters.
2324
0a258a67051d In Visual mode with 'showcmd' display the number of bytes and characters.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2317
diff changeset
6454 If the number of bytes is different it is also displayed: "2-6"
0a258a67051d In Visual mode with 'showcmd' display the number of bytes and characters.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2317
diff changeset
6455 means two characters and six bytes.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6456 - When selecting more than one line, the number of lines.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6457 - When selecting a block, the size in screen characters:
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
6458 {lines}x{columns}.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6459 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6460 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6461
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6462 *'showfulltag'* *'sft'* *'noshowfulltag'* *'nosft'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6463 'showfulltag' 'sft' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6464 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6465 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6466 When completing a word in insert mode (see |ins-completion|) from the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6467 tags file, show both the tag name and a tidied-up form of the search
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6468 pattern (if there is one) as possible matches. Thus, if you have
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6469 matched a C function, you can see a template for what arguments are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6470 required (coding style permitting).
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
6471 Note that this doesn't work well together with having "longest" in
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
6472 'completeopt', because the completion from the search pattern may not
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
6473 match the typed text.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6474
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6475 *'showmatch'* *'sm'* *'noshowmatch'* *'nosm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6476 'showmatch' 'sm' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6477 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6478 When a bracket is inserted, briefly jump to the matching one. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6479 jump is only done if the match can be seen on the screen. The time to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6480 show the match can be set with 'matchtime'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6481 A Beep is given if there is no match (no matter if the match can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6482 seen or not). This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6483 When the 'm' flag is not included in 'cpoptions', typing a character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6484 will immediately move the cursor back to where it belongs.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6485 See the "sm" field in 'guicursor' for setting the cursor shape and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6486 blinking when showing the match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6487 The 'matchpairs' option can be used to specify the characters to show
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6488 matches for. 'rightleft' and 'revins' are used to look for opposite
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6489 matches.
699
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6490 Also see the matchparen plugin for highlighting the match when moving
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6491 around |pi_paren.txt|.
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
6492 Note: Use of the short form is rated PG.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6493
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6494 *'showmode'* *'smd'* *'noshowmode'* *'nosmd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6495 'showmode' 'smd' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6496 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6497 If in Insert, Replace or Visual mode put a message on the last line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6498 Use the 'M' flag in 'highlight' to set the type of highlighting for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6499 this message.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6500 When |XIM| may be used the message will include "XIM". But this
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6501 doesn't mean XIM is really active, especially when 'imactivatekey' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6502 not set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6503 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6504 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6505
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6506 *'showtabline'* *'stal'*
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6507 'showtabline' 'stal' number (default 1)
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6508 global
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6509 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
6510 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6511 feature}
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6512 The value of this option specifies when the line with tab page labels
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6513 will be displayed:
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6514 0: never
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6515 1: only if there are at least two tab pages
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6516 2: always
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6517 This is both for the GUI and non-GUI implementation of the tab pages
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6518 line.
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6519 See |tab-page| for more information about tab pages.
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
6520
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6521 *'sidescroll'* *'ss'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6522 'sidescroll' 'ss' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6523 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6524 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6525 The minimal number of columns to scroll horizontally. Used only when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6526 the 'wrap' option is off and the cursor is moved off of the screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6527 When it is zero the cursor will be put in the middle of the screen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6528 When using a slow terminal set it to a large number or 0. When using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6529 a fast terminal use a small number or 1. Not used for "zh" and "zl"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6530 commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6531
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6532 *'sidescrolloff'* *'siso'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6533 'sidescrolloff' 'siso' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6534 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6535 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6536 The minimal number of screen columns to keep to the left and to the
534
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
6537 right of the cursor if 'nowrap' is set. Setting this option to a
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
6538 value greater than 0 while having |'sidescroll'| also at a non-zero
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
6539 value makes some context visible in the line you are scrolling in
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
6540 horizontally (except at beginning of the line). Setting this option
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
6541 to a large value (like 999) has the effect of keeping the cursor
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
6542 horizontally centered in the window, as long as one does not come too
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 532
diff changeset
6543 close to the beginning of the line.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6544 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6545
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6546 Example: Try this together with 'sidescroll' and 'listchars' as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6547 in the following example to never allow the cursor to move
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6548 onto the "extends" character:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6549
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6550 :set nowrap sidescroll=1 listchars=extends:>,precedes:<
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6551 :set sidescrolloff=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6552
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6553
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6554 *'smartcase'* *'scs'* *'nosmartcase'* *'noscs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6555 'smartcase' 'scs' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6556 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6557 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6558 Override the 'ignorecase' option if the search pattern contains upper
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6559 case characters. Only used when the search pattern is typed and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6560 'ignorecase' option is on. Used for the commands "/", "?", "n", "N",
3557
9cb3a75a20b9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3513
diff changeset
6561 ":g" and ":s". Not used for "*", "#", "gd", tag search, etc. After
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6562 "*" and "#" you can make 'smartcase' used by doing a "/" command,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6563 recalling the search pattern from history and hitting <Enter>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6564 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6565
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6566 *'smartindent'* *'si'* *'nosmartindent'* *'nosi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6567 'smartindent' 'si' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6568 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6569 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6570 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6571 |+smartindent| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6572 Do smart autoindenting when starting a new line. Works for C-like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6573 programs, but can also be used for other languages. 'cindent' does
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6574 something like this, works better in most cases, but is more strict,
2662
916c90b37ea9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2654
diff changeset
6575 see |C-indenting|. When 'cindent' is on or 'indentexpr' is set,
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2625
diff changeset
6576 setting 'si' has no effect. 'indentexpr' is a more advanced
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2625
diff changeset
6577 alternative.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6578 Normally 'autoindent' should also be on when using 'smartindent'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6579 An indent is automatically inserted:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6580 - After a line ending in '{'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6581 - After a line starting with a keyword from 'cinwords'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6582 - Before a line starting with '}' (only with the "O" command).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6583 When typing '}' as the first character in a new line, that line is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6584 given the same indent as the matching '{'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6585 When typing '#' as the first character in a new line, the indent for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6586 that line is removed, the '#' is put in the first column. The indent
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6587 is restored for the next line. If you don't want this, use this
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6588 mapping: ":inoremap # X^H#", where ^H is entered with CTRL-V CTRL-H.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6589 When using the ">>" command, lines starting with '#' are not shifted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6590 right.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6591 NOTE: 'smartindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set. When 'paste'
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6592 is set smart indenting is disabled.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6593
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6594 *'smarttab'* *'sta'* *'nosmarttab'* *'nosta'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6595 'smarttab' 'sta' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6596 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6597 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6598 When on, a <Tab> in front of a line inserts blanks according to
648
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
6599 'shiftwidth'. 'tabstop' or 'softtabstop' is used in other places. A
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
6600 <BS> will delete a 'shiftwidth' worth of space at the start of the
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
6601 line.
650
662e40bd2be1 updated for version 7.0191
vimboss
parents: 648
diff changeset
6602 When off, a <Tab> always inserts blanks according to 'tabstop' or
648
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
6603 'softtabstop'. 'shiftwidth' is only used for shifting text left or
9032e4668296 updated for version 7.0189
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
6604 right |shift-left-right|.
1263
57361514f73a updated for version 7.1
vimboss
parents: 1213
diff changeset
6605 What gets inserted (a <Tab> or spaces) depends on the 'expandtab'
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6606 option. Also see |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the
11
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
6607 number of spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6608 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6609
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6610 *'softtabstop'* *'sts'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6611 'softtabstop' 'sts' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6612 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6613 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6614 Number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while performing editing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6615 operations, like inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6616 <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mix of spaces and <Tab>s is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6617 used. This is useful to keep the 'ts' setting at its standard value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6618 of 8, while being able to edit like it is set to 'sts'. However,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6619 commands like "x" still work on the actual characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6620 When 'sts' is zero, this feature is off.
3893
c3036f1dca68 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3750
diff changeset
6621 When 'sts' is negative, the value of 'shiftwidth' is used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6622 'softtabstop' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6623 See also |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the number of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6624 spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6625 The 'L' flag in 'cpoptions' changes how tabs are used when 'list' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6626 set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6627 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6628
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6629 *'spell'* *'nospell'*
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6630 'spell' boolean (default off)
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6631 local to window
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6632 {not in Vi}
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6633 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6634 feature}
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6635 When on spell checking will be done. See |spell|.
236
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
6636 The languages are specified with 'spelllang'.
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6637
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6638 *'spellcapcheck'* *'spc'*
389
4fe8e1a7758e updated for version 7.0102
vimboss
parents: 386
diff changeset
6639 'spellcapcheck' 'spc' string (default "[.?!]\_[\])'" \t]\+")
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6640 local to buffer
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6641 {not in Vi}
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6642 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6643 feature}
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6644 Pattern to locate the end of a sentence. The following word will be
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6645 checked to start with a capital letter. If not then it is highlighted
484
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
6646 with SpellCap |hl-SpellCap| (unless the word is also badly spelled).
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6647 When this check is not wanted make this option empty.
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6648 Only used when 'spell' is set.
389
4fe8e1a7758e updated for version 7.0102
vimboss
parents: 386
diff changeset
6649 Be careful with special characters, see |option-backslash| about
4fe8e1a7758e updated for version 7.0102
vimboss
parents: 386
diff changeset
6650 including spaces and backslashes.
480
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
6651 To set this option automatically depending on the language, see
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
6652 |set-spc-auto|.
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6653
314
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6654 *'spellfile'* *'spf'*
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6655 'spellfile' 'spf' string (default empty)
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6656 local to buffer
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6657 {not in Vi}
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6658 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6659 feature}
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6660 Name of the word list file where words are added for the |zg| and |zw|
401
4a1ead01d30b updated for version 7.0105
vimboss
parents: 389
diff changeset
6661 commands. It must end in ".{encoding}.add". You need to include the
4a1ead01d30b updated for version 7.0105
vimboss
parents: 389
diff changeset
6662 path, otherwise the file is placed in the current directory.
386
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6663 *E765*
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6664 It may also be a comma separated list of names. A count before the
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6665 |zg| and |zw| commands can be used to access each. This allows using
607d3cd9364f updated for version 7.0100
vimboss
parents: 378
diff changeset
6666 a personal word list file and a project word list file.
314
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6667 When a word is added while this option is empty Vim will set it for
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
6668 you: Using the first directory in 'runtimepath' that is writable. If
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
6669 there is no "spell" directory yet it will be created. For the file
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 818
diff changeset
6670 name the first language name that appears in 'spelllang' is used,
353
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6671 ignoring the region.
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6672 The resulting ".spl" file will be used for spell checking, it does not
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6673 have to appear in 'spelllang'.
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6674 Normally one file is used for all regions, but you can add the region
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6675 name if you want to. However, it will then only be used when
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6676 'spellfile' is set to it, for entries in 'spelllang' only files
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6677 without region name will be found.
336
2d8c2622e1fa updated for version 7.0087
vimboss
parents: 314
diff changeset
6678 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2d8c2622e1fa updated for version 7.0087
vimboss
parents: 314
diff changeset
6679 security reasons.
314
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6680
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6681 *'spelllang'* *'spl'*
314
529f887b5cb7 updated for version 7.0082
vimboss
parents: 308
diff changeset
6682 'spelllang' 'spl' string (default "en")
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6683 local to buffer
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6684 {not in Vi}
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6685 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6686 feature}
353
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6687 A comma separated list of word list names. When the 'spell' option is
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6688 on spellchecking will be done for these languages. Example: >
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6689 set spelllang=en_us,nl,medical
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6690 < This means US English, Dutch and medical words are recognized. Words
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6691 that are not recognized will be highlighted.
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6692 The word list name must not include a comma or dot. Using a dash is
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6693 recommended to separate the two letter language name from a
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6694 specification. Thus "en-rare" is used for rare English words.
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6695 A region name must come last and have the form "_xx", where "xx" is
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6696 the two-letter, lower case region name. You can use more than one
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6697 region by listing them: "en_us,en_ca" supports both US and Canadian
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6698 English, but not words specific for Australia, New Zealand or Great
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6699 Britain.
5477
853a76c7fded updated for version 7.4.088
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5466
diff changeset
6700 If the name "cjk" is included East Asian characters are excluded from
853a76c7fded updated for version 7.4.088
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5466
diff changeset
6701 spell checking. This is useful when editing text that also has Asian
853a76c7fded updated for version 7.4.088
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5466
diff changeset
6702 words.
484
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
6703 *E757*
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6704 As a special case the name of a .spl file can be given as-is. The
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6705 first "_xx" in the name is removed and used as the region name
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6706 (_xx is an underscore, two letters and followed by a non-letter).
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6707 This is mainly for testing purposes. You must make sure the correct
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6708 encoding is used, Vim doesn't check it.
236
4707450c2b33 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 233
diff changeset
6709 When 'encoding' is set the word lists are reloaded. Thus it's a good
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6710 idea to set 'spelllang' after setting 'encoding' to avoid loading the
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
6711 files twice.
353
3161473d6462 updated for version 7.0091
vimboss
parents: 344
diff changeset
6712 How the related spell files are found is explained here: |spell-load|.
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 205
diff changeset
6713
653
5acda076fb0c updated for version 7.0192
vimboss
parents: 650
diff changeset
6714 If the |spellfile.vim| plugin is active and you use a language name
5acda076fb0c updated for version 7.0192
vimboss
parents: 650
diff changeset
6715 for which Vim cannot find the .spl file in 'runtimepath' the plugin
5acda076fb0c updated for version 7.0192
vimboss
parents: 650
diff changeset
6716 will ask you if you want to download the file.
5acda076fb0c updated for version 7.0192
vimboss
parents: 650
diff changeset
6717
480
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
6718 After this option has been set successfully, Vim will source the files
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
6719 "spell/LANG.vim" in 'runtimepath'. "LANG" is the value of 'spelllang'
650
662e40bd2be1 updated for version 7.0191
vimboss
parents: 648
diff changeset
6720 up to the first comma, dot or underscore.
662e40bd2be1 updated for version 7.0191
vimboss
parents: 648
diff changeset
6721 Also see |set-spc-auto|.
480
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
6722
bf5ba8a0cdee updated for version 7.0129
vimboss
parents: 477
diff changeset
6723
344
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6724 *'spellsuggest'* *'sps'*
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6725 'spellsuggest' 'sps' string (default "best")
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6726 global
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6727 {not in Vi}
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6728 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6729 feature}
593
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
6730 Methods used for spelling suggestions. Both for the |z=| command and
374
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6731 the |spellsuggest()| function. This is a comma-separated list of
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6732 items:
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6733
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6734 best Internal method that works best for English. Finds
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6735 changes like "fast" and uses a bit of sound-a-like
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6736 scoring to improve the ordering.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6737
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6738 double Internal method that uses two methods and mixes the
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6739 results. The first method is "fast", the other method
344
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6740 computes how much the suggestion sounds like the bad
374
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6741 word. That only works when the language specifies
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6742 sound folding. Can be slow and doesn't always give
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6743 better results.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6744
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6745 fast Internal method that only checks for simple changes:
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6746 character inserts/deletes/swaps. Works well for
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6747 simple typing mistakes.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6748
593
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
6749 {number} The maximum number of suggestions listed for |z=|.
484
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
6750 Not used for |spellsuggest()|. The number of
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
6751 suggestions is never more than the value of 'lines'
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
6752 minus two.
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 480
diff changeset
6753
374
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6754 file:{filename} Read file {filename}, which must have two columns,
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6755 separated by a slash. The first column contains the
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6756 bad word, the second column the suggested good word.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6757 Example:
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6758 theribal/terrible ~
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6759 Use this for common mistakes that do not appear at the
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6760 top of the suggestion list with the internal methods.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6761 Lines without a slash are ignored, use this for
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6762 comments.
5862
306caa30d83b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5763
diff changeset
6763 The word in the second column must be correct,
306caa30d83b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5763
diff changeset
6764 otherwise it will not be used. Add the word to an
306caa30d83b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5763
diff changeset
6765 ".add" file if it is currently flagged as a spelling
306caa30d83b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5763
diff changeset
6766 mistake.
374
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6767 The file is used for all languages.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6768
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6769 expr:{expr} Evaluate expression {expr}. Use a function to avoid
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6770 trouble with spaces. |v:val| holds the badly spelled
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6771 word. The expression must evaluate to a List of
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6772 Lists, each with a suggestion and a score.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6773 Example:
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6774 [['the', 33], ['that', 44]]
593
d220eb88e4e4 updated for version 7.0168
vimboss
parents: 590
diff changeset
6775 Set 'verbose' and use |z=| to see the scores that the
374
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6776 internal methods use. A lower score is better.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6777 This may invoke |spellsuggest()| if you temporarily
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6778 set 'spellsuggest' to exclude the "expr:" part.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6779 Errors are silently ignored, unless you set the
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6780 'verbose' option to a non-zero value.
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6781
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6782 Only one of "best", "double" or "fast" may be used. The others may
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6783 appear several times in any order. Example: >
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6784 :set sps=file:~/.vim/sugg,best,expr:MySuggest()
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6785 <
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6786 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
575dacb554d8 updated for version 7.0096
vimboss
parents: 356
diff changeset
6787 security reasons.
344
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6788
7033303ea0c0 updated for version 7.0089
vimboss
parents: 336
diff changeset
6789
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6790 *'splitbelow'* *'sb'* *'nosplitbelow'* *'nosb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6791 'splitbelow' 'sb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6792 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6793 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
6794 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6795 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6796 When on, splitting a window will put the new window below the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6797 one. |:split|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6798
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6799 *'splitright'* *'spr'* *'nosplitright'* *'nospr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6800 'splitright' 'spr' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6801 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6802 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
6803 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6804 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6805 When on, splitting a window will put the new window right of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6806 current one. |:vsplit|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6807
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6808 *'startofline'* *'sol'* *'nostartofline'* *'nosol'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6809 'startofline' 'sol' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6810 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6811 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6812 When "on" the commands listed below move the cursor to the first
11
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
6813 non-blank of the line. When off the cursor is kept in the same column
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6814 (if possible). This applies to the commands: CTRL-D, CTRL-U, CTRL-B,
11
4424b47a0797 updated for version 7.0003
vimboss
parents: 10
diff changeset
6815 CTRL-F, "G", "H", "M", "L", gg, and to the commands "d", "<<" and ">>"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6816 with a linewise operator, with "%" with a count and to buffer changing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6817 commands (CTRL-^, :bnext, :bNext, etc.). Also for an Ex command that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6818 only has a line number, e.g., ":25" or ":+".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6819 In case of buffer changing commands the cursor is placed at the column
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6820 where it was the last time the buffer was edited.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6821 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6822
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
6823 *'statusline'* *'stl'* *E540* *E542*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6824 'statusline' 'stl' string (default empty)
40
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
6825 global or local to window |global-local|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6826 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6827 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6828 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6829 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the status line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6830 Also see |status-line|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6831
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6832 The option consists of printf style '%' items interspersed with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6833 normal text. Each status line item is of the form:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6834 %-0{minwid}.{maxwid}{item}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6835 All fields except the {item} is optional. A single percent sign can
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
6836 be given as "%%". Up to 80 items can be specified. *E541*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6837
680
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6838 When the option starts with "%!" then it is used as an expression,
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6839 evaluated and the result is used as the option value. Example: >
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6840 :set statusline=%!MyStatusLine()
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6841 < The result can contain %{} items that will be evaluated too.
3445
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
6842 Note that the "%!" expression is evaluated in the context of the
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
6843 current window and buffer, while %{} items are evaluated in the
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3371
diff changeset
6844 context of the window that the statusline belongs to.
680
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6845
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6846 When there is error while evaluating the option then it will be made
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6847 empty to avoid further errors. Otherwise screen updating would loop.
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6848
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6849 Note that the only effect of 'ruler' when this option is set (and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6850 'laststatus' is 2) is controlling the output of |CTRL-G|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6851
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6852 field meaning ~
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6853 - Left justify the item. The default is right justified
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6854 when minwid is larger than the length of the item.
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6855 0 Leading zeroes in numeric items. Overridden by '-'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6856 minwid Minimum width of the item, padding as set by '-' & '0'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6857 Value must be 50 or less.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6858 maxwid Maximum width of the item. Truncation occurs with a '<'
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6859 on the left for text items. Numeric items will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6860 shifted down to maxwid-2 digits followed by '>'number
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6861 where number is the amount of missing digits, much like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6862 an exponential notation.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6863 item A one letter code as described below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6864
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6865 Following is a description of the possible statusline items. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6866 second character in "item" is the type:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6867 N for number
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6868 S for string
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6869 F for flags as described below
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6870 - not applicable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6871
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6872 item meaning ~
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
6873 f S Path to the file in the buffer, as typed or relative to current
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
6874 directory.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6875 F S Full path to the file in the buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6876 t S File name (tail) of file in the buffer.
1698
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
6877 m F Modified flag, text is "[+]"; "[-]" if 'modifiable' is off.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6878 M F Modified flag, text is ",+" or ",-".
1698
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
6879 r F Readonly flag, text is "[RO]".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6880 R F Readonly flag, text is ",RO".
1698
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
6881 h F Help buffer flag, text is "[help]".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6882 H F Help buffer flag, text is ",HLP".
1698
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
6883 w F Preview window flag, text is "[Preview]".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6884 W F Preview window flag, text is ",PRV".
1698
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
6885 y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., "[vim]". See 'filetype'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6886 Y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., ",VIM". See 'filetype'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6887 {not available when compiled without |+autocmd| feature}
2411
68e394361ca3 Add "q" item for 'statusline'. Add w:quickfix_title. (Lech Lorens)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2400
diff changeset
6888 q S "[Quickfix List]", "[Location List]" or empty.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6889 k S Value of "b:keymap_name" or 'keymap' when |:lmap| mappings are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6890 being used: "<keymap>"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6891 n N Buffer number.
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
6892 b N Value of character under cursor.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6893 B N As above, in hexadecimal.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6894 o N Byte number in file of byte under cursor, first byte is 1.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6895 Mnemonic: Offset from start of file (with one added)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6896 {not available when compiled without |+byte_offset| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6897 O N As above, in hexadecimal.
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6898 N N Printer page number. (Only works in the 'printheader' option.)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6899 l N Line number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6900 L N Number of lines in buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6901 c N Column number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6902 v N Virtual column number.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6903 V N Virtual column number as -{num}. Not displayed if equal to 'c'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6904 p N Percentage through file in lines as in |CTRL-G|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6905 P S Percentage through file of displayed window. This is like the
5055
c458ff35497e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5024
diff changeset
6906 percentage described for 'ruler'. Always 3 in length, unless
c458ff35497e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5024
diff changeset
6907 translated.
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6908 a S Argument list status as in default title. ({current} of {max})
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6909 Empty if the argument file count is zero or one.
680
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6910 { NF Evaluate expression between '%{' and '}' and substitute result.
625
81fe2ccc1207 updated for version 7.0179
vimboss
parents: 623
diff changeset
6911 Note that there is no '%' before the closing '}'.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6912 ( - Start of item group. Can be used for setting the width and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6913 alignment of a section. Must be followed by %) somewhere.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6914 ) - End of item group. No width fields allowed.
681
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6915 T N For 'tabline': start of tab page N label. Use %T after the last
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6916 label. This information is used for mouse clicks.
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6917 X N For 'tabline': start of close tab N label. Use %X after the
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6918 label, e.g.: %3Xclose%X. Use %999X for a "close current tab"
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
6919 mark. This information is used for mouse clicks.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6920 < - Where to truncate line if too long. Default is at the start.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6921 No width fields allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6922 = - Separation point between left and right aligned items.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6923 No width fields allowed.
680
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6924 # - Set highlight group. The name must follow and then a # again.
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6925 Thus use %#HLname# for highlight group HLname. The same
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6926 highlighting is used, also for the statusline of non-current
5b101ff9d4c4 updated for version 7.0203
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
6927 windows.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6928 * - Set highlight group to User{N}, where {N} is taken from the
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6929 minwid field, e.g. %1*. Restore normal highlight with %* or %0*.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6930 The difference between User{N} and StatusLine will be applied
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6931 to StatusLineNC for the statusline of non-current windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6932 The number N must be between 1 and 9. See |hl-User1..9|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6933
1698
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
6934 When displaying a flag, Vim removes the leading comma, if any, when
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
6935 that flag comes right after plaintext. This will make a nice display
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
6936 when flags are used like in the examples below.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6937
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6938 When all items in a group becomes an empty string (i.e. flags that are
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6939 not set) and a minwid is not set for the group, the whole group will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6940 become empty. This will make a group like the following disappear
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6941 completely from the statusline when none of the flags are set. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6942 :set statusline=...%(\ [%M%R%H]%)...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6943 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6944 Beware that an expression is evaluated each and every time the status
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6945 line is displayed. The current buffer and current window will be set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6946 temporarily to that of the window (and buffer) whose statusline is
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
6947 currently being drawn. The expression will evaluate in this context.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6948 The variable "actual_curbuf" is set to the 'bufnr()' number of the
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6949 real current buffer.
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6950
3682
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
6951 The 'statusline' option will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
6952 a modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
634
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6953
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6954 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1c586ee8dd45 updated for version 7.0183
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
6955 evaluating 'statusline' |textlock|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6956
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6957 If the statusline is not updated when you want it (e.g., after setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6958 a variable that's used in an expression), you can force an update by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6959 setting an option without changing its value. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6960 :let &ro = &ro
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6961
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6962 < A result of all digits is regarded a number for display purposes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6963 Otherwise the result is taken as flag text and applied to the rules
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6964 described above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6965
199
3b32f6b507fa updated for version 7.0059
vimboss
parents: 189
diff changeset
6966 Watch out for errors in expressions. They may render Vim unusable!
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6967 If you are stuck, hold down ':' or 'Q' to get a prompt, then quit and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6968 edit your .vimrc or whatever with "vim -u NONE" to get it right.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6969
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6970 Examples:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6971 Emulate standard status line with 'ruler' set >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6972 :set statusline=%<%f\ %h%m%r%=%-14.(%l,%c%V%)\ %P
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6973 < Similar, but add ASCII value of char under the cursor (like "ga") >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6974 :set statusline=%<%f%h%m%r%=%b\ 0x%B\ \ %l,%c%V\ %P
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6975 < Display byte count and byte value, modified flag in red. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6976 :set statusline=%<%f%=\ [%1*%M%*%n%R%H]\ %-19(%3l,%02c%03V%)%O'%02b'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6977 :hi User1 term=inverse,bold cterm=inverse,bold ctermfg=red
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6978 < Display a ,GZ flag if a compressed file is loaded >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6979 :set statusline=...%r%{VarExists('b:gzflag','\ [GZ]')}%h...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6980 < In the |:autocmd|'s: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6981 :let b:gzflag = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6982 < And: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6983 :unlet b:gzflag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6984 < And define this function: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6985 :function VarExists(var, val)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6986 : if exists(a:var) | return a:val | else | return '' | endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6987 :endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6988 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6989 *'suffixes'* *'su'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6990 'suffixes' 'su' string (default ".bak,~,.o,.h,.info,.swp,.obj")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6991 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6992 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6993 Files with these suffixes get a lower priority when multiple files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6994 match a wildcard. See |suffixes|. Commas can be used to separate the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6995 suffixes. Spaces after the comma are ignored. A dot is also seen as
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
6996 the start of a suffix. To avoid a dot or comma being recognized as a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6997 separator, precede it with a backslash (see |option-backslash| about
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6998 including spaces and backslashes).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6999 See 'wildignore' for completely ignoring files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7000 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7001 suffixes from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7002 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7003
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7004 *'suffixesadd'* *'sua'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7005 'suffixesadd' 'sua' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7006 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7007 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7008 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7009 |+file_in_path| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7010 Comma separated list of suffixes, which are used when searching for a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7011 file for the "gf", "[I", etc. commands. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7012 :set suffixesadd=.java
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7013 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7014 *'swapfile'* *'swf'* *'noswapfile'* *'noswf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7015 'swapfile' 'swf' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7016 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7017 {not in Vi}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7018 Use a swapfile for the buffer. This option can be reset when a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7019 swapfile is not wanted for a specific buffer. For example, with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7020 confidential information that even root must not be able to access.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7021 Careful: All text will be in memory:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7022 - Don't use this for big files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7023 - Recovery will be impossible!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7024 A swapfile will only be present when |'updatecount'| is non-zero and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7025 'swapfile' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7026 When 'swapfile' is reset, the swap file for the current buffer is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7027 immediately deleted. When 'swapfile' is set, and 'updatecount' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7028 non-zero, a swap file is immediately created.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7029 Also see |swap-file| and |'swapsync'|.
5763
c52a655d927d Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5712
diff changeset
7030 If you want to open a new buffer without creating a swap file for it,
c52a655d927d Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5712
diff changeset
7031 use the |:noswapfile| modifier.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7032
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7033 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'buftype' to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7034 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7035
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7036 *'swapsync'* *'sws'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7037 'swapsync' 'sws' string (default "fsync")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7038 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7039 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7040 When this option is not empty a swap file is synced to disk after
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7041 writing to it. This takes some time, especially on busy unix systems.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7042 When this option is empty parts of the swap file may be in memory and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7043 not written to disk. When the system crashes you may lose more work.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7044 On Unix the system does a sync now and then without Vim asking for it,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7045 so the disadvantage of setting this option off is small. On some
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7046 systems the swap file will not be written at all. For a unix system
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7047 setting it to "sync" will use the sync() call instead of the default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7048 fsync(), which may work better on some systems.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
7049 The 'fsync' option is used for the actual file.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7050
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7051 *'switchbuf'* *'swb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7052 'switchbuf' 'swb' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7053 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7054 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7055 This option controls the behavior when switching between buffers.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7056 Possible values (comma separated list):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7057 useopen If included, jump to the first open window that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7058 contains the specified buffer (if there is one).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7059 Otherwise: Do not examine other windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7060 This setting is checked with |quickfix| commands, when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7061 jumping to errors (":cc", ":cn", "cp", etc.). It is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7062 also used in all buffer related split commands, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7063 example ":sbuffer", ":sbnext", or ":sbrewind".
825
6675076019ae updated for version 7.0d
vimboss
parents: 824
diff changeset
7064 usetab Like "useopen", but also consider windows in other tab
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
7065 pages.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7066 split If included, split the current window before loading
3153
37ecb8ff4560 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3082
diff changeset
7067 a buffer for a |quickfix| command that display errors.
37ecb8ff4560 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3082
diff changeset
7068 Otherwise: do not split, use current window.
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
7069 newtab Like "split", but open a new tab page. Overrules
2290
22529abcd646 Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
7070 "split" when both are present.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7071
410
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
7072 *'synmaxcol'* *'smc'*
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
7073 'synmaxcol' 'smc' number (default 3000)
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
7074 local to buffer
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
7075 {not in Vi}
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
7076 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
7077 feature}
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
7078 Maximum column in which to search for syntax items. In long lines the
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
7079 text after this column is not highlighted and following lines may not
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 410
diff changeset
7080 be highlighted correctly, because the syntax state is cleared.
410
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
7081 This helps to avoid very slow redrawing for an XML file that is one
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
7082 long line.
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
7083 Set to zero to remove the limit.
c60ba877860b updated for version 7.0107
vimboss
parents: 401
diff changeset
7084
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7085 *'syntax'* *'syn'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7086 'syntax' 'syn' string (default empty)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7087 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7088 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7089 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7090 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7091 When this option is set, the syntax with this name is loaded, unless
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7092 syntax highlighting has been switched off with ":syntax off".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7093 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current syntax (the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7094 b:current_syntax variable does).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7095 This option is most useful in a modeline, for a file which syntax is
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7096 not automatically recognized. Example, in an IDL file:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7097 /* vim: set syntax=idl : */ ~
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7098 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7099 names. Example:
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7100 /* vim: set syntax=c.doxygen : */ ~
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7101 This will use the "c" syntax first, then the "doxygen" syntax.
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7102 Note that the second one must be prepared to be loaded as an addition,
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7103 otherwise it will be skipped. More than one dot may appear.
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
7104 To switch off syntax highlighting for the current file, use: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7105 :set syntax=OFF
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7106 < To switch syntax highlighting on according to the current value of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7107 'filetype' option: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7108 :set syntax=ON
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7109 < What actually happens when setting the 'syntax' option is that the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7110 Syntax autocommand event is triggered with the value as argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7111 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7112 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
7113 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7114
699
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
7115 *'tabline'* *'tal'*
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
7116 'tabline' 'tal' string (default empty)
674
4b8583e82cb8 updated for version 7.0201
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
7117 global
4b8583e82cb8 updated for version 7.0201
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
7118 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
7119 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
674
4b8583e82cb8 updated for version 7.0201
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
7120 feature}
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
7121 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the tab pages
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
7122 line at the top of the Vim window. When empty Vim will use a default
681
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
7123 tab pages line. See |setting-tabline| for more info.
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
7124
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
7125 The tab pages line only appears as specified with the 'showtabline'
688
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
7126 option and only when there is no GUI tab line. When 'e' is in
bcd2edc4539e updated for version 7.0207
vimboss
parents: 685
diff changeset
7127 'guioptions' and the GUI supports a tab line 'guitablabel' is used
2572
ee53a39d5896 Last changes for the 7.3 release!
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2570
diff changeset
7128 instead. Note that the two tab pages lines are very different.
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
7129
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
7130 The value is evaluated like with 'statusline'. You can use
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
7131 |tabpagenr()|, |tabpagewinnr()| and |tabpagebuflist()| to figure out
681
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
7132 the text to be displayed. Use "%1T" for the first label, "%2T" for
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 680
diff changeset
7133 the second one, etc. Use "%X" items for closing labels.
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
7134
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
7135 Keep in mind that only one of the tab pages is the current one, others
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
7136 are invisible and you can't jump to their windows.
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 674
diff changeset
7137
674
4b8583e82cb8 updated for version 7.0201
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
7138
699
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
7139 *'tabpagemax'* *'tpm'*
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
7140 'tabpagemax' 'tpm' number (default 10)
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
7141 global
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
7142 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
7143 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
699
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
7144 feature}
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
7145 Maximum number of tab pages to be opened by the |-p| command line
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
7146 argument or the ":tab all" command. |tabpage|
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
7147
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
7148
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 697
diff changeset
7149 *'tabstop'* *'ts'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7150 'tabstop' 'ts' number (default 8)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7151 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7152 Number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for. Also see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7153 |:retab| command, and 'softtabstop' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7154
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7155 Note: Setting 'tabstop' to any other value than 8 can make your file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7156 appear wrong in many places (e.g., when printing it).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7157
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7158 There are four main ways to use tabs in Vim:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7159 1. Always keep 'tabstop' at 8, set 'softtabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to 4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7160 (or 3 or whatever you prefer) and use 'noexpandtab'. Then Vim
1263
57361514f73a updated for version 7.1
vimboss
parents: 1213
diff changeset
7161 will use a mix of tabs and spaces, but typing <Tab> and <BS> will
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7162 behave like a tab appears every 4 (or 3) characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7163 2. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7164 'expandtab'. This way you will always insert spaces. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7165 formatting will never be messed up when 'tabstop' is changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7166 3. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use a
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7167 |modeline| to set these values when editing the file again. Only
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7168 works when using Vim to edit the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7169 4. Always set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to the same value, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7170 'noexpandtab'. This should then work (for initial indents only)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7171 for any tabstop setting that people use. It might be nice to have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7172 tabs after the first non-blank inserted as spaces if you do this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7173 though. Otherwise aligned comments will be wrong when 'tabstop' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7174 changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7175
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7176 *'tagbsearch'* *'tbs'* *'notagbsearch'* *'notbs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7177 'tagbsearch' 'tbs' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7178 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7179 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7180 When searching for a tag (e.g., for the |:ta| command), Vim can either
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7181 use a binary search or a linear search in a tags file. Binary
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7182 searching makes searching for a tag a LOT faster, but a linear search
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7183 will find more tags if the tags file wasn't properly sorted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7184 Vim normally assumes that your tags files are sorted, or indicate that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7185 they are not sorted. Only when this is not the case does the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7186 'tagbsearch' option need to be switched off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7187
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7188 When 'tagbsearch' is on, binary searching is first used in the tags
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7189 files. In certain situations, Vim will do a linear search instead for
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7190 certain files, or retry all files with a linear search. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7191 'tagbsearch' is off, only a linear search is done.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7192
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7193 Linear searching is done anyway, for one file, when Vim finds a line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7194 at the start of the file indicating that it's not sorted: >
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
7195 !_TAG_FILE_SORTED 0 /some comment/
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7196 < [The whitespace before and after the '0' must be a single <Tab>]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7197
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7198 When a binary search was done and no match was found in any of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7199 files listed in 'tags', and 'ignorecase' is set or a pattern is used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7200 instead of a normal tag name, a retry is done with a linear search.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7201 Tags in unsorted tags files, and matches with different case will only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7202 be found in the retry.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7203
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 20
diff changeset
7204 If a tag file indicates that it is case-fold sorted, the second,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7205 linear search can be avoided for the 'ignorecase' case. Use a value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7206 of '2' in the "!_TAG_FILE_SORTED" line for this. A tag file can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7207 case-fold sorted with the -f switch to "sort" in most unices, as in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7208 the command: "sort -f -o tags tags". For "Exuberant ctags" version
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
7209 5.x or higher (at least 5.5) the --sort=foldcase switch can be used
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
7210 for this as well. Note that case must be folded to uppercase for this
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
7211 to work.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7212
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7213 When 'tagbsearch' is off, tags searching is slower when a full match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7214 exists, but faster when no full match exists. Tags in unsorted tags
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7215 files may only be found with 'tagbsearch' off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7216 When the tags file is not sorted, or sorted in a wrong way (not on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7217 ASCII byte value), 'tagbsearch' should be off, or the line given above
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7218 must be included in the tags file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7219 This option doesn't affect commands that find all matching tags (e.g.,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7220 command-line completion and ":help").
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7221 {Vi: always uses binary search in some versions}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7222
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7223 *'taglength'* *'tl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7224 'taglength' 'tl' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7225 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7226 If non-zero, tags are significant up to this number of characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7227
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7228 *'tagrelative'* *'tr'* *'notagrelative'* *'notr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7229 'tagrelative' 'tr' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7230 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7231 {not in Vi}
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 819
diff changeset
7232 If on and using a tags file in another directory, file names in that
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 819
diff changeset
7233 tags file are relative to the directory where the tags file is.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7234 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7235 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7236
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7237 *'tags'* *'tag'* *E433*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7238 'tags' 'tag' string (default "./tags,tags", when compiled with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7239 |+emacs_tags|: "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7240 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7241 Filenames for the tag command, separated by spaces or commas. To
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7242 include a space or comma in a file name, precede it with a backslash
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7243 (see |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7244 When a file name starts with "./", the '.' is replaced with the path
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7245 of the current file. But only when the 'd' flag is not included in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7246 'cpoptions'. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. Also see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7247 |tags-option|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7248 "*", "**" and other wildcards can be used to search for tags files in
2522
d7ecfc8b784c Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2492
diff changeset
7249 a directory tree. See |file-searching|. E.g., "/lib/**/tags" will
d7ecfc8b784c Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2492
diff changeset
7250 find all files named "tags" below "/lib". The filename itself cannot
d7ecfc8b784c Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2492
diff changeset
7251 contain wildcards, it is used as-is. E.g., "/lib/**/tags?" will find
d7ecfc8b784c Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2492
diff changeset
7252 files called "tags?". {not available when compiled without the
d7ecfc8b784c Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2492
diff changeset
7253 |+path_extra| feature}
515
04dcb5a1f2f9 updated for version 7.0144
vimboss
parents: 502
diff changeset
7254 The |tagfiles()| function can be used to get a list of the file names
04dcb5a1f2f9 updated for version 7.0144
vimboss
parents: 502
diff changeset
7255 actually used.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7256 If Vim was compiled with the |+emacs_tags| feature, Emacs-style tag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7257 files are also supported. They are automatically recognized. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7258 default value becomes "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS", unless case
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7259 differences are ignored (MS-Windows). |emacs-tags|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7260 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7261 file names from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7262 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7263 {Vi: default is "tags /usr/lib/tags"}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7264
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7265 *'tagstack'* *'tgst'* *'notagstack'* *'notgst'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7266 'tagstack' 'tgst' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7267 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7268 {not in all versions of Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7269 When on, the |tagstack| is used normally. When off, a ":tag" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7270 ":tselect" command with an argument will not push the tag onto the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7271 tagstack. A following ":tag" without an argument, a ":pop" command or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7272 any other command that uses the tagstack will use the unmodified
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7273 tagstack, but does change the pointer to the active entry.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7274 Resetting this option is useful when using a ":tag" command in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7275 mapping which should not change the tagstack.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7276
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7277 *'term'* *E529* *E530* *E531*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7278 'term' string (default is $TERM, if that fails:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7279 in the GUI: "builtin_gui"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7280 on Amiga: "amiga"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7281 on BeOS: "beos-ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7282 on Mac: "mac-ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7283 on MiNT: "vt52"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7284 on MS-DOS: "pcterm"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7285 on OS/2: "os2ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7286 on Unix: "ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7287 on VMS: "ansi"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7288 on Win 32: "win32")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7289 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7290 Name of the terminal. Used for choosing the terminal control
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7291 characters. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7292 For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7293 :set term=$TERM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7294 < See |termcap|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7295
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7296 *'termbidi'* *'tbidi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7297 *'notermbidi'* *'notbidi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7298 'termbidi' 'tbidi' boolean (default off, on for "mlterm")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7299 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7300 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7301 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7302 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7303 The terminal is in charge of Bi-directionality of text (as specified
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7304 by Unicode). The terminal is also expected to do the required shaping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7305 that some languages (such as Arabic) require.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7306 Setting this option implies that 'rightleft' will not be set when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7307 'arabic' is set and the value of 'arabicshape' will be ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7308 Note that setting 'termbidi' has the immediate effect that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7309 'arabicshape' is ignored, but 'rightleft' isn't changed automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7310 This option is reset when the GUI is started.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7311 For further details see |arabic.txt|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7312
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7313 *'termencoding'* *'tenc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7314 'termencoding' 'tenc' string (default ""; with GTK+ 2 GUI: "utf-8"; with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7315 Macintosh GUI: "macroman")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7316 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7317 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7318 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7319 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7320 Encoding used for the terminal. This specifies what character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7321 encoding the keyboard produces and the display will understand. For
4186
7ffc704cb7c1 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4159
diff changeset
7322 the GUI it only applies to the keyboard ( 'encoding' is used for the
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
7323 display). Except for the Mac when 'macatsui' is off, then
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
7324 'termencoding' should be "macroman".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7325 In the Win32 console version the default value is the console codepage
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7326 when it differs from the ANSI codepage.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7327 *E617*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7328 Note: This does not apply to the GTK+ 2 GUI. After the GUI has been
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7329 successfully initialized, 'termencoding' is forcibly set to "utf-8".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7330 Any attempts to set a different value will be rejected, and an error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7331 message is shown.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7332 For the Win32 GUI 'termencoding' is not used for typed characters,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7333 because the Win32 system always passes Unicode characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7334 When empty, the same encoding is used as for the 'encoding' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7335 This is the normal value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7336 Not all combinations for 'termencoding' and 'encoding' are valid. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7337 |encoding-table|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7338 The value for this option must be supported by internal conversions or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7339 iconv(). When this is not possible no conversion will be done and you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7340 will probably experience problems with non-ASCII characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7341 Example: You are working with the locale set to euc-jp (Japanese) and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7342 want to edit a UTF-8 file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7343 :let &termencoding = &encoding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7344 :set encoding=utf-8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7345 < You need to do this when your system has no locale support for UTF-8.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7346
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7347 *'terse'* *'noterse'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7348 'terse' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7349 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7350 When set: Add 's' flag to 'shortmess' option (this makes the message
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7351 for a search that hits the start or end of the file not being
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7352 displayed). When reset: Remove 's' flag from 'shortmess' option. {Vi
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7353 shortens a lot of messages}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7354
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7355 *'textauto'* *'ta'* *'notextauto'* *'nota'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7356 'textauto' 'ta' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7357 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7358 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7359 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformats'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7360 For backwards compatibility, when 'textauto' is set, 'fileformats' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7361 set to the default value for the current system. When 'textauto' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7362 reset, 'fileformats' is made empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7363 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7364 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7365
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7366 *'textmode'* *'tx'* *'notextmode'* *'notx'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7367 'textmode' 'tx' boolean (MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2: default on,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7368 others: default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7369 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7370 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7371 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformat'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7372 For backwards compatibility, when 'textmode' is set, 'fileformat' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7373 set to "dos". When 'textmode' is reset, 'fileformat' is set to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7374 "unix".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7375
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7376 *'textwidth'* *'tw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7377 'textwidth' 'tw' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7378 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7379 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7380 Maximum width of text that is being inserted. A longer line will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7381 broken after white space to get this width. A zero value disables
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7382 this. 'textwidth' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set. When
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7383 'textwidth' is zero, 'wrapmargin' may be used. See also
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7384 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|.
838
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 836
diff changeset
7385 When 'formatexpr' is set it will be used to break the line.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7386 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7387
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7388 *'thesaurus'* *'tsr'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7389 'thesaurus' 'tsr' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7390 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7391 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7392 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7393 for thesaurus completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|. Each line in
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7394 the file should contain words with similar meaning, separated by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7395 non-keyword characters (white space is preferred). Maximum line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7396 length is 510 bytes.
3496
d1e4abe8342c Fixed compatible mode in most runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3493
diff changeset
7397 To obtain a file to be used here, check out this ftp site:
d1e4abe8342c Fixed compatible mode in most runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3493
diff changeset
7398 ftp://ftp.ox.ac.uk/pub/wordlists/ First get the README file.
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7399 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7400 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7401 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7402 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7403 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7404 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7405 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7406
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7407 *'tildeop'* *'top'* *'notildeop'* *'notop'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7408 'tildeop' 'top' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7409 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7410 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7411 When on: The tilde command "~" behaves like an operator.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7412 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7413
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7414 *'timeout'* *'to'* *'notimeout'* *'noto'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7415 'timeout' 'to' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7416 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7417 *'ttimeout'* *'nottimeout'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7418 'ttimeout' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7419 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7420 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7421 These two options together determine the behavior when part of a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7422 mapped key sequence or keyboard code has been received:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7423
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7424 'timeout' 'ttimeout' action ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7425 off off do not time out
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7426 on on or off time out on :mappings and key codes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7427 off on time out on key codes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7428
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7429 If both options are off, Vim will wait until either the complete
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7430 mapping or key sequence has been received, or it is clear that there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7431 is no mapping or key sequence for the received characters. For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7432 example: if you have mapped "vl" and Vim has received 'v', the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7433 character is needed to see if the 'v' is followed by an 'l'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7434 When one of the options is on, Vim will wait for about 1 second for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7435 the next character to arrive. After that the already received
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7436 characters are interpreted as single characters. The waiting time can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7437 be changed with the 'timeoutlen' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7438 On slow terminals or very busy systems timing out may cause
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7439 malfunctioning cursor keys. If both options are off, Vim waits
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7440 forever after an entered <Esc> if there are key codes that start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7441 with <Esc>. You will have to type <Esc> twice. If you do not have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7442 problems with key codes, but would like to have :mapped key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7443 sequences not timing out in 1 second, set the 'ttimeout' option and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7444 reset the 'timeout' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7445
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7446 NOTE: 'ttimeout' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7447
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7448 *'timeoutlen'* *'tm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7449 'timeoutlen' 'tm' number (default 1000)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7450 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7451 {not in all versions of Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7452 *'ttimeoutlen'* *'ttm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7453 'ttimeoutlen' 'ttm' number (default -1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7454 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7455 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7456 The time in milliseconds that is waited for a key code or mapped key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7457 sequence to complete. Also used for CTRL-\ CTRL-N and CTRL-\ CTRL-G
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7458 when part of a command has been typed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7459 Normally only 'timeoutlen' is used and 'ttimeoutlen' is -1. When a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7460 different timeout value for key codes is desired set 'ttimeoutlen' to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7461 a non-negative number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7462
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7463 ttimeoutlen mapping delay key code delay ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7464 < 0 'timeoutlen' 'timeoutlen'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7465 >= 0 'timeoutlen' 'ttimeoutlen'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7466
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7467 The timeout only happens when the 'timeout' and 'ttimeout' options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7468 tell so. A useful setting would be >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7469 :set timeout timeoutlen=3000 ttimeoutlen=100
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7470 < (time out on mapping after three seconds, time out on key codes after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7471 a tenth of a second).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7472
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7473 *'title'* *'notitle'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7474 'title' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7475 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7476 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7477 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7478 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7479 When on, the title of the window will be set to the value of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7480 'titlestring' (if it is not empty), or to:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7481 filename [+=-] (path) - VIM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7482 Where:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7483 filename the name of the file being edited
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7484 - indicates the file cannot be modified, 'ma' off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7485 + indicates the file was modified
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7486 = indicates the file is read-only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7487 =+ indicates the file is read-only and modified
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7488 (path) is the path of the file being edited
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7489 - VIM the server name |v:servername| or "VIM"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7490 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7491 (currently Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7492 terminals with a non- empty 't_ts' option - these are Unix xterm and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7493 iris-ansi by default, where 't_ts' is taken from the builtin termcap).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7494 *X11*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7495 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7496 be restored if possible. The output of ":version" will include "+X11"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7497 when HAVE_X11 was defined, otherwise it will be "-X11". This also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7498 works for the icon name |'icon'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7499 But: When Vim was started with the |-X| argument, restoring the title
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7500 will not work (except in the GUI).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7501 If the title cannot be restored, it is set to the value of 'titleold'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7502 You might want to restore the title outside of Vim then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7503 When using an xterm from a remote machine you can use this command:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7504 rsh machine_name xterm -display $DISPLAY &
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7505 then the WINDOWID environment variable should be inherited and the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7506 title of the window should change back to what it should be after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7507 exiting Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7508
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7509 *'titlelen'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7510 'titlelen' number (default 85)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7511 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7512 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7513 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7514 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7515 Gives the percentage of 'columns' to use for the length of the window
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7516 title. When the title is longer, only the end of the path name is
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7517 shown. A '<' character before the path name is used to indicate this.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7518 Using a percentage makes this adapt to the width of the window. But
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7519 it won't work perfectly, because the actual number of characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7520 available also depends on the font used and other things in the title
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7521 bar. When 'titlelen' is zero the full path is used. Otherwise,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7522 values from 1 to 30000 percent can be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7523 'titlelen' is also used for the 'titlestring' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7524
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7525 *'titleold'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7526 'titleold' string (default "Thanks for flying Vim")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7527 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7528 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7529 {only available when compiled with the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7530 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7531 This option will be used for the window title when exiting Vim if the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7532 original title cannot be restored. Only happens if 'title' is on or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7533 'titlestring' is not empty.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
7534 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
7535 security reasons.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7536 *'titlestring'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7537 'titlestring' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7538 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7539 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7540 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7541 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7542 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the title of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7543 window. This happens only when the 'title' option is on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7544 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles (currently
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7545 Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and terminals with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7546 non-empty 't_ts' option).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7547 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7548 be restored if possible |X11|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7549 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7550 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7551 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7552 :auto BufEnter * let &titlestring = hostname() . "/" . expand("%:p")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7553 :set title titlestring=%<%F%=%l/%L-%P titlelen=70
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7554 < The value of 'titlelen' is used to align items in the middle or right
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7555 of the available space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7556 Some people prefer to have the file name first: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7557 :set titlestring=%t%(\ %M%)%(\ (%{expand(\"%:~:.:h\")})%)%(\ %a%)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7558 < Note the use of "%{ }" and an expression to get the path of the file,
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7559 without the file name. The "%( %)" constructs are used to add a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7560 separating space only when needed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7561 NOTE: Use of special characters in 'titlestring' may cause the display
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7562 to be garbled (e.g., when it contains a CR or NL character).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7563 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7564
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7565 *'toolbar'* *'tb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7566 'toolbar' 'tb' string (default "icons,tooltips")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7567 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7568 {only for |+GUI_GTK|, |+GUI_Athena|, |+GUI_Motif| and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7569 |+GUI_Photon|}
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7570 The contents of this option controls various toolbar settings. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7571 possible values are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7572 icons Toolbar buttons are shown with icons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7573 text Toolbar buttons shown with text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7574 horiz Icon and text of a toolbar button are
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7575 horizontally arranged. {only in GTK+ 2 GUI}
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7576 tooltips Tooltips are active for toolbar buttons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7577 Tooltips refer to the popup help text which appears after the mouse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7578 cursor is placed over a toolbar button for a brief moment.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7579
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7580 If you want the toolbar to be shown with icons as well as text, do the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7581 following: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7582 :set tb=icons,text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7583 < Motif and Athena cannot display icons and text at the same time. They
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7584 will show icons if both are requested.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7585
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7586 If none of the strings specified in 'toolbar' are valid or if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7587 'toolbar' is empty, this option is ignored. If you want to disable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7588 the toolbar, you need to set the 'guioptions' option. For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7589 :set guioptions-=T
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7590 < Also see |gui-toolbar|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7591
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7592 *'toolbariconsize'* *'tbis'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7593 'toolbariconsize' 'tbis' string (default "small")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7594 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7595 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7596 {only in the GTK+ 2 GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7597 Controls the size of toolbar icons. The possible values are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7598 tiny Use tiny toolbar icons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7599 small Use small toolbar icons (default).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7600 medium Use medium-sized toolbar icons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7601 large Use large toolbar icons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7602 The exact dimensions in pixels of the various icon sizes depend on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7603 the current theme. Common dimensions are large=32x32, medium=24x24,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7604 small=20x20 and tiny=16x16.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7605
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7606 If 'toolbariconsize' is empty, the global default size as determined
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7607 by user preferences or the current theme is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7608
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7609 *'ttybuiltin'* *'tbi'* *'nottybuiltin'* *'notbi'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7610 'ttybuiltin' 'tbi' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7611 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7612 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7613 When on, the builtin termcaps are searched before the external ones.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7614 When off the builtin termcaps are searched after the external ones.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7615 When this option is changed, you should set the 'term' option next for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7616 the change to take effect, for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7617 :set notbi term=$TERM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7618 < See also |termcap|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7619 Rationale: The default for this option is "on", because the builtin
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7620 termcap entries are generally better (many systems contain faulty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7621 xterm entries...).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7622
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7623 *'ttyfast'* *'tf'* *'nottyfast'* *'notf'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7624 'ttyfast' 'tf' boolean (default off, on when 'term' is xterm, hpterm,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7625 sun-cmd, screen, rxvt, dtterm or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7626 iris-ansi; also on when running Vim in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7627 a DOS console)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7628 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7629 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7630 Indicates a fast terminal connection. More characters will be sent to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7631 the screen for redrawing, instead of using insert/delete line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7632 commands. Improves smoothness of redrawing when there are multiple
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7633 windows and the terminal does not support a scrolling region.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7634 Also enables the extra writing of characters at the end of each screen
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7635 line for lines that wrap. This helps when using copy/paste with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7636 mouse in an xterm and other terminals.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7637
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7638 *'ttymouse'* *'ttym'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7639 'ttymouse' 'ttym' string (default depends on 'term')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7640 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7641 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7642 {only in Unix and VMS, doesn't work in the GUI; not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7643 available when compiled without |+mouse|}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7644 Name of the terminal type for which mouse codes are to be recognized.
1213
8906c10ecbb0 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1152
diff changeset
7645 Currently these strings are valid:
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7646 *xterm-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7647 xterm xterm-like mouse handling. The mouse generates
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7648 "<Esc>[Mscr", where "scr" is three bytes:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7649 "s" = button state
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7650 "c" = column plus 33
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7651 "r" = row plus 33
5908
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7652 This only works up to 223 columns! See "dec",
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7653 "urxvt", and "sgr" for solutions.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7654 xterm2 Works like "xterm", but with the xterm reporting the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7655 mouse position while the mouse is dragged. This works
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7656 much faster and more precise. Your xterm must at
180
7e70fc748752 updated for version 7.0056
vimboss
parents: 179
diff changeset
7657 least at patchlevel 88 / XFree 3.3.3 for this to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7658 work. See below for how Vim detects this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7659 automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7660 *netterm-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7661 netterm NetTerm mouse handling. The mouse generates
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7662 "<Esc>}r,c<CR>", where "r,c" are two decimal numbers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7663 for the row and column.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7664 *dec-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7665 dec DEC terminal mouse handling. The mouse generates a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7666 rather complex sequence, starting with "<Esc>[".
189
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
7667 This is also available for an Xterm, if it was
504c627f7474 updated for version 7.0057
vimboss
parents: 180
diff changeset
7668 configured with "--enable-dec-locator".
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7669 *jsbterm-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7670 jsbterm JSB term mouse handling.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7671 *pterm-mouse*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7672 pterm QNX pterm mouse handling.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7673 *urxvt-mouse*
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7674 urxvt Mouse handling for the urxvt (rxvt-unicode) terminal.
5908
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7675 The mouse works only if the terminal supports this
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7676 encoding style, but it does not have 223 columns limit
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7677 unlike "xterm" or "xterm2".
3750
536aa8b0c934 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3746
diff changeset
7678 *sgr-mouse*
536aa8b0c934 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3746
diff changeset
7679 sgr Mouse handling for the terminal that emits SGR-styled
5908
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7680 mouse reporting. The mouse works even in columns
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7681 beyond 223. This option is backward compatible with
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7682 "xterm2" because it can also decode "xterm2" style
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7683 mouse codes.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7684
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7685 The mouse handling must be enabled at compile time |+mouse_xterm|
5908
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7686 |+mouse_dec| |+mouse_netterm| |+mouse_jsbterm| |+mouse_urxvt|
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7687 |+mouse_sgr|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7688 Only "xterm"(2) is really recognized. NetTerm mouse codes are always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7689 recognized, if enabled at compile time. DEC terminal mouse codes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7690 are recognized if enabled at compile time, and 'ttymouse' is not
5908
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7691 "xterm", "xterm2", "urxvt" or "sgr" (because dec mouse codes conflict
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7692 with them).
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7693 This option is automatically set to "xterm", when the 'term' option is
5908
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7694 set to a name that starts with "xterm", "mlterm", or "screen", and
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7695 'ttymouse' is not set already.
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7696 Additionally, if vim is compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7697 |t_RV| is set to the escape sequence to request the xterm version
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7698 number, more intelligent detection process runs.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7699 The "xterm2" value will be set if the xterm version is reported to be
5908
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7700 from 95 to 276. The "sgr" value will be set if the xterm version is
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7701 277 or highter.
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7702 If you do not want 'ttymouse' to be set to "xterm2" or "sgr"
32de51778c27 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5862
diff changeset
7703 automatically, set t_RV to an empty string: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7704 :set t_RV=
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7705 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7706 *'ttyscroll'* *'tsl'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7707 'ttyscroll' 'tsl' number (default 999)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7708 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7709 Maximum number of lines to scroll the screen. If there are more lines
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7710 to scroll the window is redrawn. For terminals where scrolling is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7711 very slow and redrawing is not slow this can be set to a small number,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7712 e.g., 3, to speed up displaying.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7713
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7714 *'ttytype'* *'tty'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7715 'ttytype' 'tty' string (default from $TERM)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7716 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7717 Alias for 'term', see above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7718
2214
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7719 *'undodir'* *'udir'*
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7720 'undodir' 'udir' string (default ".")
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7721 global
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7722 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
7723 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature}
2214
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7724 List of directory names for undo files, separated with commas.
2220
b1c70c500de4 Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2218
diff changeset
7725 See |'backupdir'| for details of the format.
2218
695ceebf17ca Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2214
diff changeset
7726 "." means using the directory of the file. The undo file name for
695ceebf17ca Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2214
diff changeset
7727 "file.txt" is ".file.txt.un~".
695ceebf17ca Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2214
diff changeset
7728 For other directories the file name is the full path of the edited
695ceebf17ca Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2214
diff changeset
7729 file, with path separators replaced with "%".
2214
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7730 When writing: The first directory that exists is used. "." always
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7731 works, no directories after "." will be used for writing.
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7732 When reading all entries are tried to find an undo file. The first
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7733 undo file that exists is used. When it cannot be read an error is
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7734 given, no further entry is used.
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7735 See |undo-persistence|.
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7736
4681
2eb30f341e8d Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4502
diff changeset
7737 *'undofile'* *'noundofile'* *'udf'* *'noudf'*
2214
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7738 'undofile' 'udf' boolean (default off)
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7739 local to buffer
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7740 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
7741 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature}
2214
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7742 When on, Vim automatically saves undo history to an undo file when
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7743 writing a buffer to a file, and restores undo history from the same
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7744 file on buffer read.
2220
b1c70c500de4 Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2218
diff changeset
7745 The directory where the undo file is stored is specified by 'undodir'.
b1c70c500de4 Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2218
diff changeset
7746 For more information about this feature see |undo-persistence|.
2394
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7747 The undo file is not read when 'undoreload' causes the buffer from
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7748 before a reload to be saved for undo.
3920
c53344bacabf Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3893
diff changeset
7749 When 'undofile' is turned off the undo file is NOT deleted.
2214
f8222d1f9a73 Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2209
diff changeset
7750
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7751 *'undolevels'* *'ul'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7752 'undolevels' 'ul' number (default 100, 1000 for Unix, VMS,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7753 Win32 and OS/2)
5446
d0595545e98a updated for version 7.4.073
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5340
diff changeset
7754 global or local to buffer |global-local|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7755 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7756 Maximum number of changes that can be undone. Since undo information
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7757 is kept in memory, higher numbers will cause more memory to be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7758 (nevertheless, a single change can use an unlimited amount of memory).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7759 Set to 0 for Vi compatibility: One level of undo and "u" undoes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7760 itself: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7761 set ul=0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7762 < But you can also get Vi compatibility by including the 'u' flag in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7763 'cpoptions', and still be able to use CTRL-R to repeat undo.
2249
6d3d35ff2c2b Use full path in undofile(). Updated docs.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2240
diff changeset
7764 Also see |undo-two-ways|.
5446
d0595545e98a updated for version 7.4.073
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5340
diff changeset
7765 Set to -1 for no undo at all. You might want to do this only for the
d0595545e98a updated for version 7.4.073
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5340
diff changeset
7766 current buffer: >
d0595545e98a updated for version 7.4.073
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5340
diff changeset
7767 setlocal ul=-1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7768 < This helps when you run out of memory for a single change.
6336
4abac79c0b7a Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6328
diff changeset
7769
4abac79c0b7a Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6328
diff changeset
7770 The local value is set to -123456 when the global value is to be used.
4abac79c0b7a Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6328
diff changeset
7771
2249
6d3d35ff2c2b Use full path in undofile(). Updated docs.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2240
diff changeset
7772 Also see |clear-undo|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7773
2394
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7774 *'undoreload'* *'ur'*
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7775 'undoreload' 'ur' number (default 10000)
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7776 global
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7777 {not in Vi}
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7778 Save the whole buffer for undo when reloading it. This applies to the
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7779 ":e!" command and reloading for when the buffer changed outside of
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7780 Vim. |FileChangedShell|
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7781 The save only happens when this options is negative or when the number
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7782 of lines is smaller than the value of this option.
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7783 Set this option to zero to disable undo for a reload.
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7784
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7785 When saving undo for a reload, any undo file is not read.
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7786
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7787 Note that this causes the whole buffer to be stored in memory. Set
a3aca345aafa Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2382
diff changeset
7788 this option to a lower value if you run out of memory.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7789
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7790 *'updatecount'* *'uc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7791 'updatecount' 'uc' number (default: 200)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7792 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7793 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7794 After typing this many characters the swap file will be written to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7795 disk. When zero, no swap file will be created at all (see chapter on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7796 recovery |crash-recovery|). 'updatecount' is set to zero by starting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7797 Vim with the "-n" option, see |startup|. When editing in readonly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7798 mode this option will be initialized to 10000.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7799 The swapfile can be disabled per buffer with |'swapfile'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7800 When 'updatecount' is set from zero to non-zero, swap files are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7801 created for all buffers that have 'swapfile' set. When 'updatecount'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7802 is set to zero, existing swap files are not deleted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7803 Also see |'swapsync'|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7804 This option has no meaning in buffers where |'buftype'| is "nofile"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7805 or "nowrite".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7806
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7807 *'updatetime'* *'ut'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7808 'updatetime' 'ut' number (default 4000)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7809 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7810 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7811 If this many milliseconds nothing is typed the swap file will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7812 written to disk (see |crash-recovery|). Also used for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7813 |CursorHold| autocommand event.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7814
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7815 *'verbose'* *'vbs'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7816 'verbose' 'vbs' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7817 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7818 {not in Vi, although some versions have a boolean
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7819 verbose option}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7820 When bigger than zero, Vim will give messages about what it is doing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7821 Currently, these messages are given:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7822 >= 1 When the viminfo file is read or written.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7823 >= 2 When a file is ":source"'ed.
712
2e887dfa8917 updated for version 7.0214
vimboss
parents: 707
diff changeset
7824 >= 5 Every searched tags file and include file.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7825 >= 8 Files for which a group of autocommands is executed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7826 >= 9 Every executed autocommand.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7827 >= 12 Every executed function.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7828 >= 13 When an exception is thrown, caught, finished, or discarded.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7829 >= 14 Anything pending in a ":finally" clause.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7830 >= 15 Every executed Ex command (truncated at 200 characters).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7831
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7832 This option can also be set with the "-V" argument. See |-V|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7833 This option is also set by the |:verbose| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7834
293
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7835 When the 'verbosefile' option is set then the verbose messages are not
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7836 displayed.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7837
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7838 *'verbosefile'* *'vfile'*
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7839 'verbosefile' 'vfile' string (default empty)
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7840 global
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7841 {not in Vi}
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7842 When not empty all messages are written in a file with this name.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7843 When the file exists messages are appended.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7844 Writing to the file ends when Vim exits or when 'verbosefile' is made
2265
b7cb69ab616d Added salt to blowfish encryption.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
7845 empty. Writes are buffered, thus may not show up for some time.
293
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7846 Setting 'verbosefile' to a new value is like making it empty first.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7847 The difference with |:redir| is that verbose messages are not
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7848 displayed when 'verbosefile' is set.
f811be6fa9b5 updated for version 7.0077
vimboss
parents: 236
diff changeset
7849
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7850 *'viewdir'* *'vdir'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7851 'viewdir' 'vdir' string (default for Amiga, MS-DOS, OS/2 and Win32:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7852 "$VIM/vimfiles/view",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7853 for Unix: "~/.vim/view",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7854 for Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles:view"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7855 for VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles/view"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7856 for RiscOS: "Choices:vimfiles/view")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7857 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7858 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
7859 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7860 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7861 Name of the directory where to store files for |:mkview|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7862 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7863 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7864
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7865 *'viewoptions'* *'vop'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7866 'viewoptions' 'vop' string (default: "folds,options,cursor")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7867 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7868 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
7869 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7870 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7871 Changes the effect of the |:mkview| command. It is a comma separated
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7872 list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring something:
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7873 word save and restore ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7874 cursor cursor position in file and in window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7875 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7876 fold options
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7877 options options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7878 global values for local options)
6213
37c24033b260 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 6153
diff changeset
7879 localoptions same as "options"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7880 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7881 slashes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7882 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7883 on Windows or DOS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7884
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7885 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing view files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7886 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7887 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7888
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7889 *'viminfo'* *'vi'* *E526* *E527* *E528*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7890 'viminfo' 'vi' string (Vi default: "", Vim default for MS-DOS,
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
7891 Windows and OS/2: '100,<50,s10,h,rA:,rB:,
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
7892 for Amiga: '100,<50,s10,h,rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
7893 for others: '100,<50,s10,h)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7894 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7895 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
7896 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7897 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7898 When non-empty, the viminfo file is read upon startup and written
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7899 when exiting Vim (see |viminfo-file|). The string should be a comma
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7900 separated list of parameters, each consisting of a single character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7901 identifying the particular parameter, followed by a number or string
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7902 which specifies the value of that parameter. If a particular
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7903 character is left out, then the default value is used for that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7904 parameter. The following is a list of the identifying characters and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7905 the effect of their value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7906 CHAR VALUE ~
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7907 *viminfo-!*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7908 ! When included, save and restore global variables that start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7909 with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7910 letter. Thus "KEEPTHIS and "K_L_M" are stored, but "KeepThis"
2607
2f57d93bdbf6 updated for version 7.3.030
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2587
diff changeset
7911 and "_K_L_M" are not. Nested List and Dict items may not be
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2625
diff changeset
7912 read back correctly, you end up with an empty item.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7913 *viminfo-quote*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7914 " Maximum number of lines saved for each register. Old name of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7915 the '<' item, with the disadvantage that you need to put a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7916 backslash before the ", otherwise it will be recognized as the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7917 start of a comment!
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7918 *viminfo-%*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7919 % When included, save and restore the buffer list. If Vim is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7920 started with a file name argument, the buffer list is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7921 restored. If Vim is started without a file name argument, the
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7922 buffer list is restored from the viminfo file. Buffers
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7923 without a file name and buffers for help files are not written
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7924 to the viminfo file.
23
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
7925 When followed by a number, the number specifies the maximum
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
7926 number of buffers that are stored. Without a number all
3f44e9abe4ec updated for version 7.0015
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
7927 buffers are stored.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7928 *viminfo-'*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7929 ' Maximum number of previously edited files for which the marks
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7930 are remembered. This parameter must always be included when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7931 'viminfo' is non-empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7932 Including this item also means that the |jumplist| and the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7933 |changelist| are stored in the viminfo file.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7934 *viminfo-/*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7935 / Maximum number of items in the search pattern history to be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7936 saved. If non-zero, then the previous search and substitute
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7937 patterns are also saved. When not included, the value of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7938 'history' is used.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7939 *viminfo-:*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7940 : Maximum number of items in the command-line history to be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7941 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7942 *viminfo-<*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7943 < Maximum number of lines saved for each register. If zero then
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7944 registers are not saved. When not included, all lines are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7945 saved. '"' is the old name for this item.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7946 Also see the 's' item below: limit specified in Kbyte.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7947 *viminfo-@*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7948 @ Maximum number of items in the input-line history to be
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7949 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7950 *viminfo-c*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7951 c When included, convert the text in the viminfo file from the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7952 'encoding' used when writing the file to the current
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
7953 'encoding'. See |viminfo-encoding|.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7954 *viminfo-f*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7955 f Whether file marks need to be stored. If zero, file marks ('0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7956 to '9, 'A to 'Z) are not stored. When not present or when
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
7957 non-zero, they are all stored. '0 is used for the current
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7958 cursor position (when exiting or when doing ":wviminfo").
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7959 *viminfo-h*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7960 h Disable the effect of 'hlsearch' when loading the viminfo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7961 file. When not included, it depends on whether ":nohlsearch"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7962 has been used since the last search command.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7963 *viminfo-n*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7964 n Name of the viminfo file. The name must immediately follow
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7965 the 'n'. Must be the last one! If the "-i" argument was
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7966 given when starting Vim, that file name overrides the one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7967 given here with 'viminfo'. Environment variables are expanded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7968 when opening the file, not when setting the option.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7969 *viminfo-r*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7970 r Removable media. The argument is a string (up to the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7971 ','). This parameter can be given several times. Each
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7972 specifies the start of a path for which no marks will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7973 stored. This is to avoid removable media. For MS-DOS you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7974 could use "ra:,rb:", for Amiga "rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:". You can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7975 also use it for temp files, e.g., for Unix: "r/tmp". Case is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7976 ignored. Maximum length of each 'r' argument is 50
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7977 characters.
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
7978 *viminfo-s*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7979 s Maximum size of an item in Kbyte. If zero then registers are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7980 not saved. Currently only applies to registers. The default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7981 "s10" will exclude registers with more than 10 Kbyte of text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7982 Also see the '<' item above: line count limit.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7983
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7984 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7985 :set viminfo='50,<1000,s100,:0,n~/vim/viminfo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7986 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7987 '50 Marks will be remembered for the last 50 files you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7988 edited.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7989 <1000 Contents of registers (up to 1000 lines each) will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7990 remembered.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7991 s100 Registers with more than 100 Kbyte text are skipped.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7992 :0 Command-line history will not be saved.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7993 n~/vim/viminfo The name of the file to use is "~/vim/viminfo".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7994 no / Since '/' is not specified, the default will be used,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7995 that is, save all of the search history, and also the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7996 previous search and substitute patterns.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7997 no % The buffer list will not be saved nor read back.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7998 no h 'hlsearch' highlighting will be restored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7999
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8000 When setting 'viminfo' from an empty value you can use |:rviminfo| to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8001 load the contents of the file, this is not done automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8002
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8003 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8004 security reasons.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8005
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8006 *'virtualedit'* *'ve'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8007 'virtualedit' 've' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8008 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8009 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8010 {not available when compiled without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8011 |+virtualedit| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8012 A comma separated list of these words:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8013 block Allow virtual editing in Visual block mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8014 insert Allow virtual editing in Insert mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8015 all Allow virtual editing in all modes.
772
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
8016 onemore Allow the cursor to move just past the end of the line
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8017
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8018 Virtual editing means that the cursor can be positioned where there is
1263
57361514f73a updated for version 7.1
vimboss
parents: 1213
diff changeset
8019 no actual character. This can be halfway into a tab or beyond the end
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8020 of the line. Useful for selecting a rectangle in Visual mode and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8021 editing a table.
772
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
8022 "onemore" is not the same, it will only allow moving the cursor just
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
8023 after the last character of the line. This makes some commands more
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
8024 consistent. Previously the cursor was always past the end of the line
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
8025 if the line was empty. But it is far from Vi compatible. It may also
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8026 break some plugins or Vim scripts. For example because |l| can move
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8027 the cursor after the last character. Use with care!
5220
050893d44c33 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5161
diff changeset
8028 Using the `$` command will move to the last character in the line, not
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8029 past it. This may actually move the cursor to the left!
5220
050893d44c33 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5161
diff changeset
8030 The `g$` command will move to the end of the screen line.
772
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
8031 It doesn't make sense to combine "all" with "onemore", but you will
aaaca5077255 updated for version 7.0226
vimboss
parents: 766
diff changeset
8032 not get a warning for it.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8033
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8034 *'visualbell'* *'vb'* *'novisualbell'* *'novb'* *beep*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8035 'visualbell' 'vb' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8036 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8037 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8038 Use visual bell instead of beeping. The terminal code to display the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8039 visual bell is given with 't_vb'. When no beep or flash is wanted,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8040 use ":set vb t_vb=".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8041 Note: When the GUI starts, 't_vb' is reset to its default value. You
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8042 might want to set it again in your |gvimrc|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8043 In the GUI, 't_vb' defaults to "<Esc>|f", which inverts the display
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8044 for 20 msec. If you want to use a different time, use "<Esc>|40f",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8045 where 40 is the time in msec.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8046 Does not work on the Amiga, you always get a screen flash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8047 Also see 'errorbells'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8048
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8049 *'warn'* *'nowarn'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8050 'warn' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8051 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8052 Give a warning message when a shell command is used while the buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8053 has been changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8054
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8055 *'weirdinvert'* *'wiv'* *'noweirdinvert'* *'nowiv'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8056 'weirdinvert' 'wiv' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8057 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8058 {not in Vi}
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 665
diff changeset
8059 This option has the same effect as the 't_xs' terminal option.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8060 It is provided for backwards compatibility with version 4.x.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8061 Setting 'weirdinvert' has the effect of making 't_xs' non-empty, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8062 vice versa. Has no effect when the GUI is running.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8063
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8064 *'whichwrap'* *'ww'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8065 'whichwrap' 'ww' string (Vim default: "b,s", Vi default: "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8066 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8067 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8068 Allow specified keys that move the cursor left/right to move to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8069 previous/next line when the cursor is on the first/last character in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8070 the line. Concatenate characters to allow this for these keys:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8071 char key mode ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8072 b <BS> Normal and Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8073 s <Space> Normal and Visual
712
2e887dfa8917 updated for version 7.0214
vimboss
parents: 707
diff changeset
8074 h "h" Normal and Visual (not recommended)
2e887dfa8917 updated for version 7.0214
vimboss
parents: 707
diff changeset
8075 l "l" Normal and Visual (not recommended)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8076 < <Left> Normal and Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8077 > <Right> Normal and Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8078 ~ "~" Normal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8079 [ <Left> Insert and Replace
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8080 ] <Right> Insert and Replace
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8081 For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8082 :set ww=<,>,[,]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8083 < allows wrap only when cursor keys are used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8084 When the movement keys are used in combination with a delete or change
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8085 operator, the <EOL> also counts for a character. This makes "3h"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8086 different from "3dh" when the cursor crosses the end of a line. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8087 is also true for "x" and "X", because they do the same as "dl" and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8088 "dh". If you use this, you may also want to use the mapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8089 ":map <BS> X" to make backspace delete the character in front of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8090 cursor.
714
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
8091 When 'l' is included and it is used after an operator at the end of a
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
8092 line then it will not move to the next line. This makes "dl", "cl",
0f9f4761ad9c updated for version 7.0216
vimboss
parents: 712
diff changeset
8093 "yl" etc. work normally.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8094 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8095 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8096
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8097 *'wildchar'* *'wc'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8098 'wildchar' 'wc' number (Vim default: <Tab>, Vi default: CTRL-E)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8099 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8100 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8101 Character you have to type to start wildcard expansion in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8102 command-line, as specified with 'wildmode'.
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8103 More info here: |cmdline-completion|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8104 The character is not recognized when used inside a macro. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8105 'wildcharm' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8106 Although 'wc' is a number option, you can set it to a special key: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8107 :set wc=<Esc>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8108 < NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8109 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8110
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8111 *'wildcharm'* *'wcm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8112 'wildcharm' 'wcm' number (default: none (0))
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8113 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8114 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8115 'wildcharm' works exactly like 'wildchar', except that it is
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
8116 recognized when used inside a macro. You can find "spare" command-line
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
8117 keys suitable for this option by looking at |ex-edit-index|. Normally
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8118 you'll never actually type 'wildcharm', just use it in mappings that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8119 automatically invoke completion mode, e.g.: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8120 :set wcm=<C-Z>
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8121 :cnoremap ss so $vim/sessions/*.vim<C-Z>
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8122 < Then after typing :ss you can use CTRL-P & CTRL-N.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8123
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8124 *'wildignore'* *'wig'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8125 'wildignore' 'wig' string (default "")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8126 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8127 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8128 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8129 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8130 A list of file patterns. A file that matches with one of these
3682
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
8131 patterns is ignored when expanding |wildcards|, completing file or
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
8132 directory names, and influences the result of |expand()|, |glob()| and
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3674
diff changeset
8133 |globpath()| unless a flag is passed to disable this.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8134 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8135 Also see 'suffixes'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8136 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8137 :set wildignore=*.o,*.obj
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8138 < The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8139 a pattern from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8140 uses another default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8141
2652
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
8142
2662
916c90b37ea9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2654
diff changeset
8143 *'wildignorecase'* *'wic'* *'nowildignorecase'* *'nowic'*
2652
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
8144 'wildignorecase' 'wic' boolean (default off)
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
8145 global
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
8146 {not in Vi}
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
8147 When set case is ignored when completing file names and directories.
4242
edd0bc1f26bd updated for version 7.3.872
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4229
diff changeset
8148 Has no effect when 'fileignorecase' is set.
2652
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
8149 Does not apply when the shell is used to expand wildcards, which
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
8150 happens when there are special characters.
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
8151
b2a7d143abe2 updated for version 7.3.072
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
8152
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8153 *'wildmenu'* *'wmnu'* *'nowildmenu'* *'nowmnu'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8154 'wildmenu' 'wmnu' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8155 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8156 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8157 {not available if compiled without the |+wildmenu|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8158 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8159 When 'wildmenu' is on, command-line completion operates in an enhanced
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8160 mode. On pressing 'wildchar' (usually <Tab>) to invoke completion,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8161 the possible matches are shown just above the command line, with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8162 first match highlighted (overwriting the status line, if there is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8163 one). Keys that show the previous/next match, such as <Tab> or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8164 CTRL-P/CTRL-N, cause the highlight to move to the appropriate match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8165 When 'wildmode' is used, "wildmenu" mode is used where "full" is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8166 specified. "longest" and "list" do not start "wildmenu" mode.
4159
8b86b69546a9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 4119
diff changeset
8167 You can check the current mode with |wildmenumode()|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8168 If there are more matches than can fit in the line, a ">" is shown on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8169 the right and/or a "<" is shown on the left. The status line scrolls
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8170 as needed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8171 The "wildmenu" mode is abandoned when a key is hit that is not used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8172 for selecting a completion.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8173 While the "wildmenu" is active the following keys have special
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8174 meanings:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8175
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8176 <Left> <Right> - select previous/next match (like CTRL-P/CTRL-N)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8177 <Down> - in filename/menu name completion: move into a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8178 subdirectory or submenu.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8179 <CR> - in menu completion, when the cursor is just after a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8180 dot: move into a submenu.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8181 <Up> - in filename/menu name completion: move up into
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8182 parent directory or parent menu.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8183
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8184 This makes the menus accessible from the console |console-menus|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8185
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8186 If you prefer the <Left> and <Right> keys to move the cursor instead
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8187 of selecting a different match, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8188 :cnoremap <Left> <Space><BS><Left>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8189 :cnoremap <Right> <Space><BS><Right>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8190 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8191 The "WildMenu" highlighting is used for displaying the current match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8192 |hl-WildMenu|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8193
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8194 *'wildmode'* *'wim'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8195 'wildmode' 'wim' string (Vim default: "full")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8196 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8197 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8198 Completion mode that is used for the character specified with
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
8199 'wildchar'. It is a comma separated list of up to four parts. Each
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
8200 part specifies what to do for each consecutive use of 'wildchar'. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8201 first part specifies the behavior for the first use of 'wildchar',
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8202 The second part for the second use, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8203 These are the possible values for each part:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8204 "" Complete only the first match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8205 "full" Complete the next full match. After the last match,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8206 the original string is used and then the first match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8207 again.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8208 "longest" Complete till longest common string. If this doesn't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8209 result in a longer string, use the next part.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8210 "longest:full" Like "longest", but also start 'wildmenu' if it is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8211 enabled.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8212 "list" When more than one match, list all matches.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8213 "list:full" When more than one match, list all matches and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8214 complete first match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8215 "list:longest" When more than one match, list all matches and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8216 complete till longest common string.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8217 When there is only a single match, it is fully completed in all cases.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8218
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8219 Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8220 :set wildmode=full
233
fca8a9b65afa updated for version 7.0065
vimboss
parents: 227
diff changeset
8221 < Complete first full match, next match, etc. (the default) >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8222 :set wildmode=longest,full
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8223 < Complete longest common string, then each full match >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8224 :set wildmode=list:full
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8225 < List all matches and complete each full match >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8226 :set wildmode=list,full
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8227 < List all matches without completing, then each full match >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8228 :set wildmode=longest,list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8229 < Complete longest common string, then list alternatives.
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8230 More info here: |cmdline-completion|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8231
40
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
8232 *'wildoptions'* *'wop'*
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
8233 'wildoptions' 'wop' string (default "")
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
8234 global
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
8235 {not in Vi}
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
8236 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
8237 feature}
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
8238 A list of words that change how command line completion is done.
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
8239 Currently only one word is allowed:
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
8240 tagfile When using CTRL-D to list matching tags, the kind of
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 853
diff changeset
8241 tag and the file of the tag is listed. Only one match
40
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
8242 is displayed per line. Often used tag kinds are:
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
8243 d #define
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
8244 f function
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
8245 Also see |cmdline-completion|.
f1d2a58883b9 updated for version 7.0024
vimboss
parents: 39
diff changeset
8246
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8247 *'winaltkeys'* *'wak'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8248 'winaltkeys' 'wak' string (default "menu")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8249 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8250 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8251 {only used in Win32, Motif, GTK and Photon GUI}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8252 Some GUI versions allow the access to menu entries by using the ALT
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8253 key in combination with a character that appears underlined in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8254 menu. This conflicts with the use of the ALT key for mappings and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8255 entering special characters. This option tells what to do:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8256 no Don't use ALT keys for menus. ALT key combinations can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8257 mapped, but there is no automatic handling. This can then be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8258 done with the |:simalt| command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8259 yes ALT key handling is done by the windowing system. ALT key
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8260 combinations cannot be mapped.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8261 menu Using ALT in combination with a character that is a menu
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
8262 shortcut key, will be handled by the windowing system. Other
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8263 keys can be mapped.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8264 If the menu is disabled by excluding 'm' from 'guioptions', the ALT
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8265 key is never used for the menu.
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
8266 This option is not used for <F10>; on Win32 and with GTK <F10> will
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 33
diff changeset
8267 select the menu, unless it has been mapped.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8268
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
8269 *'window'* *'wi'*
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
8270 'window' 'wi' number (default screen height - 1)
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
8271 global
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
8272 Window height. Do not confuse this with the height of the Vim window,
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
8273 use 'lines' for that.
179
7fd70926e2e1 updated for version 7.0055
vimboss
parents: 170
diff changeset
8274 Used for |CTRL-F| and |CTRL-B| when there is only one window and the
7fd70926e2e1 updated for version 7.0055
vimboss
parents: 170
diff changeset
8275 value is smaller than 'lines' minus one. The screen will scroll
7fd70926e2e1 updated for version 7.0055
vimboss
parents: 170
diff changeset
8276 'window' minus two lines, with a minimum of one.
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
8277 When 'window' is equal to 'lines' minus one CTRL-F and CTRL-B scroll
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
8278 in a much smarter way, taking care of wrapping lines.
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
8279 When resizing the Vim window, the value is smaller than 1 or more than
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
8280 or equal to 'lines' it will be set to 'lines' minus 1.
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
8281 {Vi also uses the option to specify the number of displayed lines}
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
8282
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8283 *'winheight'* *'wh'* *E591*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8284 'winheight' 'wh' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8285 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8286 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
8287 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8288 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8289 Minimal number of lines for the current window. This is not a hard
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
8290 minimum, Vim will use fewer lines if there is not enough room. If the
1621
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8291 focus goes to a window that is smaller, its size is increased, at the
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8292 cost of the height of other windows.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8293 Set 'winheight' to a small number for normal editing.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8294 Set it to 999 to make the current window fill most of the screen.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8295 Other windows will be only 'winminheight' high. This has the drawback
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8296 that ":all" will create only two windows. To avoid "vim -o 1 2 3 4"
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8297 to create only two windows, set the option after startup is done,
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8298 using the |VimEnter| event: >
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8299 au VimEnter * set winheight=999
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8300 < Minimum value is 1.
82b5078be2dd updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1564
diff changeset
8301 The height is not adjusted after one of the commands that change the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8302 height of the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8303 'winheight' applies to the current window. Use 'winminheight' to set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8304 the minimal height for other windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8305
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8306 *'winfixheight'* *'wfh'* *'nowinfixheight'* *'nowfh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8307 'winfixheight' 'wfh' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8308 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8309 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
8310 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8311 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8312 Keep the window height when windows are opened or closed and
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
8313 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|. Set by default for the
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
8314 |preview-window| and |quickfix-window|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8315 The height may be changed anyway when running out of room.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8316
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8317 *'winfixwidth'* *'wfw'* *'nowinfixwidth'* *'nowfw'*
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8318 'winfixwidth' 'wfw' boolean (default off)
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8319 local to window
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8320 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
8321 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8322 feature}
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8323 Keep the window width when windows are opened or closed and
1152
e1787f5b90da updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1111
diff changeset
8324 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|.
782
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8325 The width may be changed anyway when running out of room.
d20041a02ee5 updated for version 7.0228
vimboss
parents: 777
diff changeset
8326
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8327 *'winminheight'* *'wmh'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8328 'winminheight' 'wmh' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8329 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8330 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
8331 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8332 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8333 The minimal height of a window, when it's not the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8334 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8335 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero lines (i.e. just a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8336 status bar) if necessary. They will return to at least one line when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8337 they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere to go.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8338 Use 'winheight' to set the minimal height of the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8339 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8340 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8341 windows. A value of 0 to 3 is reasonable.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8342
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8343 *'winminwidth'* *'wmw'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8344 'winminwidth' 'wmw' number (default 1)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8345 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8346 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
8347 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8348 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8349 The minimal width of a window, when it's not the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8350 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8351 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero columns (i.e. just
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8352 a vertical separator) if necessary. They will return to at least one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8353 line when they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8354 to go.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8355 Use 'winwidth' to set the minimal width of the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8356 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8357 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8358 windows. A value of 0 to 12 is reasonable.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8359
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8360 *'winwidth'* *'wiw'* *E592*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8361 'winwidth' 'wiw' number (default 20)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8362 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8363 {not in Vi}
2570
71b56b4e7785 Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2561
diff changeset
8364 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8365 feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8366 Minimal number of columns for the current window. This is not a hard
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8367 minimum, Vim will use fewer columns if there is not enough room. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8368 the current window is smaller, its size is increased, at the cost of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8369 the width of other windows. Set it to 999 to make the current window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8370 always fill the screen. Set it to a small number for normal editing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8371 The width is not adjusted after one of the commands to change the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8372 width of the current window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8373 'winwidth' applies to the current window. Use 'winminwidth' to set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8374 the minimal width for other windows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8375
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8376 *'wrap'* *'nowrap'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8377 'wrap' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8378 local to window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8379 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8380 This option changes how text is displayed. It doesn't change the text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8381 in the buffer, see 'textwidth' for that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8382 When on, lines longer than the width of the window will wrap and
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
8383 displaying continues on the next line. When off lines will not wrap
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
8384 and only part of long lines will be displayed. When the cursor is
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8385 moved to a part that is not shown, the screen will scroll
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8386 horizontally.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8387 The line will be broken in the middle of a word if necessary. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8388 'linebreak' to get the break at a word boundary.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8389 To make scrolling horizontally a bit more useful, try this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8390 :set sidescroll=5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8391 :set listchars+=precedes:<,extends:>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8392 < See 'sidescroll', 'listchars' and |wrap-off|.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
8393 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1904
diff changeset
8394 on.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8395
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8396 *'wrapmargin'* *'wm'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8397 'wrapmargin' 'wm' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8398 local to buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8399 Number of characters from the right window border where wrapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8400 starts. When typing text beyond this limit, an <EOL> will be inserted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8401 and inserting continues on the next line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8402 Options that add a margin, such as 'number' and 'foldcolumn', cause
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8403 the text width to be further reduced. This is Vi compatible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8404 When 'textwidth' is non-zero, this option is not used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8405 See also 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|. {Vi: works differently
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8406 and less usefully}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8407
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8408 *'wrapscan'* *'ws'* *'nowrapscan'* *'nows'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8409 'wrapscan' 'ws' boolean (default on) *E384* *E385*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8410 global
500
4772a5e3f9fa updated for version 7.0138
vimboss
parents: 493
diff changeset
8411 Searches wrap around the end of the file. Also applies to |]s| and
4772a5e3f9fa updated for version 7.0138
vimboss
parents: 493
diff changeset
8412 |[s|, searching for spelling mistakes.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8413
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8414 *'write'* *'nowrite'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8415 'write' boolean (default on)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8416 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8417 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8418 Allows writing files. When not set, writing a file is not allowed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8419 Can be used for a view-only mode, where modifications to the text are
10
4e2284e71352 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
8420 still allowed. Can be reset with the |-m| or |-M| command line
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8421 argument. Filtering text is still possible, even though this requires
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8422 writing a temporary file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8423
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8424 *'writeany'* *'wa'* *'nowriteany'* *'nowa'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8425 'writeany' 'wa' boolean (default off)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8426 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8427 Allows writing to any file with no need for "!" override.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8428
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8429 *'writebackup'* *'wb'* *'nowritebackup'* *'nowb'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8430 'writebackup' 'wb' boolean (default on with |+writebackup| feature, off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8431 otherwise)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8432 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8433 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8434 Make a backup before overwriting a file. The backup is removed after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8435 the file was successfully written, unless the 'backup' option is
3513
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
8436 also on.
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
8437 WARNING: Switching this option off means that when Vim fails to write
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
8438 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
8439 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only reset
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
8440 this option if your file system is almost full and it makes the write
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
8441 fail (and make sure not to exit Vim until the write was successful).
1b584a6f446c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3496
diff changeset
8442 See |backup-table| for another explanation.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8443 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8444 NOTE: This option is set to the default value when 'compatible' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8445 set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8446
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8447 *'writedelay'* *'wd'*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8448 'writedelay' 'wd' number (default 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8449 global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8450 {not in Vi}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8451 The number of microseconds to wait for each character sent to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8452 screen. When non-zero, characters are sent to the terminal one by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8453 one. For MS-DOS pcterm this does not work. For debugging purposes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8454
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8455 vim:tw=78:ts=8:ft=help:norl: